1 /* ELF executable support for BFD.
3 Copyright (C) 1993-2020 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
5 This file is part of BFD, the Binary File Descriptor library.
7 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
8 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
9 the Free Software Foundation; either version 3 of the License, or
10 (at your option) any later version.
12 This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
13 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
14 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
15 GNU General Public License for more details.
17 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
18 along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
19 Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street - Fifth Floor, Boston,
20 MA 02110-1301, USA. */
27 BFD support for ELF formats is being worked on.
28 Currently, the best supported back ends are for sparc and i386
29 (running svr4 or Solaris 2).
31 Documentation of the internals of the support code still needs
32 to be written. The code is changing quickly enough that we
33 haven't bothered yet. */
35 /* For sparc64-cross-sparc32. */
44 #include "libiberty.h"
45 #include "safe-ctype.h"
46 #include "elf-linux-core.h"
52 static int elf_sort_sections (const void *, const void *);
53 static bfd_boolean
assign_file_positions_except_relocs (bfd
*, struct bfd_link_info
*);
54 static bfd_boolean
swap_out_syms (bfd
*, struct elf_strtab_hash
**, int,
55 struct bfd_link_info
*);
56 static bfd_boolean
elf_parse_notes (bfd
*abfd
, char *buf
, size_t size
,
57 file_ptr offset
, size_t align
);
59 /* Swap version information in and out. The version information is
60 currently size independent. If that ever changes, this code will
61 need to move into elfcode.h. */
63 /* Swap in a Verdef structure. */
66 _bfd_elf_swap_verdef_in (bfd
*abfd
,
67 const Elf_External_Verdef
*src
,
68 Elf_Internal_Verdef
*dst
)
70 dst
->vd_version
= H_GET_16 (abfd
, src
->vd_version
);
71 dst
->vd_flags
= H_GET_16 (abfd
, src
->vd_flags
);
72 dst
->vd_ndx
= H_GET_16 (abfd
, src
->vd_ndx
);
73 dst
->vd_cnt
= H_GET_16 (abfd
, src
->vd_cnt
);
74 dst
->vd_hash
= H_GET_32 (abfd
, src
->vd_hash
);
75 dst
->vd_aux
= H_GET_32 (abfd
, src
->vd_aux
);
76 dst
->vd_next
= H_GET_32 (abfd
, src
->vd_next
);
79 /* Swap out a Verdef structure. */
82 _bfd_elf_swap_verdef_out (bfd
*abfd
,
83 const Elf_Internal_Verdef
*src
,
84 Elf_External_Verdef
*dst
)
86 H_PUT_16 (abfd
, src
->vd_version
, dst
->vd_version
);
87 H_PUT_16 (abfd
, src
->vd_flags
, dst
->vd_flags
);
88 H_PUT_16 (abfd
, src
->vd_ndx
, dst
->vd_ndx
);
89 H_PUT_16 (abfd
, src
->vd_cnt
, dst
->vd_cnt
);
90 H_PUT_32 (abfd
, src
->vd_hash
, dst
->vd_hash
);
91 H_PUT_32 (abfd
, src
->vd_aux
, dst
->vd_aux
);
92 H_PUT_32 (abfd
, src
->vd_next
, dst
->vd_next
);
95 /* Swap in a Verdaux structure. */
98 _bfd_elf_swap_verdaux_in (bfd
*abfd
,
99 const Elf_External_Verdaux
*src
,
100 Elf_Internal_Verdaux
*dst
)
102 dst
->vda_name
= H_GET_32 (abfd
, src
->vda_name
);
103 dst
->vda_next
= H_GET_32 (abfd
, src
->vda_next
);
106 /* Swap out a Verdaux structure. */
109 _bfd_elf_swap_verdaux_out (bfd
*abfd
,
110 const Elf_Internal_Verdaux
*src
,
111 Elf_External_Verdaux
*dst
)
113 H_PUT_32 (abfd
, src
->vda_name
, dst
->vda_name
);
114 H_PUT_32 (abfd
, src
->vda_next
, dst
->vda_next
);
117 /* Swap in a Verneed structure. */
120 _bfd_elf_swap_verneed_in (bfd
*abfd
,
121 const Elf_External_Verneed
*src
,
122 Elf_Internal_Verneed
*dst
)
124 dst
->vn_version
= H_GET_16 (abfd
, src
->vn_version
);
125 dst
->vn_cnt
= H_GET_16 (abfd
, src
->vn_cnt
);
126 dst
->vn_file
= H_GET_32 (abfd
, src
->vn_file
);
127 dst
->vn_aux
= H_GET_32 (abfd
, src
->vn_aux
);
128 dst
->vn_next
= H_GET_32 (abfd
, src
->vn_next
);
131 /* Swap out a Verneed structure. */
134 _bfd_elf_swap_verneed_out (bfd
*abfd
,
135 const Elf_Internal_Verneed
*src
,
136 Elf_External_Verneed
*dst
)
138 H_PUT_16 (abfd
, src
->vn_version
, dst
->vn_version
);
139 H_PUT_16 (abfd
, src
->vn_cnt
, dst
->vn_cnt
);
140 H_PUT_32 (abfd
, src
->vn_file
, dst
->vn_file
);
141 H_PUT_32 (abfd
, src
->vn_aux
, dst
->vn_aux
);
142 H_PUT_32 (abfd
, src
->vn_next
, dst
->vn_next
);
145 /* Swap in a Vernaux structure. */
148 _bfd_elf_swap_vernaux_in (bfd
*abfd
,
149 const Elf_External_Vernaux
*src
,
150 Elf_Internal_Vernaux
*dst
)
152 dst
->vna_hash
= H_GET_32 (abfd
, src
->vna_hash
);
153 dst
->vna_flags
= H_GET_16 (abfd
, src
->vna_flags
);
154 dst
->vna_other
= H_GET_16 (abfd
, src
->vna_other
);
155 dst
->vna_name
= H_GET_32 (abfd
, src
->vna_name
);
156 dst
->vna_next
= H_GET_32 (abfd
, src
->vna_next
);
159 /* Swap out a Vernaux structure. */
162 _bfd_elf_swap_vernaux_out (bfd
*abfd
,
163 const Elf_Internal_Vernaux
*src
,
164 Elf_External_Vernaux
*dst
)
166 H_PUT_32 (abfd
, src
->vna_hash
, dst
->vna_hash
);
167 H_PUT_16 (abfd
, src
->vna_flags
, dst
->vna_flags
);
168 H_PUT_16 (abfd
, src
->vna_other
, dst
->vna_other
);
169 H_PUT_32 (abfd
, src
->vna_name
, dst
->vna_name
);
170 H_PUT_32 (abfd
, src
->vna_next
, dst
->vna_next
);
173 /* Swap in a Versym structure. */
176 _bfd_elf_swap_versym_in (bfd
*abfd
,
177 const Elf_External_Versym
*src
,
178 Elf_Internal_Versym
*dst
)
180 dst
->vs_vers
= H_GET_16 (abfd
, src
->vs_vers
);
183 /* Swap out a Versym structure. */
186 _bfd_elf_swap_versym_out (bfd
*abfd
,
187 const Elf_Internal_Versym
*src
,
188 Elf_External_Versym
*dst
)
190 H_PUT_16 (abfd
, src
->vs_vers
, dst
->vs_vers
);
193 /* Standard ELF hash function. Do not change this function; you will
194 cause invalid hash tables to be generated. */
197 bfd_elf_hash (const char *namearg
)
199 const unsigned char *name
= (const unsigned char *) namearg
;
204 while ((ch
= *name
++) != '\0')
207 if ((g
= (h
& 0xf0000000)) != 0)
210 /* The ELF ABI says `h &= ~g', but this is equivalent in
211 this case and on some machines one insn instead of two. */
215 return h
& 0xffffffff;
218 /* DT_GNU_HASH hash function. Do not change this function; you will
219 cause invalid hash tables to be generated. */
222 bfd_elf_gnu_hash (const char *namearg
)
224 const unsigned char *name
= (const unsigned char *) namearg
;
225 unsigned long h
= 5381;
228 while ((ch
= *name
++) != '\0')
229 h
= (h
<< 5) + h
+ ch
;
230 return h
& 0xffffffff;
233 /* Create a tdata field OBJECT_SIZE bytes in length, zeroed out and with
234 the object_id field of an elf_obj_tdata field set to OBJECT_ID. */
236 bfd_elf_allocate_object (bfd
*abfd
,
238 enum elf_target_id object_id
)
240 BFD_ASSERT (object_size
>= sizeof (struct elf_obj_tdata
));
241 abfd
->tdata
.any
= bfd_zalloc (abfd
, object_size
);
242 if (abfd
->tdata
.any
== NULL
)
245 elf_object_id (abfd
) = object_id
;
246 if (abfd
->direction
!= read_direction
)
248 struct output_elf_obj_tdata
*o
= bfd_zalloc (abfd
, sizeof *o
);
251 elf_tdata (abfd
)->o
= o
;
252 elf_program_header_size (abfd
) = (bfd_size_type
) -1;
259 bfd_elf_make_object (bfd
*abfd
)
261 const struct elf_backend_data
*bed
= get_elf_backend_data (abfd
);
262 return bfd_elf_allocate_object (abfd
, sizeof (struct elf_obj_tdata
),
267 bfd_elf_mkcorefile (bfd
*abfd
)
269 /* I think this can be done just like an object file. */
270 if (!abfd
->xvec
->_bfd_set_format
[(int) bfd_object
] (abfd
))
272 elf_tdata (abfd
)->core
= bfd_zalloc (abfd
, sizeof (*elf_tdata (abfd
)->core
));
273 return elf_tdata (abfd
)->core
!= NULL
;
277 bfd_elf_get_str_section (bfd
*abfd
, unsigned int shindex
)
279 Elf_Internal_Shdr
**i_shdrp
;
280 bfd_byte
*shstrtab
= NULL
;
282 bfd_size_type shstrtabsize
;
284 i_shdrp
= elf_elfsections (abfd
);
286 || shindex
>= elf_numsections (abfd
)
287 || i_shdrp
[shindex
] == 0)
290 shstrtab
= i_shdrp
[shindex
]->contents
;
291 if (shstrtab
== NULL
)
293 /* No cached one, attempt to read, and cache what we read. */
294 offset
= i_shdrp
[shindex
]->sh_offset
;
295 shstrtabsize
= i_shdrp
[shindex
]->sh_size
;
297 /* Allocate and clear an extra byte at the end, to prevent crashes
298 in case the string table is not terminated. */
299 if (shstrtabsize
+ 1 <= 1
300 || bfd_seek (abfd
, offset
, SEEK_SET
) != 0
301 || (shstrtab
= _bfd_alloc_and_read (abfd
, shstrtabsize
+ 1,
302 shstrtabsize
)) == NULL
)
304 /* Once we've failed to read it, make sure we don't keep
305 trying. Otherwise, we'll keep allocating space for
306 the string table over and over. */
307 i_shdrp
[shindex
]->sh_size
= 0;
310 shstrtab
[shstrtabsize
] = '\0';
311 i_shdrp
[shindex
]->contents
= shstrtab
;
313 return (char *) shstrtab
;
317 bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (bfd
*abfd
,
318 unsigned int shindex
,
319 unsigned int strindex
)
321 Elf_Internal_Shdr
*hdr
;
326 if (elf_elfsections (abfd
) == NULL
|| shindex
>= elf_numsections (abfd
))
329 hdr
= elf_elfsections (abfd
)[shindex
];
331 if (hdr
->contents
== NULL
)
333 if (hdr
->sh_type
!= SHT_STRTAB
&& hdr
->sh_type
< SHT_LOOS
)
335 /* PR 17512: file: f057ec89. */
336 /* xgettext:c-format */
337 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: attempt to load strings from"
338 " a non-string section (number %d)"),
343 if (bfd_elf_get_str_section (abfd
, shindex
) == NULL
)
348 /* PR 24273: The string section's contents may have already
349 been loaded elsewhere, eg because a corrupt file has the
350 string section index in the ELF header pointing at a group
351 section. So be paranoid, and test that the last byte of
352 the section is zero. */
353 if (hdr
->sh_size
== 0 || hdr
->contents
[hdr
->sh_size
- 1] != 0)
357 if (strindex
>= hdr
->sh_size
)
359 unsigned int shstrndx
= elf_elfheader(abfd
)->e_shstrndx
;
361 /* xgettext:c-format */
362 (_("%pB: invalid string offset %u >= %" PRIu64
" for section `%s'"),
363 abfd
, strindex
, (uint64_t) hdr
->sh_size
,
364 (shindex
== shstrndx
&& strindex
== hdr
->sh_name
366 : bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd
, shstrndx
, hdr
->sh_name
)));
370 return ((char *) hdr
->contents
) + strindex
;
373 /* Read and convert symbols to internal format.
374 SYMCOUNT specifies the number of symbols to read, starting from
375 symbol SYMOFFSET. If any of INTSYM_BUF, EXTSYM_BUF or EXTSHNDX_BUF
376 are non-NULL, they are used to store the internal symbols, external
377 symbols, and symbol section index extensions, respectively.
378 Returns a pointer to the internal symbol buffer (malloced if necessary)
379 or NULL if there were no symbols or some kind of problem. */
382 bfd_elf_get_elf_syms (bfd
*ibfd
,
383 Elf_Internal_Shdr
*symtab_hdr
,
386 Elf_Internal_Sym
*intsym_buf
,
388 Elf_External_Sym_Shndx
*extshndx_buf
)
390 Elf_Internal_Shdr
*shndx_hdr
;
392 const bfd_byte
*esym
;
393 Elf_External_Sym_Shndx
*alloc_extshndx
;
394 Elf_External_Sym_Shndx
*shndx
;
395 Elf_Internal_Sym
*alloc_intsym
;
396 Elf_Internal_Sym
*isym
;
397 Elf_Internal_Sym
*isymend
;
398 const struct elf_backend_data
*bed
;
403 if (bfd_get_flavour (ibfd
) != bfd_target_elf_flavour
)
409 /* Normal syms might have section extension entries. */
411 if (elf_symtab_shndx_list (ibfd
) != NULL
)
413 elf_section_list
* entry
;
414 Elf_Internal_Shdr
**sections
= elf_elfsections (ibfd
);
416 /* Find an index section that is linked to this symtab section. */
417 for (entry
= elf_symtab_shndx_list (ibfd
); entry
!= NULL
; entry
= entry
->next
)
420 if (entry
->hdr
.sh_link
>= elf_numsections (ibfd
))
423 if (sections
[entry
->hdr
.sh_link
] == symtab_hdr
)
425 shndx_hdr
= & entry
->hdr
;
430 if (shndx_hdr
== NULL
)
432 if (symtab_hdr
== & elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd
))
433 /* Not really accurate, but this was how the old code used to work. */
434 shndx_hdr
= & elf_symtab_shndx_list (ibfd
)->hdr
;
435 /* Otherwise we do nothing. The assumption is that
436 the index table will not be needed. */
440 /* Read the symbols. */
442 alloc_extshndx
= NULL
;
444 bed
= get_elf_backend_data (ibfd
);
445 extsym_size
= bed
->s
->sizeof_sym
;
446 if (_bfd_mul_overflow (symcount
, extsym_size
, &amt
))
448 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_file_too_big
);
452 pos
= symtab_hdr
->sh_offset
+ symoffset
* extsym_size
;
453 if (extsym_buf
== NULL
)
455 alloc_ext
= bfd_malloc (amt
);
456 extsym_buf
= alloc_ext
;
458 if (extsym_buf
== NULL
459 || bfd_seek (ibfd
, pos
, SEEK_SET
) != 0
460 || bfd_bread (extsym_buf
, amt
, ibfd
) != amt
)
466 if (shndx_hdr
== NULL
|| shndx_hdr
->sh_size
== 0)
470 if (_bfd_mul_overflow (symcount
, sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx
), &amt
))
472 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_file_too_big
);
476 pos
= shndx_hdr
->sh_offset
+ symoffset
* sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx
);
477 if (extshndx_buf
== NULL
)
479 alloc_extshndx
= (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx
*) bfd_malloc (amt
);
480 extshndx_buf
= alloc_extshndx
;
482 if (extshndx_buf
== NULL
483 || bfd_seek (ibfd
, pos
, SEEK_SET
) != 0
484 || bfd_bread (extshndx_buf
, amt
, ibfd
) != amt
)
491 if (intsym_buf
== NULL
)
493 if (_bfd_mul_overflow (symcount
, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Sym
), &amt
))
495 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_file_too_big
);
498 alloc_intsym
= (Elf_Internal_Sym
*) bfd_malloc (amt
);
499 intsym_buf
= alloc_intsym
;
500 if (intsym_buf
== NULL
)
504 /* Convert the symbols to internal form. */
505 isymend
= intsym_buf
+ symcount
;
506 for (esym
= (const bfd_byte
*) extsym_buf
, isym
= intsym_buf
,
507 shndx
= extshndx_buf
;
509 esym
+= extsym_size
, isym
++, shndx
= shndx
!= NULL
? shndx
+ 1 : NULL
)
510 if (!(*bed
->s
->swap_symbol_in
) (ibfd
, esym
, shndx
, isym
))
512 symoffset
+= (esym
- (bfd_byte
*) extsym_buf
) / extsym_size
;
513 /* xgettext:c-format */
514 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB symbol number %lu references"
515 " nonexistent SHT_SYMTAB_SHNDX section"),
516 ibfd
, (unsigned long) symoffset
);
524 free (alloc_extshndx
);
529 /* Look up a symbol name. */
531 bfd_elf_sym_name (bfd
*abfd
,
532 Elf_Internal_Shdr
*symtab_hdr
,
533 Elf_Internal_Sym
*isym
,
537 unsigned int iname
= isym
->st_name
;
538 unsigned int shindex
= symtab_hdr
->sh_link
;
540 if (iname
== 0 && ELF_ST_TYPE (isym
->st_info
) == STT_SECTION
541 /* Check for a bogus st_shndx to avoid crashing. */
542 && isym
->st_shndx
< elf_numsections (abfd
))
544 iname
= elf_elfsections (abfd
)[isym
->st_shndx
]->sh_name
;
545 shindex
= elf_elfheader (abfd
)->e_shstrndx
;
548 name
= bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd
, shindex
, iname
);
551 else if (sym_sec
&& *name
== '\0')
552 name
= bfd_section_name (sym_sec
);
557 /* Elf_Internal_Shdr->contents is an array of these for SHT_GROUP
558 sections. The first element is the flags, the rest are section
561 typedef union elf_internal_group
{
562 Elf_Internal_Shdr
*shdr
;
564 } Elf_Internal_Group
;
566 /* Return the name of the group signature symbol. Why isn't the
567 signature just a string? */
570 group_signature (bfd
*abfd
, Elf_Internal_Shdr
*ghdr
)
572 Elf_Internal_Shdr
*hdr
;
573 unsigned char esym
[sizeof (Elf64_External_Sym
)];
574 Elf_External_Sym_Shndx eshndx
;
575 Elf_Internal_Sym isym
;
577 /* First we need to ensure the symbol table is available. Make sure
578 that it is a symbol table section. */
579 if (ghdr
->sh_link
>= elf_numsections (abfd
))
581 hdr
= elf_elfsections (abfd
) [ghdr
->sh_link
];
582 if (hdr
->sh_type
!= SHT_SYMTAB
583 || ! bfd_section_from_shdr (abfd
, ghdr
->sh_link
))
586 /* Go read the symbol. */
587 hdr
= &elf_tdata (abfd
)->symtab_hdr
;
588 if (bfd_elf_get_elf_syms (abfd
, hdr
, 1, ghdr
->sh_info
,
589 &isym
, esym
, &eshndx
) == NULL
)
592 return bfd_elf_sym_name (abfd
, hdr
, &isym
, NULL
);
595 /* Set next_in_group list pointer, and group name for NEWSECT. */
598 setup_group (bfd
*abfd
, Elf_Internal_Shdr
*hdr
, asection
*newsect
)
600 unsigned int num_group
= elf_tdata (abfd
)->num_group
;
602 /* If num_group is zero, read in all SHT_GROUP sections. The count
603 is set to -1 if there are no SHT_GROUP sections. */
606 unsigned int i
, shnum
;
608 /* First count the number of groups. If we have a SHT_GROUP
609 section with just a flag word (ie. sh_size is 4), ignore it. */
610 shnum
= elf_numsections (abfd
);
613 #define IS_VALID_GROUP_SECTION_HEADER(shdr, minsize) \
614 ( (shdr)->sh_type == SHT_GROUP \
615 && (shdr)->sh_size >= minsize \
616 && (shdr)->sh_entsize == GRP_ENTRY_SIZE \
617 && ((shdr)->sh_size % GRP_ENTRY_SIZE) == 0)
619 for (i
= 0; i
< shnum
; i
++)
621 Elf_Internal_Shdr
*shdr
= elf_elfsections (abfd
)[i
];
623 if (IS_VALID_GROUP_SECTION_HEADER (shdr
, 2 * GRP_ENTRY_SIZE
))
629 num_group
= (unsigned) -1;
630 elf_tdata (abfd
)->num_group
= num_group
;
631 elf_tdata (abfd
)->group_sect_ptr
= NULL
;
635 /* We keep a list of elf section headers for group sections,
636 so we can find them quickly. */
639 elf_tdata (abfd
)->num_group
= num_group
;
640 amt
= num_group
* sizeof (Elf_Internal_Shdr
*);
641 elf_tdata (abfd
)->group_sect_ptr
642 = (Elf_Internal_Shdr
**) bfd_zalloc (abfd
, amt
);
643 if (elf_tdata (abfd
)->group_sect_ptr
== NULL
)
647 for (i
= 0; i
< shnum
; i
++)
649 Elf_Internal_Shdr
*shdr
= elf_elfsections (abfd
)[i
];
651 if (IS_VALID_GROUP_SECTION_HEADER (shdr
, 2 * GRP_ENTRY_SIZE
))
654 Elf_Internal_Group
*dest
;
656 /* Make sure the group section has a BFD section
658 if (!bfd_section_from_shdr (abfd
, i
))
661 /* Add to list of sections. */
662 elf_tdata (abfd
)->group_sect_ptr
[num_group
] = shdr
;
665 /* Read the raw contents. */
666 BFD_ASSERT (sizeof (*dest
) >= 4 && sizeof (*dest
) % 4 == 0);
667 shdr
->contents
= NULL
;
668 if (_bfd_mul_overflow (shdr
->sh_size
,
669 sizeof (*dest
) / 4, &amt
)
670 || bfd_seek (abfd
, shdr
->sh_offset
, SEEK_SET
) != 0
672 = _bfd_alloc_and_read (abfd
, amt
, shdr
->sh_size
)))
675 /* xgettext:c-format */
676 (_("%pB: invalid size field in group section"
677 " header: %#" PRIx64
""),
678 abfd
, (uint64_t) shdr
->sh_size
);
679 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value
);
684 /* Translate raw contents, a flag word followed by an
685 array of elf section indices all in target byte order,
686 to the flag word followed by an array of elf section
688 src
= shdr
->contents
+ shdr
->sh_size
;
689 dest
= (Elf_Internal_Group
*) (shdr
->contents
+ amt
);
697 idx
= H_GET_32 (abfd
, src
);
698 if (src
== shdr
->contents
)
702 if (shdr
->bfd_section
!= NULL
&& (idx
& GRP_COMDAT
))
703 shdr
->bfd_section
->flags
704 |= SEC_LINK_ONCE
| SEC_LINK_DUPLICATES_DISCARD
;
709 dest
->shdr
= elf_elfsections (abfd
)[idx
];
710 /* PR binutils/23199: All sections in a
711 section group should be marked with
712 SHF_GROUP. But some tools generate
713 broken objects without SHF_GROUP. Fix
715 dest
->shdr
->sh_flags
|= SHF_GROUP
;
718 || dest
->shdr
->sh_type
== SHT_GROUP
)
721 (_("%pB: invalid entry in SHT_GROUP section [%u]"),
729 /* PR 17510: Corrupt binaries might contain invalid groups. */
730 if (num_group
!= (unsigned) elf_tdata (abfd
)->num_group
)
732 elf_tdata (abfd
)->num_group
= num_group
;
734 /* If all groups are invalid then fail. */
737 elf_tdata (abfd
)->group_sect_ptr
= NULL
;
738 elf_tdata (abfd
)->num_group
= num_group
= -1;
740 (_("%pB: no valid group sections found"), abfd
);
741 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value
);
747 if (num_group
!= (unsigned) -1)
749 unsigned int search_offset
= elf_tdata (abfd
)->group_search_offset
;
752 for (j
= 0; j
< num_group
; j
++)
754 /* Begin search from previous found group. */
755 unsigned i
= (j
+ search_offset
) % num_group
;
757 Elf_Internal_Shdr
*shdr
= elf_tdata (abfd
)->group_sect_ptr
[i
];
758 Elf_Internal_Group
*idx
;
764 idx
= (Elf_Internal_Group
*) shdr
->contents
;
765 if (idx
== NULL
|| shdr
->sh_size
< 4)
767 /* See PR 21957 for a reproducer. */
768 /* xgettext:c-format */
769 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: group section '%pA' has no contents"),
770 abfd
, shdr
->bfd_section
);
771 elf_tdata (abfd
)->group_sect_ptr
[i
] = NULL
;
772 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value
);
775 n_elt
= shdr
->sh_size
/ 4;
777 /* Look through this group's sections to see if current
778 section is a member. */
780 if ((++idx
)->shdr
== hdr
)
784 /* We are a member of this group. Go looking through
785 other members to see if any others are linked via
787 idx
= (Elf_Internal_Group
*) shdr
->contents
;
788 n_elt
= shdr
->sh_size
/ 4;
790 if ((++idx
)->shdr
!= NULL
791 && (s
= idx
->shdr
->bfd_section
) != NULL
792 && elf_next_in_group (s
) != NULL
)
796 /* Snarf the group name from other member, and
797 insert current section in circular list. */
798 elf_group_name (newsect
) = elf_group_name (s
);
799 elf_next_in_group (newsect
) = elf_next_in_group (s
);
800 elf_next_in_group (s
) = newsect
;
806 gname
= group_signature (abfd
, shdr
);
809 elf_group_name (newsect
) = gname
;
811 /* Start a circular list with one element. */
812 elf_next_in_group (newsect
) = newsect
;
815 /* If the group section has been created, point to the
817 if (shdr
->bfd_section
!= NULL
)
818 elf_next_in_group (shdr
->bfd_section
) = newsect
;
820 elf_tdata (abfd
)->group_search_offset
= i
;
827 if (elf_group_name (newsect
) == NULL
)
829 /* xgettext:c-format */
830 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: no group info for section '%pA'"),
838 _bfd_elf_setup_sections (bfd
*abfd
)
841 unsigned int num_group
= elf_tdata (abfd
)->num_group
;
842 bfd_boolean result
= TRUE
;
845 /* Process SHF_LINK_ORDER. */
846 for (s
= abfd
->sections
; s
!= NULL
; s
= s
->next
)
848 Elf_Internal_Shdr
*this_hdr
= &elf_section_data (s
)->this_hdr
;
849 if ((this_hdr
->sh_flags
& SHF_LINK_ORDER
) != 0)
851 unsigned int elfsec
= this_hdr
->sh_link
;
852 /* An sh_link value of 0 is now allowed. It indicates that linked
853 to section has already been discarded, but that the current
854 section has been retained for some other reason. This linking
855 section is still a candidate for later garbage collection
859 elf_linked_to_section (s
) = NULL
;
863 asection
*linksec
= NULL
;
865 if (elfsec
< elf_numsections (abfd
))
867 this_hdr
= elf_elfsections (abfd
)[elfsec
];
868 linksec
= this_hdr
->bfd_section
;
872 Some strip/objcopy may leave an incorrect value in
873 sh_link. We don't want to proceed. */
877 /* xgettext:c-format */
878 (_("%pB: sh_link [%d] in section `%pA' is incorrect"),
879 s
->owner
, elfsec
, s
);
883 elf_linked_to_section (s
) = linksec
;
886 else if (this_hdr
->sh_type
== SHT_GROUP
887 && elf_next_in_group (s
) == NULL
)
890 /* xgettext:c-format */
891 (_("%pB: SHT_GROUP section [index %d] has no SHF_GROUP sections"),
892 abfd
, elf_section_data (s
)->this_idx
);
897 /* Process section groups. */
898 if (num_group
== (unsigned) -1)
901 for (i
= 0; i
< num_group
; i
++)
903 Elf_Internal_Shdr
*shdr
= elf_tdata (abfd
)->group_sect_ptr
[i
];
904 Elf_Internal_Group
*idx
;
907 /* PR binutils/18758: Beware of corrupt binaries with invalid group data. */
908 if (shdr
== NULL
|| shdr
->bfd_section
== NULL
|| shdr
->contents
== NULL
)
911 /* xgettext:c-format */
912 (_("%pB: section group entry number %u is corrupt"),
918 idx
= (Elf_Internal_Group
*) shdr
->contents
;
919 n_elt
= shdr
->sh_size
/ 4;
925 if (idx
->shdr
== NULL
)
927 else if (idx
->shdr
->bfd_section
)
928 elf_sec_group (idx
->shdr
->bfd_section
) = shdr
->bfd_section
;
929 else if (idx
->shdr
->sh_type
!= SHT_RELA
930 && idx
->shdr
->sh_type
!= SHT_REL
)
932 /* There are some unknown sections in the group. */
934 /* xgettext:c-format */
935 (_("%pB: unknown type [%#x] section `%s' in group [%pA]"),
938 bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd
,
939 (elf_elfheader (abfd
)
952 bfd_elf_is_group_section (bfd
*abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED
, const asection
*sec
)
954 return elf_next_in_group (sec
) != NULL
;
958 bfd_elf_group_name (bfd
*abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED
, const asection
*sec
)
960 if (elf_sec_group (sec
) != NULL
)
961 return elf_group_name (sec
);
966 convert_debug_to_zdebug (bfd
*abfd
, const char *name
)
968 unsigned int len
= strlen (name
);
969 char *new_name
= bfd_alloc (abfd
, len
+ 2);
970 if (new_name
== NULL
)
974 memcpy (new_name
+ 2, name
+ 1, len
);
979 convert_zdebug_to_debug (bfd
*abfd
, const char *name
)
981 unsigned int len
= strlen (name
);
982 char *new_name
= bfd_alloc (abfd
, len
);
983 if (new_name
== NULL
)
986 memcpy (new_name
+ 1, name
+ 2, len
- 1);
990 /* This a copy of lto_section defined in GCC (lto-streamer.h). */
994 int16_t major_version
;
995 int16_t minor_version
;
996 unsigned char slim_object
;
998 /* Flags is a private field that is not defined publicly. */
1002 /* Make a BFD section from an ELF section. We store a pointer to the
1003 BFD section in the bfd_section field of the header. */
1006 _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (bfd
*abfd
,
1007 Elf_Internal_Shdr
*hdr
,
1013 const struct elf_backend_data
*bed
;
1014 unsigned int opb
= bfd_octets_per_byte (abfd
, NULL
);
1016 if (hdr
->bfd_section
!= NULL
)
1019 newsect
= bfd_make_section_anyway (abfd
, name
);
1020 if (newsect
== NULL
)
1023 hdr
->bfd_section
= newsect
;
1024 elf_section_data (newsect
)->this_hdr
= *hdr
;
1025 elf_section_data (newsect
)->this_idx
= shindex
;
1027 /* Always use the real type/flags. */
1028 elf_section_type (newsect
) = hdr
->sh_type
;
1029 elf_section_flags (newsect
) = hdr
->sh_flags
;
1031 newsect
->filepos
= hdr
->sh_offset
;
1033 flags
= SEC_NO_FLAGS
;
1034 if (hdr
->sh_type
!= SHT_NOBITS
)
1035 flags
|= SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
;
1036 if (hdr
->sh_type
== SHT_GROUP
)
1038 if ((hdr
->sh_flags
& SHF_ALLOC
) != 0)
1041 if (hdr
->sh_type
!= SHT_NOBITS
)
1044 if ((hdr
->sh_flags
& SHF_WRITE
) == 0)
1045 flags
|= SEC_READONLY
;
1046 if ((hdr
->sh_flags
& SHF_EXECINSTR
) != 0)
1048 else if ((flags
& SEC_LOAD
) != 0)
1050 if ((hdr
->sh_flags
& SHF_MERGE
) != 0)
1053 newsect
->entsize
= hdr
->sh_entsize
;
1055 if ((hdr
->sh_flags
& SHF_STRINGS
) != 0)
1056 flags
|= SEC_STRINGS
;
1057 if (hdr
->sh_flags
& SHF_GROUP
)
1058 if (!setup_group (abfd
, hdr
, newsect
))
1060 if ((hdr
->sh_flags
& SHF_TLS
) != 0)
1061 flags
|= SEC_THREAD_LOCAL
;
1062 if ((hdr
->sh_flags
& SHF_EXCLUDE
) != 0)
1063 flags
|= SEC_EXCLUDE
;
1065 switch (elf_elfheader (abfd
)->e_ident
[EI_OSABI
])
1067 /* FIXME: We should not recognize SHF_GNU_MBIND for ELFOSABI_NONE,
1068 but binutils as of 2019-07-23 did not set the EI_OSABI header
1071 case ELFOSABI_FREEBSD
:
1072 if ((hdr
->sh_flags
& SHF_GNU_RETAIN
) != 0)
1073 elf_tdata (abfd
)->has_gnu_osabi
|= elf_gnu_osabi_retain
;
1076 if ((hdr
->sh_flags
& SHF_GNU_MBIND
) != 0)
1077 elf_tdata (abfd
)->has_gnu_osabi
|= elf_gnu_osabi_mbind
;
1081 if ((flags
& SEC_ALLOC
) == 0)
1083 /* The debugging sections appear to be recognized only by name,
1084 not any sort of flag. Their SEC_ALLOC bits are cleared. */
1085 if (name
[0] == '.')
1087 if (strncmp (name
, ".debug", 6) == 0
1088 || strncmp (name
, ".gnu.linkonce.wi.", 17) == 0
1089 || strncmp (name
, ".zdebug", 7) == 0)
1090 flags
|= SEC_DEBUGGING
| SEC_ELF_OCTETS
;
1091 else if (strncmp (name
, GNU_BUILD_ATTRS_SECTION_NAME
, 21) == 0
1092 || strncmp (name
, ".note.gnu", 9) == 0)
1094 flags
|= SEC_ELF_OCTETS
;
1097 else if (strncmp (name
, ".line", 5) == 0
1098 || strncmp (name
, ".stab", 5) == 0
1099 || strcmp (name
, ".gdb_index") == 0)
1100 flags
|= SEC_DEBUGGING
;
1104 if (!bfd_set_section_vma (newsect
, hdr
->sh_addr
/ opb
)
1105 || !bfd_set_section_size (newsect
, hdr
->sh_size
)
1106 || !bfd_set_section_alignment (newsect
, bfd_log2 (hdr
->sh_addralign
)))
1109 /* As a GNU extension, if the name begins with .gnu.linkonce, we
1110 only link a single copy of the section. This is used to support
1111 g++. g++ will emit each template expansion in its own section.
1112 The symbols will be defined as weak, so that multiple definitions
1113 are permitted. The GNU linker extension is to actually discard
1114 all but one of the sections. */
1115 if (CONST_STRNEQ (name
, ".gnu.linkonce")
1116 && elf_next_in_group (newsect
) == NULL
)
1117 flags
|= SEC_LINK_ONCE
| SEC_LINK_DUPLICATES_DISCARD
;
1119 if (!bfd_set_section_flags (newsect
, flags
))
1122 bed
= get_elf_backend_data (abfd
);
1123 if (bed
->elf_backend_section_flags
)
1124 if (!bed
->elf_backend_section_flags (hdr
))
1127 /* We do not parse the PT_NOTE segments as we are interested even in the
1128 separate debug info files which may have the segments offsets corrupted.
1129 PT_NOTEs from the core files are currently not parsed using BFD. */
1130 if (hdr
->sh_type
== SHT_NOTE
)
1134 if (!bfd_malloc_and_get_section (abfd
, newsect
, &contents
))
1137 elf_parse_notes (abfd
, (char *) contents
, hdr
->sh_size
,
1138 hdr
->sh_offset
, hdr
->sh_addralign
);
1142 if ((newsect
->flags
& SEC_ALLOC
) != 0)
1144 Elf_Internal_Phdr
*phdr
;
1145 unsigned int i
, nload
;
1147 /* Some ELF linkers produce binaries with all the program header
1148 p_paddr fields zero. If we have such a binary with more than
1149 one PT_LOAD header, then leave the section lma equal to vma
1150 so that we don't create sections with overlapping lma. */
1151 phdr
= elf_tdata (abfd
)->phdr
;
1152 for (nload
= 0, i
= 0; i
< elf_elfheader (abfd
)->e_phnum
; i
++, phdr
++)
1153 if (phdr
->p_paddr
!= 0)
1155 else if (phdr
->p_type
== PT_LOAD
&& phdr
->p_memsz
!= 0)
1157 if (i
>= elf_elfheader (abfd
)->e_phnum
&& nload
> 1)
1160 phdr
= elf_tdata (abfd
)->phdr
;
1161 for (i
= 0; i
< elf_elfheader (abfd
)->e_phnum
; i
++, phdr
++)
1163 if (((phdr
->p_type
== PT_LOAD
1164 && (hdr
->sh_flags
& SHF_TLS
) == 0)
1165 || phdr
->p_type
== PT_TLS
)
1166 && ELF_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT (hdr
, phdr
))
1168 if ((newsect
->flags
& SEC_LOAD
) == 0)
1169 newsect
->lma
= (phdr
->p_paddr
1170 + hdr
->sh_addr
- phdr
->p_vaddr
) / opb
;
1172 /* We used to use the same adjustment for SEC_LOAD
1173 sections, but that doesn't work if the segment
1174 is packed with code from multiple VMAs.
1175 Instead we calculate the section LMA based on
1176 the segment LMA. It is assumed that the
1177 segment will contain sections with contiguous
1178 LMAs, even if the VMAs are not. */
1179 newsect
->lma
= (phdr
->p_paddr
1180 + hdr
->sh_offset
- phdr
->p_offset
) / opb
;
1182 /* With contiguous segments, we can't tell from file
1183 offsets whether a section with zero size should
1184 be placed at the end of one segment or the
1185 beginning of the next. Decide based on vaddr. */
1186 if (hdr
->sh_addr
>= phdr
->p_vaddr
1187 && (hdr
->sh_addr
+ hdr
->sh_size
1188 <= phdr
->p_vaddr
+ phdr
->p_memsz
))
1194 /* Compress/decompress DWARF debug sections with names: .debug_* and
1195 .zdebug_*, after the section flags is set. */
1196 if ((newsect
->flags
& SEC_DEBUGGING
)
1197 && ((name
[1] == 'd' && name
[6] == '_')
1198 || (name
[1] == 'z' && name
[7] == '_')))
1200 enum { nothing
, compress
, decompress
} action
= nothing
;
1201 int compression_header_size
;
1202 bfd_size_type uncompressed_size
;
1203 unsigned int uncompressed_align_power
;
1204 bfd_boolean compressed
1205 = bfd_is_section_compressed_with_header (abfd
, newsect
,
1206 &compression_header_size
,
1208 &uncompressed_align_power
);
1211 /* Compressed section. Check if we should decompress. */
1212 if ((abfd
->flags
& BFD_DECOMPRESS
))
1213 action
= decompress
;
1216 /* Compress the uncompressed section or convert from/to .zdebug*
1217 section. Check if we should compress. */
1218 if (action
== nothing
)
1220 if (newsect
->size
!= 0
1221 && (abfd
->flags
& BFD_COMPRESS
)
1222 && compression_header_size
>= 0
1223 && uncompressed_size
> 0
1225 || ((compression_header_size
> 0)
1226 != ((abfd
->flags
& BFD_COMPRESS_GABI
) != 0))))
1232 if (action
== compress
)
1234 if (!bfd_init_section_compress_status (abfd
, newsect
))
1237 /* xgettext:c-format */
1238 (_("%pB: unable to initialize compress status for section %s"),
1245 if (!bfd_init_section_decompress_status (abfd
, newsect
))
1248 /* xgettext:c-format */
1249 (_("%pB: unable to initialize decompress status for section %s"),
1255 if (abfd
->is_linker_input
)
1258 && (action
== decompress
1259 || (action
== compress
1260 && (abfd
->flags
& BFD_COMPRESS_GABI
) != 0)))
1262 /* Convert section name from .zdebug_* to .debug_* so
1263 that linker will consider this section as a debug
1265 char *new_name
= convert_zdebug_to_debug (abfd
, name
);
1266 if (new_name
== NULL
)
1268 bfd_rename_section (newsect
, new_name
);
1272 /* For objdump, don't rename the section. For objcopy, delay
1273 section rename to elf_fake_sections. */
1274 newsect
->flags
|= SEC_ELF_RENAME
;
1277 /* GCC uses .gnu.lto_.lto.<some_hash> as a LTO bytecode information
1279 const char *lto_section_name
= ".gnu.lto_.lto.";
1280 if (strncmp (name
, lto_section_name
, strlen (lto_section_name
)) == 0)
1282 struct lto_section lsection
;
1283 if (bfd_get_section_contents (abfd
, newsect
, &lsection
, 0,
1284 sizeof (struct lto_section
)))
1285 abfd
->lto_slim_object
= lsection
.slim_object
;
1291 const char *const bfd_elf_section_type_names
[] =
1293 "SHT_NULL", "SHT_PROGBITS", "SHT_SYMTAB", "SHT_STRTAB",
1294 "SHT_RELA", "SHT_HASH", "SHT_DYNAMIC", "SHT_NOTE",
1295 "SHT_NOBITS", "SHT_REL", "SHT_SHLIB", "SHT_DYNSYM",
1298 /* ELF relocs are against symbols. If we are producing relocatable
1299 output, and the reloc is against an external symbol, and nothing
1300 has given us any additional addend, the resulting reloc will also
1301 be against the same symbol. In such a case, we don't want to
1302 change anything about the way the reloc is handled, since it will
1303 all be done at final link time. Rather than put special case code
1304 into bfd_perform_relocation, all the reloc types use this howto
1305 function. It just short circuits the reloc if producing
1306 relocatable output against an external symbol. */
1308 bfd_reloc_status_type
1309 bfd_elf_generic_reloc (bfd
*abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED
,
1310 arelent
*reloc_entry
,
1312 void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED
,
1313 asection
*input_section
,
1315 char **error_message ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED
)
1317 if (output_bfd
!= NULL
1318 && (symbol
->flags
& BSF_SECTION_SYM
) == 0
1319 && (! reloc_entry
->howto
->partial_inplace
1320 || reloc_entry
->addend
== 0))
1322 reloc_entry
->address
+= input_section
->output_offset
;
1323 return bfd_reloc_ok
;
1326 return bfd_reloc_continue
;
1329 /* Returns TRUE if section A matches section B.
1330 Names, addresses and links may be different, but everything else
1331 should be the same. */
1334 section_match (const Elf_Internal_Shdr
* a
,
1335 const Elf_Internal_Shdr
* b
)
1337 if (a
->sh_type
!= b
->sh_type
1338 || ((a
->sh_flags
^ b
->sh_flags
) & ~SHF_INFO_LINK
) != 0
1339 || a
->sh_addralign
!= b
->sh_addralign
1340 || a
->sh_entsize
!= b
->sh_entsize
)
1342 if (a
->sh_type
== SHT_SYMTAB
1343 || a
->sh_type
== SHT_STRTAB
)
1345 return a
->sh_size
== b
->sh_size
;
1348 /* Find a section in OBFD that has the same characteristics
1349 as IHEADER. Return the index of this section or SHN_UNDEF if
1350 none can be found. Check's section HINT first, as this is likely
1351 to be the correct section. */
1354 find_link (const bfd
*obfd
, const Elf_Internal_Shdr
*iheader
,
1355 const unsigned int hint
)
1357 Elf_Internal_Shdr
** oheaders
= elf_elfsections (obfd
);
1360 BFD_ASSERT (iheader
!= NULL
);
1362 /* See PR 20922 for a reproducer of the NULL test. */
1363 if (hint
< elf_numsections (obfd
)
1364 && oheaders
[hint
] != NULL
1365 && section_match (oheaders
[hint
], iheader
))
1368 for (i
= 1; i
< elf_numsections (obfd
); i
++)
1370 Elf_Internal_Shdr
* oheader
= oheaders
[i
];
1372 if (oheader
== NULL
)
1374 if (section_match (oheader
, iheader
))
1375 /* FIXME: Do we care if there is a potential for
1376 multiple matches ? */
1383 /* PR 19938: Attempt to set the ELF section header fields of an OS or
1384 Processor specific section, based upon a matching input section.
1385 Returns TRUE upon success, FALSE otherwise. */
1388 copy_special_section_fields (const bfd
*ibfd
,
1390 const Elf_Internal_Shdr
*iheader
,
1391 Elf_Internal_Shdr
*oheader
,
1392 const unsigned int secnum
)
1394 const struct elf_backend_data
*bed
= get_elf_backend_data (obfd
);
1395 const Elf_Internal_Shdr
**iheaders
= (const Elf_Internal_Shdr
**) elf_elfsections (ibfd
);
1396 bfd_boolean changed
= FALSE
;
1397 unsigned int sh_link
;
1399 if (oheader
->sh_type
== SHT_NOBITS
)
1401 /* This is a feature for objcopy --only-keep-debug:
1402 When a section's type is changed to NOBITS, we preserve
1403 the sh_link and sh_info fields so that they can be
1404 matched up with the original.
1406 Note: Strictly speaking these assignments are wrong.
1407 The sh_link and sh_info fields should point to the
1408 relevent sections in the output BFD, which may not be in
1409 the same location as they were in the input BFD. But
1410 the whole point of this action is to preserve the
1411 original values of the sh_link and sh_info fields, so
1412 that they can be matched up with the section headers in
1413 the original file. So strictly speaking we may be
1414 creating an invalid ELF file, but it is only for a file
1415 that just contains debug info and only for sections
1416 without any contents. */
1417 if (oheader
->sh_link
== 0)
1418 oheader
->sh_link
= iheader
->sh_link
;
1419 if (oheader
->sh_info
== 0)
1420 oheader
->sh_info
= iheader
->sh_info
;
1424 /* Allow the target a chance to decide how these fields should be set. */
1425 if (bed
->elf_backend_copy_special_section_fields (ibfd
, obfd
,
1429 /* We have an iheader which might match oheader, and which has non-zero
1430 sh_info and/or sh_link fields. Attempt to follow those links and find
1431 the section in the output bfd which corresponds to the linked section
1432 in the input bfd. */
1433 if (iheader
->sh_link
!= SHN_UNDEF
)
1435 /* See PR 20931 for a reproducer. */
1436 if (iheader
->sh_link
>= elf_numsections (ibfd
))
1439 /* xgettext:c-format */
1440 (_("%pB: invalid sh_link field (%d) in section number %d"),
1441 ibfd
, iheader
->sh_link
, secnum
);
1445 sh_link
= find_link (obfd
, iheaders
[iheader
->sh_link
], iheader
->sh_link
);
1446 if (sh_link
!= SHN_UNDEF
)
1448 oheader
->sh_link
= sh_link
;
1452 /* FIXME: Should we install iheader->sh_link
1453 if we could not find a match ? */
1455 /* xgettext:c-format */
1456 (_("%pB: failed to find link section for section %d"), obfd
, secnum
);
1459 if (iheader
->sh_info
)
1461 /* The sh_info field can hold arbitrary information, but if the
1462 SHF_LINK_INFO flag is set then it should be interpreted as a
1464 if (iheader
->sh_flags
& SHF_INFO_LINK
)
1466 sh_link
= find_link (obfd
, iheaders
[iheader
->sh_info
],
1468 if (sh_link
!= SHN_UNDEF
)
1469 oheader
->sh_flags
|= SHF_INFO_LINK
;
1472 /* No idea what it means - just copy it. */
1473 sh_link
= iheader
->sh_info
;
1475 if (sh_link
!= SHN_UNDEF
)
1477 oheader
->sh_info
= sh_link
;
1482 /* xgettext:c-format */
1483 (_("%pB: failed to find info section for section %d"), obfd
, secnum
);
1489 /* Copy the program header and other data from one object module to
1493 _bfd_elf_copy_private_bfd_data (bfd
*ibfd
, bfd
*obfd
)
1495 const Elf_Internal_Shdr
**iheaders
= (const Elf_Internal_Shdr
**) elf_elfsections (ibfd
);
1496 Elf_Internal_Shdr
**oheaders
= elf_elfsections (obfd
);
1497 const struct elf_backend_data
*bed
;
1500 if (bfd_get_flavour (ibfd
) != bfd_target_elf_flavour
1501 || bfd_get_flavour (obfd
) != bfd_target_elf_flavour
)
1504 if (!elf_flags_init (obfd
))
1506 elf_elfheader (obfd
)->e_flags
= elf_elfheader (ibfd
)->e_flags
;
1507 elf_flags_init (obfd
) = TRUE
;
1510 elf_gp (obfd
) = elf_gp (ibfd
);
1512 /* Also copy the EI_OSABI field. */
1513 elf_elfheader (obfd
)->e_ident
[EI_OSABI
] =
1514 elf_elfheader (ibfd
)->e_ident
[EI_OSABI
];
1516 /* If set, copy the EI_ABIVERSION field. */
1517 if (elf_elfheader (ibfd
)->e_ident
[EI_ABIVERSION
])
1518 elf_elfheader (obfd
)->e_ident
[EI_ABIVERSION
]
1519 = elf_elfheader (ibfd
)->e_ident
[EI_ABIVERSION
];
1521 /* Copy object attributes. */
1522 _bfd_elf_copy_obj_attributes (ibfd
, obfd
);
1524 if (iheaders
== NULL
|| oheaders
== NULL
)
1527 bed
= get_elf_backend_data (obfd
);
1529 /* Possibly copy other fields in the section header. */
1530 for (i
= 1; i
< elf_numsections (obfd
); i
++)
1533 Elf_Internal_Shdr
* oheader
= oheaders
[i
];
1535 /* Ignore ordinary sections. SHT_NOBITS sections are considered however
1536 because of a special case need for generating separate debug info
1537 files. See below for more details. */
1539 || (oheader
->sh_type
!= SHT_NOBITS
1540 && oheader
->sh_type
< SHT_LOOS
))
1543 /* Ignore empty sections, and sections whose
1544 fields have already been initialised. */
1545 if (oheader
->sh_size
== 0
1546 || (oheader
->sh_info
!= 0 && oheader
->sh_link
!= 0))
1549 /* Scan for the matching section in the input bfd.
1550 First we try for a direct mapping between the input and output sections. */
1551 for (j
= 1; j
< elf_numsections (ibfd
); j
++)
1553 const Elf_Internal_Shdr
* iheader
= iheaders
[j
];
1555 if (iheader
== NULL
)
1558 if (oheader
->bfd_section
!= NULL
1559 && iheader
->bfd_section
!= NULL
1560 && iheader
->bfd_section
->output_section
!= NULL
1561 && iheader
->bfd_section
->output_section
== oheader
->bfd_section
)
1563 /* We have found a connection from the input section to the
1564 output section. Attempt to copy the header fields. If
1565 this fails then do not try any further sections - there
1566 should only be a one-to-one mapping between input and output. */
1567 if (! copy_special_section_fields (ibfd
, obfd
, iheader
, oheader
, i
))
1568 j
= elf_numsections (ibfd
);
1573 if (j
< elf_numsections (ibfd
))
1576 /* That failed. So try to deduce the corresponding input section.
1577 Unfortunately we cannot compare names as the output string table
1578 is empty, so instead we check size, address and type. */
1579 for (j
= 1; j
< elf_numsections (ibfd
); j
++)
1581 const Elf_Internal_Shdr
* iheader
= iheaders
[j
];
1583 if (iheader
== NULL
)
1586 /* Try matching fields in the input section's header.
1587 Since --only-keep-debug turns all non-debug sections into
1588 SHT_NOBITS sections, the output SHT_NOBITS type matches any
1590 if ((oheader
->sh_type
== SHT_NOBITS
1591 || iheader
->sh_type
== oheader
->sh_type
)
1592 && (iheader
->sh_flags
& ~ SHF_INFO_LINK
)
1593 == (oheader
->sh_flags
& ~ SHF_INFO_LINK
)
1594 && iheader
->sh_addralign
== oheader
->sh_addralign
1595 && iheader
->sh_entsize
== oheader
->sh_entsize
1596 && iheader
->sh_size
== oheader
->sh_size
1597 && iheader
->sh_addr
== oheader
->sh_addr
1598 && (iheader
->sh_info
!= oheader
->sh_info
1599 || iheader
->sh_link
!= oheader
->sh_link
))
1601 if (copy_special_section_fields (ibfd
, obfd
, iheader
, oheader
, i
))
1606 if (j
== elf_numsections (ibfd
) && oheader
->sh_type
>= SHT_LOOS
)
1608 /* Final attempt. Call the backend copy function
1609 with a NULL input section. */
1610 (void) bed
->elf_backend_copy_special_section_fields (ibfd
, obfd
,
1619 get_segment_type (unsigned int p_type
)
1624 case PT_NULL
: pt
= "NULL"; break;
1625 case PT_LOAD
: pt
= "LOAD"; break;
1626 case PT_DYNAMIC
: pt
= "DYNAMIC"; break;
1627 case PT_INTERP
: pt
= "INTERP"; break;
1628 case PT_NOTE
: pt
= "NOTE"; break;
1629 case PT_SHLIB
: pt
= "SHLIB"; break;
1630 case PT_PHDR
: pt
= "PHDR"; break;
1631 case PT_TLS
: pt
= "TLS"; break;
1632 case PT_GNU_EH_FRAME
: pt
= "EH_FRAME"; break;
1633 case PT_GNU_STACK
: pt
= "STACK"; break;
1634 case PT_GNU_RELRO
: pt
= "RELRO"; break;
1635 default: pt
= NULL
; break;
1640 /* Print out the program headers. */
1643 _bfd_elf_print_private_bfd_data (bfd
*abfd
, void *farg
)
1645 FILE *f
= (FILE *) farg
;
1646 Elf_Internal_Phdr
*p
;
1648 bfd_byte
*dynbuf
= NULL
;
1650 p
= elf_tdata (abfd
)->phdr
;
1655 fprintf (f
, _("\nProgram Header:\n"));
1656 c
= elf_elfheader (abfd
)->e_phnum
;
1657 for (i
= 0; i
< c
; i
++, p
++)
1659 const char *pt
= get_segment_type (p
->p_type
);
1664 sprintf (buf
, "0x%lx", p
->p_type
);
1667 fprintf (f
, "%8s off 0x", pt
);
1668 bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd
, f
, p
->p_offset
);
1669 fprintf (f
, " vaddr 0x");
1670 bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd
, f
, p
->p_vaddr
);
1671 fprintf (f
, " paddr 0x");
1672 bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd
, f
, p
->p_paddr
);
1673 fprintf (f
, " align 2**%u\n", bfd_log2 (p
->p_align
));
1674 fprintf (f
, " filesz 0x");
1675 bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd
, f
, p
->p_filesz
);
1676 fprintf (f
, " memsz 0x");
1677 bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd
, f
, p
->p_memsz
);
1678 fprintf (f
, " flags %c%c%c",
1679 (p
->p_flags
& PF_R
) != 0 ? 'r' : '-',
1680 (p
->p_flags
& PF_W
) != 0 ? 'w' : '-',
1681 (p
->p_flags
& PF_X
) != 0 ? 'x' : '-');
1682 if ((p
->p_flags
&~ (unsigned) (PF_R
| PF_W
| PF_X
)) != 0)
1683 fprintf (f
, " %lx", p
->p_flags
&~ (unsigned) (PF_R
| PF_W
| PF_X
));
1688 s
= bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd
, ".dynamic");
1691 unsigned int elfsec
;
1692 unsigned long shlink
;
1693 bfd_byte
*extdyn
, *extdynend
;
1695 void (*swap_dyn_in
) (bfd
*, const void *, Elf_Internal_Dyn
*);
1697 fprintf (f
, _("\nDynamic Section:\n"));
1699 if (!bfd_malloc_and_get_section (abfd
, s
, &dynbuf
))
1702 elfsec
= _bfd_elf_section_from_bfd_section (abfd
, s
);
1703 if (elfsec
== SHN_BAD
)
1705 shlink
= elf_elfsections (abfd
)[elfsec
]->sh_link
;
1707 extdynsize
= get_elf_backend_data (abfd
)->s
->sizeof_dyn
;
1708 swap_dyn_in
= get_elf_backend_data (abfd
)->s
->swap_dyn_in
;
1711 /* PR 17512: file: 6f427532. */
1712 if (s
->size
< extdynsize
)
1714 extdynend
= extdyn
+ s
->size
;
1715 /* PR 17512: file: id:000006,sig:06,src:000000,op:flip4,pos:5664.
1717 for (; extdyn
<= (extdynend
- extdynsize
); extdyn
+= extdynsize
)
1719 Elf_Internal_Dyn dyn
;
1720 const char *name
= "";
1722 bfd_boolean stringp
;
1723 const struct elf_backend_data
*bed
= get_elf_backend_data (abfd
);
1725 (*swap_dyn_in
) (abfd
, extdyn
, &dyn
);
1727 if (dyn
.d_tag
== DT_NULL
)
1734 if (bed
->elf_backend_get_target_dtag
)
1735 name
= (*bed
->elf_backend_get_target_dtag
) (dyn
.d_tag
);
1737 if (!strcmp (name
, ""))
1739 sprintf (ab
, "%#" BFD_VMA_FMT
"x", dyn
.d_tag
);
1744 case DT_NEEDED
: name
= "NEEDED"; stringp
= TRUE
; break;
1745 case DT_PLTRELSZ
: name
= "PLTRELSZ"; break;
1746 case DT_PLTGOT
: name
= "PLTGOT"; break;
1747 case DT_HASH
: name
= "HASH"; break;
1748 case DT_STRTAB
: name
= "STRTAB"; break;
1749 case DT_SYMTAB
: name
= "SYMTAB"; break;
1750 case DT_RELA
: name
= "RELA"; break;
1751 case DT_RELASZ
: name
= "RELASZ"; break;
1752 case DT_RELAENT
: name
= "RELAENT"; break;
1753 case DT_STRSZ
: name
= "STRSZ"; break;
1754 case DT_SYMENT
: name
= "SYMENT"; break;
1755 case DT_INIT
: name
= "INIT"; break;
1756 case DT_FINI
: name
= "FINI"; break;
1757 case DT_SONAME
: name
= "SONAME"; stringp
= TRUE
; break;
1758 case DT_RPATH
: name
= "RPATH"; stringp
= TRUE
; break;
1759 case DT_SYMBOLIC
: name
= "SYMBOLIC"; break;
1760 case DT_REL
: name
= "REL"; break;
1761 case DT_RELSZ
: name
= "RELSZ"; break;
1762 case DT_RELENT
: name
= "RELENT"; break;
1763 case DT_PLTREL
: name
= "PLTREL"; break;
1764 case DT_DEBUG
: name
= "DEBUG"; break;
1765 case DT_TEXTREL
: name
= "TEXTREL"; break;
1766 case DT_JMPREL
: name
= "JMPREL"; break;
1767 case DT_BIND_NOW
: name
= "BIND_NOW"; break;
1768 case DT_INIT_ARRAY
: name
= "INIT_ARRAY"; break;
1769 case DT_FINI_ARRAY
: name
= "FINI_ARRAY"; break;
1770 case DT_INIT_ARRAYSZ
: name
= "INIT_ARRAYSZ"; break;
1771 case DT_FINI_ARRAYSZ
: name
= "FINI_ARRAYSZ"; break;
1772 case DT_RUNPATH
: name
= "RUNPATH"; stringp
= TRUE
; break;
1773 case DT_FLAGS
: name
= "FLAGS"; break;
1774 case DT_PREINIT_ARRAY
: name
= "PREINIT_ARRAY"; break;
1775 case DT_PREINIT_ARRAYSZ
: name
= "PREINIT_ARRAYSZ"; break;
1776 case DT_CHECKSUM
: name
= "CHECKSUM"; break;
1777 case DT_PLTPADSZ
: name
= "PLTPADSZ"; break;
1778 case DT_MOVEENT
: name
= "MOVEENT"; break;
1779 case DT_MOVESZ
: name
= "MOVESZ"; break;
1780 case DT_FEATURE
: name
= "FEATURE"; break;
1781 case DT_POSFLAG_1
: name
= "POSFLAG_1"; break;
1782 case DT_SYMINSZ
: name
= "SYMINSZ"; break;
1783 case DT_SYMINENT
: name
= "SYMINENT"; break;
1784 case DT_CONFIG
: name
= "CONFIG"; stringp
= TRUE
; break;
1785 case DT_DEPAUDIT
: name
= "DEPAUDIT"; stringp
= TRUE
; break;
1786 case DT_AUDIT
: name
= "AUDIT"; stringp
= TRUE
; break;
1787 case DT_PLTPAD
: name
= "PLTPAD"; break;
1788 case DT_MOVETAB
: name
= "MOVETAB"; break;
1789 case DT_SYMINFO
: name
= "SYMINFO"; break;
1790 case DT_RELACOUNT
: name
= "RELACOUNT"; break;
1791 case DT_RELCOUNT
: name
= "RELCOUNT"; break;
1792 case DT_FLAGS_1
: name
= "FLAGS_1"; break;
1793 case DT_VERSYM
: name
= "VERSYM"; break;
1794 case DT_VERDEF
: name
= "VERDEF"; break;
1795 case DT_VERDEFNUM
: name
= "VERDEFNUM"; break;
1796 case DT_VERNEED
: name
= "VERNEED"; break;
1797 case DT_VERNEEDNUM
: name
= "VERNEEDNUM"; break;
1798 case DT_AUXILIARY
: name
= "AUXILIARY"; stringp
= TRUE
; break;
1799 case DT_USED
: name
= "USED"; break;
1800 case DT_FILTER
: name
= "FILTER"; stringp
= TRUE
; break;
1801 case DT_GNU_HASH
: name
= "GNU_HASH"; break;
1804 fprintf (f
, " %-20s ", name
);
1808 bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd
, f
, dyn
.d_un
.d_val
);
1813 unsigned int tagv
= dyn
.d_un
.d_val
;
1815 string
= bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd
, shlink
, tagv
);
1818 fprintf (f
, "%s", string
);
1827 if ((elf_dynverdef (abfd
) != 0 && elf_tdata (abfd
)->verdef
== NULL
)
1828 || (elf_dynverref (abfd
) != 0 && elf_tdata (abfd
)->verref
== NULL
))
1830 if (! _bfd_elf_slurp_version_tables (abfd
, FALSE
))
1834 if (elf_dynverdef (abfd
) != 0)
1836 Elf_Internal_Verdef
*t
;
1838 fprintf (f
, _("\nVersion definitions:\n"));
1839 for (t
= elf_tdata (abfd
)->verdef
; t
!= NULL
; t
= t
->vd_nextdef
)
1841 fprintf (f
, "%d 0x%2.2x 0x%8.8lx %s\n", t
->vd_ndx
,
1842 t
->vd_flags
, t
->vd_hash
,
1843 t
->vd_nodename
? t
->vd_nodename
: "<corrupt>");
1844 if (t
->vd_auxptr
!= NULL
&& t
->vd_auxptr
->vda_nextptr
!= NULL
)
1846 Elf_Internal_Verdaux
*a
;
1849 for (a
= t
->vd_auxptr
->vda_nextptr
;
1853 a
->vda_nodename
? a
->vda_nodename
: "<corrupt>");
1859 if (elf_dynverref (abfd
) != 0)
1861 Elf_Internal_Verneed
*t
;
1863 fprintf (f
, _("\nVersion References:\n"));
1864 for (t
= elf_tdata (abfd
)->verref
; t
!= NULL
; t
= t
->vn_nextref
)
1866 Elf_Internal_Vernaux
*a
;
1868 fprintf (f
, _(" required from %s:\n"),
1869 t
->vn_filename
? t
->vn_filename
: "<corrupt>");
1870 for (a
= t
->vn_auxptr
; a
!= NULL
; a
= a
->vna_nextptr
)
1871 fprintf (f
, " 0x%8.8lx 0x%2.2x %2.2d %s\n", a
->vna_hash
,
1872 a
->vna_flags
, a
->vna_other
,
1873 a
->vna_nodename
? a
->vna_nodename
: "<corrupt>");
1884 /* Get version name. If BASE_P is TRUE, return "Base" for VER_FLG_BASE
1885 and return symbol version for symbol version itself. */
1888 _bfd_elf_get_symbol_version_string (bfd
*abfd
, asymbol
*symbol
,
1890 bfd_boolean
*hidden
)
1892 const char *version_string
= NULL
;
1893 if (elf_dynversym (abfd
) != 0
1894 && (elf_dynverdef (abfd
) != 0 || elf_dynverref (abfd
) != 0))
1896 unsigned int vernum
= ((elf_symbol_type
*) symbol
)->version
;
1898 *hidden
= (vernum
& VERSYM_HIDDEN
) != 0;
1899 vernum
&= VERSYM_VERSION
;
1902 version_string
= "";
1903 else if (vernum
== 1
1904 && (vernum
> elf_tdata (abfd
)->cverdefs
1905 || (elf_tdata (abfd
)->verdef
[0].vd_flags
1907 version_string
= base_p
? "Base" : "";
1908 else if (vernum
<= elf_tdata (abfd
)->cverdefs
)
1910 const char *nodename
1911 = elf_tdata (abfd
)->verdef
[vernum
- 1].vd_nodename
;
1912 version_string
= "";
1915 || symbol
->name
== NULL
1916 || strcmp (symbol
->name
, nodename
) != 0)
1917 version_string
= nodename
;
1921 Elf_Internal_Verneed
*t
;
1923 version_string
= _("<corrupt>");
1924 for (t
= elf_tdata (abfd
)->verref
;
1928 Elf_Internal_Vernaux
*a
;
1930 for (a
= t
->vn_auxptr
; a
!= NULL
; a
= a
->vna_nextptr
)
1932 if (a
->vna_other
== vernum
)
1934 version_string
= a
->vna_nodename
;
1941 return version_string
;
1944 /* Display ELF-specific fields of a symbol. */
1947 bfd_elf_print_symbol (bfd
*abfd
,
1950 bfd_print_symbol_type how
)
1952 FILE *file
= (FILE *) filep
;
1955 case bfd_print_symbol_name
:
1956 fprintf (file
, "%s", symbol
->name
);
1958 case bfd_print_symbol_more
:
1959 fprintf (file
, "elf ");
1960 bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd
, file
, symbol
->value
);
1961 fprintf (file
, " %x", symbol
->flags
);
1963 case bfd_print_symbol_all
:
1965 const char *section_name
;
1966 const char *name
= NULL
;
1967 const struct elf_backend_data
*bed
;
1968 unsigned char st_other
;
1970 const char *version_string
;
1973 section_name
= symbol
->section
? symbol
->section
->name
: "(*none*)";
1975 bed
= get_elf_backend_data (abfd
);
1976 if (bed
->elf_backend_print_symbol_all
)
1977 name
= (*bed
->elf_backend_print_symbol_all
) (abfd
, filep
, symbol
);
1981 name
= symbol
->name
;
1982 bfd_print_symbol_vandf (abfd
, file
, symbol
);
1985 fprintf (file
, " %s\t", section_name
);
1986 /* Print the "other" value for a symbol. For common symbols,
1987 we've already printed the size; now print the alignment.
1988 For other symbols, we have no specified alignment, and
1989 we've printed the address; now print the size. */
1990 if (symbol
->section
&& bfd_is_com_section (symbol
->section
))
1991 val
= ((elf_symbol_type
*) symbol
)->internal_elf_sym
.st_value
;
1993 val
= ((elf_symbol_type
*) symbol
)->internal_elf_sym
.st_size
;
1994 bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd
, file
, val
);
1996 /* If we have version information, print it. */
1997 version_string
= _bfd_elf_get_symbol_version_string (abfd
,
2004 fprintf (file
, " %-11s", version_string
);
2009 fprintf (file
, " (%s)", version_string
);
2010 for (i
= 10 - strlen (version_string
); i
> 0; --i
)
2015 /* If the st_other field is not zero, print it. */
2016 st_other
= ((elf_symbol_type
*) symbol
)->internal_elf_sym
.st_other
;
2021 case STV_INTERNAL
: fprintf (file
, " .internal"); break;
2022 case STV_HIDDEN
: fprintf (file
, " .hidden"); break;
2023 case STV_PROTECTED
: fprintf (file
, " .protected"); break;
2025 /* Some other non-defined flags are also present, so print
2027 fprintf (file
, " 0x%02x", (unsigned int) st_other
);
2030 fprintf (file
, " %s", name
);
2036 /* ELF .o/exec file reading */
2038 /* Create a new bfd section from an ELF section header. */
2041 bfd_section_from_shdr (bfd
*abfd
, unsigned int shindex
)
2043 Elf_Internal_Shdr
*hdr
;
2044 Elf_Internal_Ehdr
*ehdr
;
2045 const struct elf_backend_data
*bed
;
2047 bfd_boolean ret
= TRUE
;
2048 static bfd_boolean
* sections_being_created
= NULL
;
2049 static bfd
* sections_being_created_abfd
= NULL
;
2050 static unsigned int nesting
= 0;
2052 if (shindex
>= elf_numsections (abfd
))
2057 /* PR17512: A corrupt ELF binary might contain a recursive group of
2058 sections, with each the string indices pointing to the next in the
2059 loop. Detect this here, by refusing to load a section that we are
2060 already in the process of loading. We only trigger this test if
2061 we have nested at least three sections deep as normal ELF binaries
2062 can expect to recurse at least once.
2064 FIXME: It would be better if this array was attached to the bfd,
2065 rather than being held in a static pointer. */
2067 if (sections_being_created_abfd
!= abfd
)
2069 free (sections_being_created
);
2070 sections_being_created
= NULL
;
2072 if (sections_being_created
== NULL
)
2074 size_t amt
= elf_numsections (abfd
) * sizeof (bfd_boolean
);
2076 /* PR 26005: Do not use bfd_zalloc here as the memory might
2077 be released before the bfd has been fully scanned. */
2078 sections_being_created
= (bfd_boolean
*) bfd_zmalloc (amt
);
2079 if (sections_being_created
== NULL
)
2081 sections_being_created_abfd
= abfd
;
2083 if (sections_being_created
[shindex
])
2086 (_("%pB: warning: loop in section dependencies detected"), abfd
);
2089 sections_being_created
[shindex
] = TRUE
;
2092 hdr
= elf_elfsections (abfd
)[shindex
];
2093 ehdr
= elf_elfheader (abfd
);
2094 name
= bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd
, ehdr
->e_shstrndx
,
2099 bed
= get_elf_backend_data (abfd
);
2100 switch (hdr
->sh_type
)
2103 /* Inactive section. Throw it away. */
2106 case SHT_PROGBITS
: /* Normal section with contents. */
2107 case SHT_NOBITS
: /* .bss section. */
2108 case SHT_HASH
: /* .hash section. */
2109 case SHT_NOTE
: /* .note section. */
2110 case SHT_INIT_ARRAY
: /* .init_array section. */
2111 case SHT_FINI_ARRAY
: /* .fini_array section. */
2112 case SHT_PREINIT_ARRAY
: /* .preinit_array section. */
2113 case SHT_GNU_LIBLIST
: /* .gnu.liblist section. */
2114 case SHT_GNU_HASH
: /* .gnu.hash section. */
2115 ret
= _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd
, hdr
, name
, shindex
);
2118 case SHT_DYNAMIC
: /* Dynamic linking information. */
2119 if (! _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd
, hdr
, name
, shindex
))
2122 if (hdr
->sh_link
> elf_numsections (abfd
))
2124 /* PR 10478: Accept Solaris binaries with a sh_link
2125 field set to SHN_BEFORE or SHN_AFTER. */
2126 switch (bfd_get_arch (abfd
))
2129 case bfd_arch_sparc
:
2130 if (hdr
->sh_link
== (SHN_LORESERVE
& 0xffff) /* SHN_BEFORE */
2131 || hdr
->sh_link
== ((SHN_LORESERVE
+ 1) & 0xffff) /* SHN_AFTER */)
2133 /* Otherwise fall through. */
2138 else if (elf_elfsections (abfd
)[hdr
->sh_link
] == NULL
)
2140 else if (elf_elfsections (abfd
)[hdr
->sh_link
]->sh_type
!= SHT_STRTAB
)
2142 Elf_Internal_Shdr
*dynsymhdr
;
2144 /* The shared libraries distributed with hpux11 have a bogus
2145 sh_link field for the ".dynamic" section. Find the
2146 string table for the ".dynsym" section instead. */
2147 if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd
) != 0)
2149 dynsymhdr
= elf_elfsections (abfd
)[elf_dynsymtab (abfd
)];
2150 hdr
->sh_link
= dynsymhdr
->sh_link
;
2154 unsigned int i
, num_sec
;
2156 num_sec
= elf_numsections (abfd
);
2157 for (i
= 1; i
< num_sec
; i
++)
2159 dynsymhdr
= elf_elfsections (abfd
)[i
];
2160 if (dynsymhdr
->sh_type
== SHT_DYNSYM
)
2162 hdr
->sh_link
= dynsymhdr
->sh_link
;
2170 case SHT_SYMTAB
: /* A symbol table. */
2171 if (elf_onesymtab (abfd
) == shindex
)
2174 if (hdr
->sh_entsize
!= bed
->s
->sizeof_sym
)
2177 if (hdr
->sh_info
* hdr
->sh_entsize
> hdr
->sh_size
)
2179 if (hdr
->sh_size
!= 0)
2181 /* Some assemblers erroneously set sh_info to one with a
2182 zero sh_size. ld sees this as a global symbol count
2183 of (unsigned) -1. Fix it here. */
2188 /* PR 18854: A binary might contain more than one symbol table.
2189 Unusual, but possible. Warn, but continue. */
2190 if (elf_onesymtab (abfd
) != 0)
2193 /* xgettext:c-format */
2194 (_("%pB: warning: multiple symbol tables detected"
2195 " - ignoring the table in section %u"),
2199 elf_onesymtab (abfd
) = shindex
;
2200 elf_symtab_hdr (abfd
) = *hdr
;
2201 elf_elfsections (abfd
)[shindex
] = hdr
= & elf_symtab_hdr (abfd
);
2202 abfd
->flags
|= HAS_SYMS
;
2204 /* Sometimes a shared object will map in the symbol table. If
2205 SHF_ALLOC is set, and this is a shared object, then we also
2206 treat this section as a BFD section. We can not base the
2207 decision purely on SHF_ALLOC, because that flag is sometimes
2208 set in a relocatable object file, which would confuse the
2210 if ((hdr
->sh_flags
& SHF_ALLOC
) != 0
2211 && (abfd
->flags
& DYNAMIC
) != 0
2212 && ! _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd
, hdr
, name
,
2216 /* Go looking for SHT_SYMTAB_SHNDX too, since if there is one we
2217 can't read symbols without that section loaded as well. It
2218 is most likely specified by the next section header. */
2220 elf_section_list
* entry
;
2221 unsigned int i
, num_sec
;
2223 for (entry
= elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd
); entry
!= NULL
; entry
= entry
->next
)
2224 if (entry
->hdr
.sh_link
== shindex
)
2227 num_sec
= elf_numsections (abfd
);
2228 for (i
= shindex
+ 1; i
< num_sec
; i
++)
2230 Elf_Internal_Shdr
*hdr2
= elf_elfsections (abfd
)[i
];
2232 if (hdr2
->sh_type
== SHT_SYMTAB_SHNDX
2233 && hdr2
->sh_link
== shindex
)
2238 for (i
= 1; i
< shindex
; i
++)
2240 Elf_Internal_Shdr
*hdr2
= elf_elfsections (abfd
)[i
];
2242 if (hdr2
->sh_type
== SHT_SYMTAB_SHNDX
2243 && hdr2
->sh_link
== shindex
)
2248 ret
= bfd_section_from_shdr (abfd
, i
);
2249 /* else FIXME: we have failed to find the symbol table - should we issue an error ? */
2253 case SHT_DYNSYM
: /* A dynamic symbol table. */
2254 if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd
) == shindex
)
2257 if (hdr
->sh_entsize
!= bed
->s
->sizeof_sym
)
2260 if (hdr
->sh_info
* hdr
->sh_entsize
> hdr
->sh_size
)
2262 if (hdr
->sh_size
!= 0)
2265 /* Some linkers erroneously set sh_info to one with a
2266 zero sh_size. ld sees this as a global symbol count
2267 of (unsigned) -1. Fix it here. */
2272 /* PR 18854: A binary might contain more than one dynamic symbol table.
2273 Unusual, but possible. Warn, but continue. */
2274 if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd
) != 0)
2277 /* xgettext:c-format */
2278 (_("%pB: warning: multiple dynamic symbol tables detected"
2279 " - ignoring the table in section %u"),
2283 elf_dynsymtab (abfd
) = shindex
;
2284 elf_tdata (abfd
)->dynsymtab_hdr
= *hdr
;
2285 elf_elfsections (abfd
)[shindex
] = hdr
= &elf_tdata (abfd
)->dynsymtab_hdr
;
2286 abfd
->flags
|= HAS_SYMS
;
2288 /* Besides being a symbol table, we also treat this as a regular
2289 section, so that objcopy can handle it. */
2290 ret
= _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd
, hdr
, name
, shindex
);
2293 case SHT_SYMTAB_SHNDX
: /* Symbol section indices when >64k sections. */
2295 elf_section_list
* entry
;
2297 for (entry
= elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd
); entry
!= NULL
; entry
= entry
->next
)
2298 if (entry
->ndx
== shindex
)
2301 entry
= bfd_alloc (abfd
, sizeof (*entry
));
2304 entry
->ndx
= shindex
;
2306 entry
->next
= elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd
);
2307 elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd
) = entry
;
2308 elf_elfsections (abfd
)[shindex
] = & entry
->hdr
;
2312 case SHT_STRTAB
: /* A string table. */
2313 if (hdr
->bfd_section
!= NULL
)
2316 if (ehdr
->e_shstrndx
== shindex
)
2318 elf_tdata (abfd
)->shstrtab_hdr
= *hdr
;
2319 elf_elfsections (abfd
)[shindex
] = &elf_tdata (abfd
)->shstrtab_hdr
;
2323 if (elf_elfsections (abfd
)[elf_onesymtab (abfd
)]->sh_link
== shindex
)
2326 elf_tdata (abfd
)->strtab_hdr
= *hdr
;
2327 elf_elfsections (abfd
)[shindex
] = &elf_tdata (abfd
)->strtab_hdr
;
2331 if (elf_elfsections (abfd
)[elf_dynsymtab (abfd
)]->sh_link
== shindex
)
2334 elf_tdata (abfd
)->dynstrtab_hdr
= *hdr
;
2335 hdr
= &elf_tdata (abfd
)->dynstrtab_hdr
;
2336 elf_elfsections (abfd
)[shindex
] = hdr
;
2337 /* We also treat this as a regular section, so that objcopy
2339 ret
= _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd
, hdr
, name
,
2344 /* If the string table isn't one of the above, then treat it as a
2345 regular section. We need to scan all the headers to be sure,
2346 just in case this strtab section appeared before the above. */
2347 if (elf_onesymtab (abfd
) == 0 || elf_dynsymtab (abfd
) == 0)
2349 unsigned int i
, num_sec
;
2351 num_sec
= elf_numsections (abfd
);
2352 for (i
= 1; i
< num_sec
; i
++)
2354 Elf_Internal_Shdr
*hdr2
= elf_elfsections (abfd
)[i
];
2355 if (hdr2
->sh_link
== shindex
)
2357 /* Prevent endless recursion on broken objects. */
2360 if (! bfd_section_from_shdr (abfd
, i
))
2362 if (elf_onesymtab (abfd
) == i
)
2364 if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd
) == i
)
2365 goto dynsymtab_strtab
;
2369 ret
= _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd
, hdr
, name
, shindex
);
2374 /* *These* do a lot of work -- but build no sections! */
2376 asection
*target_sect
;
2377 Elf_Internal_Shdr
*hdr2
, **p_hdr
;
2378 unsigned int num_sec
= elf_numsections (abfd
);
2379 struct bfd_elf_section_data
*esdt
;
2382 != (bfd_size_type
) (hdr
->sh_type
== SHT_REL
2383 ? bed
->s
->sizeof_rel
: bed
->s
->sizeof_rela
))
2386 /* Check for a bogus link to avoid crashing. */
2387 if (hdr
->sh_link
>= num_sec
)
2390 /* xgettext:c-format */
2391 (_("%pB: invalid link %u for reloc section %s (index %u)"),
2392 abfd
, hdr
->sh_link
, name
, shindex
);
2393 ret
= _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd
, hdr
, name
,
2398 /* For some incomprehensible reason Oracle distributes
2399 libraries for Solaris in which some of the objects have
2400 bogus sh_link fields. It would be nice if we could just
2401 reject them, but, unfortunately, some people need to use
2402 them. We scan through the section headers; if we find only
2403 one suitable symbol table, we clobber the sh_link to point
2404 to it. I hope this doesn't break anything.
2406 Don't do it on executable nor shared library. */
2407 if ((abfd
->flags
& (DYNAMIC
| EXEC_P
)) == 0
2408 && elf_elfsections (abfd
)[hdr
->sh_link
]->sh_type
!= SHT_SYMTAB
2409 && elf_elfsections (abfd
)[hdr
->sh_link
]->sh_type
!= SHT_DYNSYM
)
2415 for (scan
= 1; scan
< num_sec
; scan
++)
2417 if (elf_elfsections (abfd
)[scan
]->sh_type
== SHT_SYMTAB
2418 || elf_elfsections (abfd
)[scan
]->sh_type
== SHT_DYNSYM
)
2429 hdr
->sh_link
= found
;
2432 /* Get the symbol table. */
2433 if ((elf_elfsections (abfd
)[hdr
->sh_link
]->sh_type
== SHT_SYMTAB
2434 || elf_elfsections (abfd
)[hdr
->sh_link
]->sh_type
== SHT_DYNSYM
)
2435 && ! bfd_section_from_shdr (abfd
, hdr
->sh_link
))
2438 /* If this is an alloc section in an executable or shared
2439 library, or the reloc section does not use the main symbol
2440 table we don't treat it as a reloc section. BFD can't
2441 adequately represent such a section, so at least for now,
2442 we don't try. We just present it as a normal section. We
2443 also can't use it as a reloc section if it points to the
2444 null section, an invalid section, another reloc section, or
2445 its sh_link points to the null section. */
2446 if (((abfd
->flags
& (DYNAMIC
| EXEC_P
)) != 0
2447 && (hdr
->sh_flags
& SHF_ALLOC
) != 0)
2448 || hdr
->sh_link
== SHN_UNDEF
2449 || hdr
->sh_link
!= elf_onesymtab (abfd
)
2450 || hdr
->sh_info
== SHN_UNDEF
2451 || hdr
->sh_info
>= num_sec
2452 || elf_elfsections (abfd
)[hdr
->sh_info
]->sh_type
== SHT_REL
2453 || elf_elfsections (abfd
)[hdr
->sh_info
]->sh_type
== SHT_RELA
)
2455 ret
= _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd
, hdr
, name
,
2460 if (! bfd_section_from_shdr (abfd
, hdr
->sh_info
))
2463 target_sect
= bfd_section_from_elf_index (abfd
, hdr
->sh_info
);
2464 if (target_sect
== NULL
)
2467 esdt
= elf_section_data (target_sect
);
2468 if (hdr
->sh_type
== SHT_RELA
)
2469 p_hdr
= &esdt
->rela
.hdr
;
2471 p_hdr
= &esdt
->rel
.hdr
;
2473 /* PR 17512: file: 0b4f81b7.
2474 Also see PR 24456, for a file which deliberately has two reloc
2478 if (!bed
->init_secondary_reloc_section (abfd
, hdr
, name
, shindex
))
2481 /* xgettext:c-format */
2482 (_("%pB: warning: secondary relocation section '%s' "
2483 "for section %pA found - ignoring"),
2484 abfd
, name
, target_sect
);
2489 hdr2
= (Elf_Internal_Shdr
*) bfd_alloc (abfd
, sizeof (*hdr2
));
2494 elf_elfsections (abfd
)[shindex
] = hdr2
;
2495 target_sect
->reloc_count
+= (NUM_SHDR_ENTRIES (hdr
)
2496 * bed
->s
->int_rels_per_ext_rel
);
2497 target_sect
->flags
|= SEC_RELOC
;
2498 target_sect
->relocation
= NULL
;
2499 target_sect
->rel_filepos
= hdr
->sh_offset
;
2500 /* In the section to which the relocations apply, mark whether
2501 its relocations are of the REL or RELA variety. */
2502 if (hdr
->sh_size
!= 0)
2504 if (hdr
->sh_type
== SHT_RELA
)
2505 target_sect
->use_rela_p
= 1;
2507 abfd
->flags
|= HAS_RELOC
;
2511 case SHT_GNU_verdef
:
2512 elf_dynverdef (abfd
) = shindex
;
2513 elf_tdata (abfd
)->dynverdef_hdr
= *hdr
;
2514 ret
= _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd
, hdr
, name
, shindex
);
2517 case SHT_GNU_versym
:
2518 if (hdr
->sh_entsize
!= sizeof (Elf_External_Versym
))
2521 elf_dynversym (abfd
) = shindex
;
2522 elf_tdata (abfd
)->dynversym_hdr
= *hdr
;
2523 ret
= _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd
, hdr
, name
, shindex
);
2526 case SHT_GNU_verneed
:
2527 elf_dynverref (abfd
) = shindex
;
2528 elf_tdata (abfd
)->dynverref_hdr
= *hdr
;
2529 ret
= _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd
, hdr
, name
, shindex
);
2536 if (! IS_VALID_GROUP_SECTION_HEADER (hdr
, GRP_ENTRY_SIZE
))
2539 if (!_bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd
, hdr
, name
, shindex
))
2545 /* Possibly an attributes section. */
2546 if (hdr
->sh_type
== SHT_GNU_ATTRIBUTES
2547 || hdr
->sh_type
== bed
->obj_attrs_section_type
)
2549 if (! _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd
, hdr
, name
, shindex
))
2551 _bfd_elf_parse_attributes (abfd
, hdr
);
2555 /* Check for any processor-specific section types. */
2556 if (bed
->elf_backend_section_from_shdr (abfd
, hdr
, name
, shindex
))
2559 if (hdr
->sh_type
>= SHT_LOUSER
&& hdr
->sh_type
<= SHT_HIUSER
)
2561 if ((hdr
->sh_flags
& SHF_ALLOC
) != 0)
2562 /* FIXME: How to properly handle allocated section reserved
2563 for applications? */
2565 /* xgettext:c-format */
2566 (_("%pB: unknown type [%#x] section `%s'"),
2567 abfd
, hdr
->sh_type
, name
);
2570 /* Allow sections reserved for applications. */
2571 ret
= _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd
, hdr
, name
,
2576 else if (hdr
->sh_type
>= SHT_LOPROC
2577 && hdr
->sh_type
<= SHT_HIPROC
)
2578 /* FIXME: We should handle this section. */
2580 /* xgettext:c-format */
2581 (_("%pB: unknown type [%#x] section `%s'"),
2582 abfd
, hdr
->sh_type
, name
);
2583 else if (hdr
->sh_type
>= SHT_LOOS
&& hdr
->sh_type
<= SHT_HIOS
)
2585 /* Unrecognised OS-specific sections. */
2586 if ((hdr
->sh_flags
& SHF_OS_NONCONFORMING
) != 0)
2587 /* SHF_OS_NONCONFORMING indicates that special knowledge is
2588 required to correctly process the section and the file should
2589 be rejected with an error message. */
2591 /* xgettext:c-format */
2592 (_("%pB: unknown type [%#x] section `%s'"),
2593 abfd
, hdr
->sh_type
, name
);
2596 /* Otherwise it should be processed. */
2597 ret
= _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd
, hdr
, name
, shindex
);
2602 /* FIXME: We should handle this section. */
2604 /* xgettext:c-format */
2605 (_("%pB: unknown type [%#x] section `%s'"),
2606 abfd
, hdr
->sh_type
, name
);
2614 if (sections_being_created
&& sections_being_created_abfd
== abfd
)
2615 sections_being_created
[shindex
] = FALSE
;
2616 if (-- nesting
== 0)
2618 free (sections_being_created
);
2619 sections_being_created
= NULL
;
2620 sections_being_created_abfd
= NULL
;
2625 /* Return the local symbol specified by ABFD, R_SYMNDX. */
2628 bfd_sym_from_r_symndx (struct sym_cache
*cache
,
2630 unsigned long r_symndx
)
2632 unsigned int ent
= r_symndx
% LOCAL_SYM_CACHE_SIZE
;
2634 if (cache
->abfd
!= abfd
|| cache
->indx
[ent
] != r_symndx
)
2636 Elf_Internal_Shdr
*symtab_hdr
;
2637 unsigned char esym
[sizeof (Elf64_External_Sym
)];
2638 Elf_External_Sym_Shndx eshndx
;
2640 symtab_hdr
= &elf_tdata (abfd
)->symtab_hdr
;
2641 if (bfd_elf_get_elf_syms (abfd
, symtab_hdr
, 1, r_symndx
,
2642 &cache
->sym
[ent
], esym
, &eshndx
) == NULL
)
2645 if (cache
->abfd
!= abfd
)
2647 memset (cache
->indx
, -1, sizeof (cache
->indx
));
2650 cache
->indx
[ent
] = r_symndx
;
2653 return &cache
->sym
[ent
];
2656 /* Given an ELF section number, retrieve the corresponding BFD
2660 bfd_section_from_elf_index (bfd
*abfd
, unsigned int sec_index
)
2662 if (sec_index
>= elf_numsections (abfd
))
2664 return elf_elfsections (abfd
)[sec_index
]->bfd_section
;
2667 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_b
[] =
2669 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".bss"), -2, SHT_NOBITS
, SHF_ALLOC
+ SHF_WRITE
},
2670 { NULL
, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2673 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_c
[] =
2675 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".comment"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS
, 0 },
2676 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".ctf"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS
, 0 },
2677 { NULL
, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2680 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_d
[] =
2682 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".data"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS
, SHF_ALLOC
+ SHF_WRITE
},
2683 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".data1"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS
, SHF_ALLOC
+ SHF_WRITE
},
2684 /* There are more DWARF sections than these, but they needn't be added here
2685 unless you have to cope with broken compilers that don't emit section
2686 attributes or you want to help the user writing assembler. */
2687 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".debug"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS
, 0 },
2688 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".debug_line"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS
, 0 },
2689 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".debug_info"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS
, 0 },
2690 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".debug_abbrev"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS
, 0 },
2691 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".debug_aranges"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS
, 0 },
2692 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".dynamic"), 0, SHT_DYNAMIC
, SHF_ALLOC
},
2693 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".dynstr"), 0, SHT_STRTAB
, SHF_ALLOC
},
2694 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".dynsym"), 0, SHT_DYNSYM
, SHF_ALLOC
},
2695 { NULL
, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2698 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_f
[] =
2700 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".fini"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS
, SHF_ALLOC
+ SHF_EXECINSTR
},
2701 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".fini_array"), -2, SHT_FINI_ARRAY
, SHF_ALLOC
+ SHF_WRITE
},
2702 { NULL
, 0 , 0, 0, 0 }
2705 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_g
[] =
2707 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.linkonce.b"), -2, SHT_NOBITS
, SHF_ALLOC
+ SHF_WRITE
},
2708 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.linkonce.n"), -2, SHT_NOBITS
, SHF_ALLOC
+ SHF_WRITE
},
2709 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.linkonce.p"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS
, SHF_ALLOC
+ SHF_WRITE
},
2710 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.lto_"), -1, SHT_PROGBITS
, SHF_EXCLUDE
},
2711 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".got"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS
, SHF_ALLOC
+ SHF_WRITE
},
2712 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.version"), 0, SHT_GNU_versym
, 0 },
2713 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.version_d"), 0, SHT_GNU_verdef
, 0 },
2714 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.version_r"), 0, SHT_GNU_verneed
, 0 },
2715 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.liblist"), 0, SHT_GNU_LIBLIST
, SHF_ALLOC
},
2716 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.conflict"), 0, SHT_RELA
, SHF_ALLOC
},
2717 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.hash"), 0, SHT_GNU_HASH
, SHF_ALLOC
},
2718 { NULL
, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2721 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_h
[] =
2723 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".hash"), 0, SHT_HASH
, SHF_ALLOC
},
2724 { NULL
, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2727 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_i
[] =
2729 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".init"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS
, SHF_ALLOC
+ SHF_EXECINSTR
},
2730 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".init_array"), -2, SHT_INIT_ARRAY
, SHF_ALLOC
+ SHF_WRITE
},
2731 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".interp"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS
, 0 },
2732 { NULL
, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2735 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_l
[] =
2737 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".line"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS
, 0 },
2738 { NULL
, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2741 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_n
[] =
2743 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".noinit"), -2, SHT_NOBITS
, SHF_ALLOC
+ SHF_WRITE
},
2744 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".note.GNU-stack"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS
, 0 },
2745 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".note"), -1, SHT_NOTE
, 0 },
2746 { NULL
, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2749 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_p
[] =
2751 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".persistent"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS
, SHF_ALLOC
+ SHF_WRITE
},
2752 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".preinit_array"), -2, SHT_PREINIT_ARRAY
, SHF_ALLOC
+ SHF_WRITE
},
2753 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".plt"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS
, SHF_ALLOC
+ SHF_EXECINSTR
},
2754 { NULL
, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2757 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_r
[] =
2759 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".rodata"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS
, SHF_ALLOC
},
2760 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".rodata1"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS
, SHF_ALLOC
},
2761 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".rela"), -1, SHT_RELA
, 0 },
2762 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".rel"), -1, SHT_REL
, 0 },
2763 { NULL
, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2766 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_s
[] =
2768 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".shstrtab"), 0, SHT_STRTAB
, 0 },
2769 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".strtab"), 0, SHT_STRTAB
, 0 },
2770 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".symtab"), 0, SHT_SYMTAB
, 0 },
2771 /* See struct bfd_elf_special_section declaration for the semantics of
2772 this special case where .prefix_length != strlen (.prefix). */
2773 { ".stabstr", 5, 3, SHT_STRTAB
, 0 },
2774 { NULL
, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2777 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_t
[] =
2779 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".text"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS
, SHF_ALLOC
+ SHF_EXECINSTR
},
2780 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".tbss"), -2, SHT_NOBITS
, SHF_ALLOC
+ SHF_WRITE
+ SHF_TLS
},
2781 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".tdata"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS
, SHF_ALLOC
+ SHF_WRITE
+ SHF_TLS
},
2782 { NULL
, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2785 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_z
[] =
2787 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".zdebug_line"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS
, 0 },
2788 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".zdebug_info"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS
, 0 },
2789 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".zdebug_abbrev"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS
, 0 },
2790 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".zdebug_aranges"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS
, 0 },
2791 { NULL
, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2794 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section
* const special_sections
[] =
2796 special_sections_b
, /* 'b' */
2797 special_sections_c
, /* 'c' */
2798 special_sections_d
, /* 'd' */
2800 special_sections_f
, /* 'f' */
2801 special_sections_g
, /* 'g' */
2802 special_sections_h
, /* 'h' */
2803 special_sections_i
, /* 'i' */
2806 special_sections_l
, /* 'l' */
2808 special_sections_n
, /* 'n' */
2810 special_sections_p
, /* 'p' */
2812 special_sections_r
, /* 'r' */
2813 special_sections_s
, /* 's' */
2814 special_sections_t
, /* 't' */
2820 special_sections_z
/* 'z' */
2823 const struct bfd_elf_special_section
*
2824 _bfd_elf_get_special_section (const char *name
,
2825 const struct bfd_elf_special_section
*spec
,
2831 len
= strlen (name
);
2833 for (i
= 0; spec
[i
].prefix
!= NULL
; i
++)
2836 int prefix_len
= spec
[i
].prefix_length
;
2838 if (len
< prefix_len
)
2840 if (memcmp (name
, spec
[i
].prefix
, prefix_len
) != 0)
2843 suffix_len
= spec
[i
].suffix_length
;
2844 if (suffix_len
<= 0)
2846 if (name
[prefix_len
] != 0)
2848 if (suffix_len
== 0)
2850 if (name
[prefix_len
] != '.'
2851 && (suffix_len
== -2
2852 || (rela
&& spec
[i
].type
== SHT_REL
)))
2858 if (len
< prefix_len
+ suffix_len
)
2860 if (memcmp (name
+ len
- suffix_len
,
2861 spec
[i
].prefix
+ prefix_len
,
2871 const struct bfd_elf_special_section
*
2872 _bfd_elf_get_sec_type_attr (bfd
*abfd
, asection
*sec
)
2875 const struct bfd_elf_special_section
*spec
;
2876 const struct elf_backend_data
*bed
;
2878 /* See if this is one of the special sections. */
2879 if (sec
->name
== NULL
)
2882 bed
= get_elf_backend_data (abfd
);
2883 spec
= bed
->special_sections
;
2886 spec
= _bfd_elf_get_special_section (sec
->name
,
2887 bed
->special_sections
,
2893 if (sec
->name
[0] != '.')
2896 i
= sec
->name
[1] - 'b';
2897 if (i
< 0 || i
> 'z' - 'b')
2900 spec
= special_sections
[i
];
2905 return _bfd_elf_get_special_section (sec
->name
, spec
, sec
->use_rela_p
);
2909 _bfd_elf_new_section_hook (bfd
*abfd
, asection
*sec
)
2911 struct bfd_elf_section_data
*sdata
;
2912 const struct elf_backend_data
*bed
;
2913 const struct bfd_elf_special_section
*ssect
;
2915 sdata
= (struct bfd_elf_section_data
*) sec
->used_by_bfd
;
2918 sdata
= (struct bfd_elf_section_data
*) bfd_zalloc (abfd
,
2922 sec
->used_by_bfd
= sdata
;
2925 /* Indicate whether or not this section should use RELA relocations. */
2926 bed
= get_elf_backend_data (abfd
);
2927 sec
->use_rela_p
= bed
->default_use_rela_p
;
2929 /* Set up ELF section type and flags for newly created sections, if
2930 there is an ABI mandated section. */
2931 ssect
= (*bed
->get_sec_type_attr
) (abfd
, sec
);
2934 elf_section_type (sec
) = ssect
->type
;
2935 elf_section_flags (sec
) = ssect
->attr
;
2938 return _bfd_generic_new_section_hook (abfd
, sec
);
2941 /* Create a new bfd section from an ELF program header.
2943 Since program segments have no names, we generate a synthetic name
2944 of the form segment<NUM>, where NUM is generally the index in the
2945 program header table. For segments that are split (see below) we
2946 generate the names segment<NUM>a and segment<NUM>b.
2948 Note that some program segments may have a file size that is different than
2949 (less than) the memory size. All this means is that at execution the
2950 system must allocate the amount of memory specified by the memory size,
2951 but only initialize it with the first "file size" bytes read from the
2952 file. This would occur for example, with program segments consisting
2953 of combined data+bss.
2955 To handle the above situation, this routine generates TWO bfd sections
2956 for the single program segment. The first has the length specified by
2957 the file size of the segment, and the second has the length specified
2958 by the difference between the two sizes. In effect, the segment is split
2959 into its initialized and uninitialized parts.
2964 _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (bfd
*abfd
,
2965 Elf_Internal_Phdr
*hdr
,
2967 const char *type_name
)
2974 unsigned int opb
= bfd_octets_per_byte (abfd
, NULL
);
2976 split
= ((hdr
->p_memsz
> 0)
2977 && (hdr
->p_filesz
> 0)
2978 && (hdr
->p_memsz
> hdr
->p_filesz
));
2980 if (hdr
->p_filesz
> 0)
2982 sprintf (namebuf
, "%s%d%s", type_name
, hdr_index
, split
? "a" : "");
2983 len
= strlen (namebuf
) + 1;
2984 name
= (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd
, len
);
2987 memcpy (name
, namebuf
, len
);
2988 newsect
= bfd_make_section (abfd
, name
);
2989 if (newsect
== NULL
)
2991 newsect
->vma
= hdr
->p_vaddr
/ opb
;
2992 newsect
->lma
= hdr
->p_paddr
/ opb
;
2993 newsect
->size
= hdr
->p_filesz
;
2994 newsect
->filepos
= hdr
->p_offset
;
2995 newsect
->flags
|= SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
;
2996 newsect
->alignment_power
= bfd_log2 (hdr
->p_align
);
2997 if (hdr
->p_type
== PT_LOAD
)
2999 newsect
->flags
|= SEC_ALLOC
;
3000 newsect
->flags
|= SEC_LOAD
;
3001 if (hdr
->p_flags
& PF_X
)
3003 /* FIXME: all we known is that it has execute PERMISSION,
3005 newsect
->flags
|= SEC_CODE
;
3008 if (!(hdr
->p_flags
& PF_W
))
3010 newsect
->flags
|= SEC_READONLY
;
3014 if (hdr
->p_memsz
> hdr
->p_filesz
)
3018 sprintf (namebuf
, "%s%d%s", type_name
, hdr_index
, split
? "b" : "");
3019 len
= strlen (namebuf
) + 1;
3020 name
= (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd
, len
);
3023 memcpy (name
, namebuf
, len
);
3024 newsect
= bfd_make_section (abfd
, name
);
3025 if (newsect
== NULL
)
3027 newsect
->vma
= (hdr
->p_vaddr
+ hdr
->p_filesz
) / opb
;
3028 newsect
->lma
= (hdr
->p_paddr
+ hdr
->p_filesz
) / opb
;
3029 newsect
->size
= hdr
->p_memsz
- hdr
->p_filesz
;
3030 newsect
->filepos
= hdr
->p_offset
+ hdr
->p_filesz
;
3031 align
= newsect
->vma
& -newsect
->vma
;
3032 if (align
== 0 || align
> hdr
->p_align
)
3033 align
= hdr
->p_align
;
3034 newsect
->alignment_power
= bfd_log2 (align
);
3035 if (hdr
->p_type
== PT_LOAD
)
3037 newsect
->flags
|= SEC_ALLOC
;
3038 if (hdr
->p_flags
& PF_X
)
3039 newsect
->flags
|= SEC_CODE
;
3041 if (!(hdr
->p_flags
& PF_W
))
3042 newsect
->flags
|= SEC_READONLY
;
3049 _bfd_elf_core_find_build_id (bfd
*templ
, bfd_vma offset
)
3051 /* The return value is ignored. Build-ids are considered optional. */
3052 if (templ
->xvec
->flavour
== bfd_target_elf_flavour
)
3053 return (*get_elf_backend_data (templ
)->elf_backend_core_find_build_id
)
3059 bfd_section_from_phdr (bfd
*abfd
, Elf_Internal_Phdr
*hdr
, int hdr_index
)
3061 const struct elf_backend_data
*bed
;
3063 switch (hdr
->p_type
)
3066 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd
, hdr
, hdr_index
, "null");
3069 if (! _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd
, hdr
, hdr_index
, "load"))
3071 if (bfd_get_format (abfd
) == bfd_core
&& abfd
->build_id
== NULL
)
3072 _bfd_elf_core_find_build_id (abfd
, hdr
->p_offset
);
3076 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd
, hdr
, hdr_index
, "dynamic");
3079 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd
, hdr
, hdr_index
, "interp");
3082 if (! _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd
, hdr
, hdr_index
, "note"))
3084 if (! elf_read_notes (abfd
, hdr
->p_offset
, hdr
->p_filesz
,
3090 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd
, hdr
, hdr_index
, "shlib");
3093 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd
, hdr
, hdr_index
, "phdr");
3095 case PT_GNU_EH_FRAME
:
3096 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd
, hdr
, hdr_index
,
3100 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd
, hdr
, hdr_index
, "stack");
3103 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd
, hdr
, hdr_index
, "relro");
3106 /* Check for any processor-specific program segment types. */
3107 bed
= get_elf_backend_data (abfd
);
3108 return bed
->elf_backend_section_from_phdr (abfd
, hdr
, hdr_index
, "proc");
3112 /* Return the REL_HDR for SEC, assuming there is only a single one, either
3116 _bfd_elf_single_rel_hdr (asection
*sec
)
3118 if (elf_section_data (sec
)->rel
.hdr
)
3120 BFD_ASSERT (elf_section_data (sec
)->rela
.hdr
== NULL
);
3121 return elf_section_data (sec
)->rel
.hdr
;
3124 return elf_section_data (sec
)->rela
.hdr
;
3128 _bfd_elf_set_reloc_sh_name (bfd
*abfd
,
3129 Elf_Internal_Shdr
*rel_hdr
,
3130 const char *sec_name
,
3131 bfd_boolean use_rela_p
)
3133 char *name
= (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd
,
3134 sizeof ".rela" + strlen (sec_name
));
3138 sprintf (name
, "%s%s", use_rela_p
? ".rela" : ".rel", sec_name
);
3140 (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (elf_shstrtab (abfd
), name
,
3142 if (rel_hdr
->sh_name
== (unsigned int) -1)
3148 /* Allocate and initialize a section-header for a new reloc section,
3149 containing relocations against ASECT. It is stored in RELDATA. If
3150 USE_RELA_P is TRUE, we use RELA relocations; otherwise, we use REL
3154 _bfd_elf_init_reloc_shdr (bfd
*abfd
,
3155 struct bfd_elf_section_reloc_data
*reldata
,
3156 const char *sec_name
,
3157 bfd_boolean use_rela_p
,
3158 bfd_boolean delay_st_name_p
)
3160 Elf_Internal_Shdr
*rel_hdr
;
3161 const struct elf_backend_data
*bed
= get_elf_backend_data (abfd
);
3163 BFD_ASSERT (reldata
->hdr
== NULL
);
3164 rel_hdr
= bfd_zalloc (abfd
, sizeof (*rel_hdr
));
3165 reldata
->hdr
= rel_hdr
;
3167 if (delay_st_name_p
)
3168 rel_hdr
->sh_name
= (unsigned int) -1;
3169 else if (!_bfd_elf_set_reloc_sh_name (abfd
, rel_hdr
, sec_name
,
3172 rel_hdr
->sh_type
= use_rela_p
? SHT_RELA
: SHT_REL
;
3173 rel_hdr
->sh_entsize
= (use_rela_p
3174 ? bed
->s
->sizeof_rela
3175 : bed
->s
->sizeof_rel
);
3176 rel_hdr
->sh_addralign
= (bfd_vma
) 1 << bed
->s
->log_file_align
;
3177 rel_hdr
->sh_flags
= 0;
3178 rel_hdr
->sh_addr
= 0;
3179 rel_hdr
->sh_size
= 0;
3180 rel_hdr
->sh_offset
= 0;
3185 /* Return the default section type based on the passed in section flags. */
3188 bfd_elf_get_default_section_type (flagword flags
)
3190 if ((flags
& (SEC_ALLOC
| SEC_IS_COMMON
)) != 0
3191 && (flags
& (SEC_LOAD
| SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
)) == 0)
3193 return SHT_PROGBITS
;
3196 struct fake_section_arg
3198 struct bfd_link_info
*link_info
;
3202 /* Set up an ELF internal section header for a section. */
3205 elf_fake_sections (bfd
*abfd
, asection
*asect
, void *fsarg
)
3207 struct fake_section_arg
*arg
= (struct fake_section_arg
*)fsarg
;
3208 const struct elf_backend_data
*bed
= get_elf_backend_data (abfd
);
3209 struct bfd_elf_section_data
*esd
= elf_section_data (asect
);
3210 Elf_Internal_Shdr
*this_hdr
;
3211 unsigned int sh_type
;
3212 const char *name
= asect
->name
;
3213 bfd_boolean delay_st_name_p
= FALSE
;
3218 /* We already failed; just get out of the bfd_map_over_sections
3223 this_hdr
= &esd
->this_hdr
;
3227 /* ld: compress DWARF debug sections with names: .debug_*. */
3228 if ((arg
->link_info
->compress_debug
& COMPRESS_DEBUG
)
3229 && (asect
->flags
& SEC_DEBUGGING
)
3233 /* Set SEC_ELF_COMPRESS to indicate this section should be
3235 asect
->flags
|= SEC_ELF_COMPRESS
;
3236 /* If this section will be compressed, delay adding section
3237 name to section name section after it is compressed in
3238 _bfd_elf_assign_file_positions_for_non_load. */
3239 delay_st_name_p
= TRUE
;
3242 else if ((asect
->flags
& SEC_ELF_RENAME
))
3244 /* objcopy: rename output DWARF debug section. */
3245 if ((abfd
->flags
& (BFD_DECOMPRESS
| BFD_COMPRESS_GABI
)))
3247 /* When we decompress or compress with SHF_COMPRESSED,
3248 convert section name from .zdebug_* to .debug_* if
3252 char *new_name
= convert_zdebug_to_debug (abfd
, name
);
3253 if (new_name
== NULL
)
3261 else if (asect
->compress_status
== COMPRESS_SECTION_DONE
)
3263 /* PR binutils/18087: Compression does not always make a
3264 section smaller. So only rename the section when
3265 compression has actually taken place. If input section
3266 name is .zdebug_*, we should never compress it again. */
3267 char *new_name
= convert_debug_to_zdebug (abfd
, name
);
3268 if (new_name
== NULL
)
3273 BFD_ASSERT (name
[1] != 'z');
3278 if (delay_st_name_p
)
3279 this_hdr
->sh_name
= (unsigned int) -1;
3283 = (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (elf_shstrtab (abfd
),
3285 if (this_hdr
->sh_name
== (unsigned int) -1)
3292 /* Don't clear sh_flags. Assembler may set additional bits. */
3294 if ((asect
->flags
& SEC_ALLOC
) != 0
3295 || asect
->user_set_vma
)
3296 this_hdr
->sh_addr
= asect
->vma
* bfd_octets_per_byte (abfd
, asect
);
3298 this_hdr
->sh_addr
= 0;
3300 this_hdr
->sh_offset
= 0;
3301 this_hdr
->sh_size
= asect
->size
;
3302 this_hdr
->sh_link
= 0;
3303 /* PR 17512: file: 0eb809fe, 8b0535ee. */
3304 if (asect
->alignment_power
>= (sizeof (bfd_vma
) * 8) - 1)
3307 /* xgettext:c-format */
3308 (_("%pB: error: alignment power %d of section `%pA' is too big"),
3309 abfd
, asect
->alignment_power
, asect
);
3313 /* Set sh_addralign to the highest power of two given by alignment
3314 consistent with the section VMA. Linker scripts can force VMA. */
3315 mask
= ((bfd_vma
) 1 << asect
->alignment_power
) | this_hdr
->sh_addr
;
3316 this_hdr
->sh_addralign
= mask
& -mask
;
3317 /* The sh_entsize and sh_info fields may have been set already by
3318 copy_private_section_data. */
3320 this_hdr
->bfd_section
= asect
;
3321 this_hdr
->contents
= NULL
;
3323 /* If the section type is unspecified, we set it based on
3325 if ((asect
->flags
& SEC_GROUP
) != 0)
3326 sh_type
= SHT_GROUP
;
3328 sh_type
= bfd_elf_get_default_section_type (asect
->flags
);
3330 if (this_hdr
->sh_type
== SHT_NULL
)
3331 this_hdr
->sh_type
= sh_type
;
3332 else if (this_hdr
->sh_type
== SHT_NOBITS
3333 && sh_type
== SHT_PROGBITS
3334 && (asect
->flags
& SEC_ALLOC
) != 0)
3336 /* Warn if we are changing a NOBITS section to PROGBITS, but
3337 allow the link to proceed. This can happen when users link
3338 non-bss input sections to bss output sections, or emit data
3339 to a bss output section via a linker script. */
3341 (_("warning: section `%pA' type changed to PROGBITS"), asect
);
3342 this_hdr
->sh_type
= sh_type
;
3345 switch (this_hdr
->sh_type
)
3356 case SHT_INIT_ARRAY
:
3357 case SHT_FINI_ARRAY
:
3358 case SHT_PREINIT_ARRAY
:
3359 this_hdr
->sh_entsize
= bed
->s
->arch_size
/ 8;
3363 this_hdr
->sh_entsize
= bed
->s
->sizeof_hash_entry
;
3367 this_hdr
->sh_entsize
= bed
->s
->sizeof_sym
;
3371 this_hdr
->sh_entsize
= bed
->s
->sizeof_dyn
;
3375 if (get_elf_backend_data (abfd
)->may_use_rela_p
)
3376 this_hdr
->sh_entsize
= bed
->s
->sizeof_rela
;
3380 if (get_elf_backend_data (abfd
)->may_use_rel_p
)
3381 this_hdr
->sh_entsize
= bed
->s
->sizeof_rel
;
3384 case SHT_GNU_versym
:
3385 this_hdr
->sh_entsize
= sizeof (Elf_External_Versym
);
3388 case SHT_GNU_verdef
:
3389 this_hdr
->sh_entsize
= 0;
3390 /* objcopy or strip will copy over sh_info, but may not set
3391 cverdefs. The linker will set cverdefs, but sh_info will be
3393 if (this_hdr
->sh_info
== 0)
3394 this_hdr
->sh_info
= elf_tdata (abfd
)->cverdefs
;
3396 BFD_ASSERT (elf_tdata (abfd
)->cverdefs
== 0
3397 || this_hdr
->sh_info
== elf_tdata (abfd
)->cverdefs
);
3400 case SHT_GNU_verneed
:
3401 this_hdr
->sh_entsize
= 0;
3402 /* objcopy or strip will copy over sh_info, but may not set
3403 cverrefs. The linker will set cverrefs, but sh_info will be
3405 if (this_hdr
->sh_info
== 0)
3406 this_hdr
->sh_info
= elf_tdata (abfd
)->cverrefs
;
3408 BFD_ASSERT (elf_tdata (abfd
)->cverrefs
== 0
3409 || this_hdr
->sh_info
== elf_tdata (abfd
)->cverrefs
);
3413 this_hdr
->sh_entsize
= GRP_ENTRY_SIZE
;
3417 this_hdr
->sh_entsize
= bed
->s
->arch_size
== 64 ? 0 : 4;
3421 if ((asect
->flags
& SEC_ALLOC
) != 0)
3422 this_hdr
->sh_flags
|= SHF_ALLOC
;
3423 if ((asect
->flags
& SEC_READONLY
) == 0)
3424 this_hdr
->sh_flags
|= SHF_WRITE
;
3425 if ((asect
->flags
& SEC_CODE
) != 0)
3426 this_hdr
->sh_flags
|= SHF_EXECINSTR
;
3427 if ((asect
->flags
& SEC_MERGE
) != 0)
3429 this_hdr
->sh_flags
|= SHF_MERGE
;
3430 this_hdr
->sh_entsize
= asect
->entsize
;
3432 if ((asect
->flags
& SEC_STRINGS
) != 0)
3433 this_hdr
->sh_flags
|= SHF_STRINGS
;
3434 if ((asect
->flags
& SEC_GROUP
) == 0 && elf_group_name (asect
) != NULL
)
3435 this_hdr
->sh_flags
|= SHF_GROUP
;
3436 if ((asect
->flags
& SEC_THREAD_LOCAL
) != 0)
3438 this_hdr
->sh_flags
|= SHF_TLS
;
3439 if (asect
->size
== 0
3440 && (asect
->flags
& SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
) == 0)
3442 struct bfd_link_order
*o
= asect
->map_tail
.link_order
;
3444 this_hdr
->sh_size
= 0;
3447 this_hdr
->sh_size
= o
->offset
+ o
->size
;
3448 if (this_hdr
->sh_size
!= 0)
3449 this_hdr
->sh_type
= SHT_NOBITS
;
3453 if ((asect
->flags
& (SEC_GROUP
| SEC_EXCLUDE
)) == SEC_EXCLUDE
)
3454 this_hdr
->sh_flags
|= SHF_EXCLUDE
;
3456 /* If the section has relocs, set up a section header for the
3457 SHT_REL[A] section. If two relocation sections are required for
3458 this section, it is up to the processor-specific back-end to
3459 create the other. */
3460 if ((asect
->flags
& SEC_RELOC
) != 0)
3462 /* When doing a relocatable link, create both REL and RELA sections if
3465 /* Do the normal setup if we wouldn't create any sections here. */
3466 && esd
->rel
.count
+ esd
->rela
.count
> 0
3467 && (bfd_link_relocatable (arg
->link_info
)
3468 || arg
->link_info
->emitrelocations
))
3470 if (esd
->rel
.count
&& esd
->rel
.hdr
== NULL
3471 && !_bfd_elf_init_reloc_shdr (abfd
, &esd
->rel
, name
,
3472 FALSE
, delay_st_name_p
))
3477 if (esd
->rela
.count
&& esd
->rela
.hdr
== NULL
3478 && !_bfd_elf_init_reloc_shdr (abfd
, &esd
->rela
, name
,
3479 TRUE
, delay_st_name_p
))
3485 else if (!_bfd_elf_init_reloc_shdr (abfd
,
3487 ? &esd
->rela
: &esd
->rel
),
3497 /* Check for processor-specific section types. */
3498 sh_type
= this_hdr
->sh_type
;
3499 if (bed
->elf_backend_fake_sections
3500 && !(*bed
->elf_backend_fake_sections
) (abfd
, this_hdr
, asect
))
3506 if (sh_type
== SHT_NOBITS
&& asect
->size
!= 0)
3508 /* Don't change the header type from NOBITS if we are being
3509 called for objcopy --only-keep-debug. */
3510 this_hdr
->sh_type
= sh_type
;
3514 /* Fill in the contents of a SHT_GROUP section. Called from
3515 _bfd_elf_compute_section_file_positions for gas, objcopy, and
3516 when ELF targets use the generic linker, ld. Called for ld -r
3517 from bfd_elf_final_link. */
3520 bfd_elf_set_group_contents (bfd
*abfd
, asection
*sec
, void *failedptrarg
)
3522 bfd_boolean
*failedptr
= (bfd_boolean
*) failedptrarg
;
3523 asection
*elt
, *first
;
3527 /* Ignore linker created group section. See elfNN_ia64_object_p in
3529 if ((sec
->flags
& (SEC_GROUP
| SEC_LINKER_CREATED
)) != SEC_GROUP
3534 if (elf_section_data (sec
)->this_hdr
.sh_info
== 0)
3536 unsigned long symindx
= 0;
3538 /* elf_group_id will have been set up by objcopy and the
3540 if (elf_group_id (sec
) != NULL
)
3541 symindx
= elf_group_id (sec
)->udata
.i
;
3545 /* If called from the assembler, swap_out_syms will have set up
3547 PR 25699: A corrupt input file could contain bogus group info. */
3548 if (elf_section_syms (abfd
) == NULL
)
3553 symindx
= elf_section_syms (abfd
)[sec
->index
]->udata
.i
;
3555 elf_section_data (sec
)->this_hdr
.sh_info
= symindx
;
3557 else if (elf_section_data (sec
)->this_hdr
.sh_info
== (unsigned int) -2)
3559 /* The ELF backend linker sets sh_info to -2 when the group
3560 signature symbol is global, and thus the index can't be
3561 set until all local symbols are output. */
3563 struct bfd_elf_section_data
*sec_data
;
3564 unsigned long symndx
;
3565 unsigned long extsymoff
;
3566 struct elf_link_hash_entry
*h
;
3568 /* The point of this little dance to the first SHF_GROUP section
3569 then back to the SHT_GROUP section is that this gets us to
3570 the SHT_GROUP in the input object. */
3571 igroup
= elf_sec_group (elf_next_in_group (sec
));
3572 sec_data
= elf_section_data (igroup
);
3573 symndx
= sec_data
->this_hdr
.sh_info
;
3575 if (!elf_bad_symtab (igroup
->owner
))
3577 Elf_Internal_Shdr
*symtab_hdr
;
3579 symtab_hdr
= &elf_tdata (igroup
->owner
)->symtab_hdr
;
3580 extsymoff
= symtab_hdr
->sh_info
;
3582 h
= elf_sym_hashes (igroup
->owner
)[symndx
- extsymoff
];
3583 while (h
->root
.type
== bfd_link_hash_indirect
3584 || h
->root
.type
== bfd_link_hash_warning
)
3585 h
= (struct elf_link_hash_entry
*) h
->root
.u
.i
.link
;
3587 elf_section_data (sec
)->this_hdr
.sh_info
= h
->indx
;
3590 /* The contents won't be allocated for "ld -r" or objcopy. */
3592 if (sec
->contents
== NULL
)
3595 sec
->contents
= (unsigned char *) bfd_alloc (abfd
, sec
->size
);
3597 /* Arrange for the section to be written out. */
3598 elf_section_data (sec
)->this_hdr
.contents
= sec
->contents
;
3599 if (sec
->contents
== NULL
)
3606 loc
= sec
->contents
+ sec
->size
;
3608 /* Get the pointer to the first section in the group that gas
3609 squirreled away here. objcopy arranges for this to be set to the
3610 start of the input section group. */
3611 first
= elt
= elf_next_in_group (sec
);
3613 /* First element is a flag word. Rest of section is elf section
3614 indices for all the sections of the group. Write them backwards
3615 just to keep the group in the same order as given in .section
3616 directives, not that it matters. */
3623 s
= s
->output_section
;
3625 && !bfd_is_abs_section (s
))
3627 struct bfd_elf_section_data
*elf_sec
= elf_section_data (s
);
3628 struct bfd_elf_section_data
*input_elf_sec
= elf_section_data (elt
);
3630 if (elf_sec
->rel
.hdr
!= NULL
3632 || (input_elf_sec
->rel
.hdr
!= NULL
3633 && input_elf_sec
->rel
.hdr
->sh_flags
& SHF_GROUP
) != 0))
3635 elf_sec
->rel
.hdr
->sh_flags
|= SHF_GROUP
;
3637 H_PUT_32 (abfd
, elf_sec
->rel
.idx
, loc
);
3639 if (elf_sec
->rela
.hdr
!= NULL
3641 || (input_elf_sec
->rela
.hdr
!= NULL
3642 && input_elf_sec
->rela
.hdr
->sh_flags
& SHF_GROUP
) != 0))
3644 elf_sec
->rela
.hdr
->sh_flags
|= SHF_GROUP
;
3646 H_PUT_32 (abfd
, elf_sec
->rela
.idx
, loc
);
3649 H_PUT_32 (abfd
, elf_sec
->this_idx
, loc
);
3651 elt
= elf_next_in_group (elt
);
3657 BFD_ASSERT (loc
== sec
->contents
);
3659 H_PUT_32 (abfd
, sec
->flags
& SEC_LINK_ONCE
? GRP_COMDAT
: 0, loc
);
3662 /* Given NAME, the name of a relocation section stripped of its
3663 .rel/.rela prefix, return the section in ABFD to which the
3664 relocations apply. */
3667 _bfd_elf_plt_get_reloc_section (bfd
*abfd
, const char *name
)
3669 /* If a target needs .got.plt section, relocations in rela.plt/rel.plt
3670 section likely apply to .got.plt or .got section. */
3671 if (get_elf_backend_data (abfd
)->want_got_plt
3672 && strcmp (name
, ".plt") == 0)
3677 sec
= bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd
, name
);
3683 return bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd
, name
);
3686 /* Return the section to which RELOC_SEC applies. */
3689 elf_get_reloc_section (asection
*reloc_sec
)
3694 const struct elf_backend_data
*bed
;
3696 type
= elf_section_data (reloc_sec
)->this_hdr
.sh_type
;
3697 if (type
!= SHT_REL
&& type
!= SHT_RELA
)
3700 /* We look up the section the relocs apply to by name. */
3701 name
= reloc_sec
->name
;
3702 if (strncmp (name
, ".rel", 4) != 0)
3705 if (type
== SHT_RELA
&& *name
++ != 'a')
3708 abfd
= reloc_sec
->owner
;
3709 bed
= get_elf_backend_data (abfd
);
3710 return bed
->get_reloc_section (abfd
, name
);
3713 /* Assign all ELF section numbers. The dummy first section is handled here
3714 too. The link/info pointers for the standard section types are filled
3715 in here too, while we're at it. LINK_INFO will be 0 when arriving
3716 here for objcopy, and when using the generic ELF linker. */
3719 assign_section_numbers (bfd
*abfd
, struct bfd_link_info
*link_info
)
3721 struct elf_obj_tdata
*t
= elf_tdata (abfd
);
3723 unsigned int section_number
;
3724 Elf_Internal_Shdr
**i_shdrp
;
3725 struct bfd_elf_section_data
*d
;
3726 bfd_boolean need_symtab
;
3731 _bfd_elf_strtab_clear_all_refs (elf_shstrtab (abfd
));
3733 /* SHT_GROUP sections are in relocatable files only. */
3734 if (link_info
== NULL
|| !link_info
->resolve_section_groups
)
3736 size_t reloc_count
= 0;
3738 /* Put SHT_GROUP sections first. */
3739 for (sec
= abfd
->sections
; sec
!= NULL
; sec
= sec
->next
)
3741 d
= elf_section_data (sec
);
3743 if (d
->this_hdr
.sh_type
== SHT_GROUP
)
3745 if (sec
->flags
& SEC_LINKER_CREATED
)
3747 /* Remove the linker created SHT_GROUP sections. */
3748 bfd_section_list_remove (abfd
, sec
);
3749 abfd
->section_count
--;
3752 d
->this_idx
= section_number
++;
3755 /* Count relocations. */
3756 reloc_count
+= sec
->reloc_count
;
3759 /* Clear HAS_RELOC if there are no relocations. */
3760 if (reloc_count
== 0)
3761 abfd
->flags
&= ~HAS_RELOC
;
3764 for (sec
= abfd
->sections
; sec
; sec
= sec
->next
)
3766 d
= elf_section_data (sec
);
3768 if (d
->this_hdr
.sh_type
!= SHT_GROUP
)
3769 d
->this_idx
= section_number
++;
3770 if (d
->this_hdr
.sh_name
!= (unsigned int) -1)
3771 _bfd_elf_strtab_addref (elf_shstrtab (abfd
), d
->this_hdr
.sh_name
);
3774 d
->rel
.idx
= section_number
++;
3775 if (d
->rel
.hdr
->sh_name
!= (unsigned int) -1)
3776 _bfd_elf_strtab_addref (elf_shstrtab (abfd
), d
->rel
.hdr
->sh_name
);
3783 d
->rela
.idx
= section_number
++;
3784 if (d
->rela
.hdr
->sh_name
!= (unsigned int) -1)
3785 _bfd_elf_strtab_addref (elf_shstrtab (abfd
), d
->rela
.hdr
->sh_name
);
3791 need_symtab
= (bfd_get_symcount (abfd
) > 0
3792 || (link_info
== NULL
3793 && ((abfd
->flags
& (EXEC_P
| DYNAMIC
| HAS_RELOC
))
3797 elf_onesymtab (abfd
) = section_number
++;
3798 _bfd_elf_strtab_addref (elf_shstrtab (abfd
), t
->symtab_hdr
.sh_name
);
3799 if (section_number
> ((SHN_LORESERVE
- 2) & 0xFFFF))
3801 elf_section_list
*entry
;
3803 BFD_ASSERT (elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd
) == NULL
);
3805 entry
= bfd_zalloc (abfd
, sizeof (*entry
));
3806 entry
->ndx
= section_number
++;
3807 elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd
) = entry
;
3809 = (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (elf_shstrtab (abfd
),
3810 ".symtab_shndx", FALSE
);
3811 if (entry
->hdr
.sh_name
== (unsigned int) -1)
3814 elf_strtab_sec (abfd
) = section_number
++;
3815 _bfd_elf_strtab_addref (elf_shstrtab (abfd
), t
->strtab_hdr
.sh_name
);
3818 elf_shstrtab_sec (abfd
) = section_number
++;
3819 _bfd_elf_strtab_addref (elf_shstrtab (abfd
), t
->shstrtab_hdr
.sh_name
);
3820 elf_elfheader (abfd
)->e_shstrndx
= elf_shstrtab_sec (abfd
);
3822 if (section_number
>= SHN_LORESERVE
)
3824 /* xgettext:c-format */
3825 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: too many sections: %u"),
3826 abfd
, section_number
);
3830 elf_numsections (abfd
) = section_number
;
3831 elf_elfheader (abfd
)->e_shnum
= section_number
;
3833 /* Set up the list of section header pointers, in agreement with the
3835 amt
= section_number
* sizeof (Elf_Internal_Shdr
*);
3836 i_shdrp
= (Elf_Internal_Shdr
**) bfd_zalloc (abfd
, amt
);
3837 if (i_shdrp
== NULL
)
3840 i_shdrp
[0] = (Elf_Internal_Shdr
*) bfd_zalloc (abfd
,
3841 sizeof (Elf_Internal_Shdr
));
3842 if (i_shdrp
[0] == NULL
)
3844 bfd_release (abfd
, i_shdrp
);
3848 elf_elfsections (abfd
) = i_shdrp
;
3850 i_shdrp
[elf_shstrtab_sec (abfd
)] = &t
->shstrtab_hdr
;
3853 i_shdrp
[elf_onesymtab (abfd
)] = &t
->symtab_hdr
;
3854 if (elf_numsections (abfd
) > (SHN_LORESERVE
& 0xFFFF))
3856 elf_section_list
* entry
= elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd
);
3857 BFD_ASSERT (entry
!= NULL
);
3858 i_shdrp
[entry
->ndx
] = & entry
->hdr
;
3859 entry
->hdr
.sh_link
= elf_onesymtab (abfd
);
3861 i_shdrp
[elf_strtab_sec (abfd
)] = &t
->strtab_hdr
;
3862 t
->symtab_hdr
.sh_link
= elf_strtab_sec (abfd
);
3865 for (sec
= abfd
->sections
; sec
; sec
= sec
->next
)
3869 d
= elf_section_data (sec
);
3871 i_shdrp
[d
->this_idx
] = &d
->this_hdr
;
3872 if (d
->rel
.idx
!= 0)
3873 i_shdrp
[d
->rel
.idx
] = d
->rel
.hdr
;
3874 if (d
->rela
.idx
!= 0)
3875 i_shdrp
[d
->rela
.idx
] = d
->rela
.hdr
;
3877 /* Fill in the sh_link and sh_info fields while we're at it. */
3879 /* sh_link of a reloc section is the section index of the symbol
3880 table. sh_info is the section index of the section to which
3881 the relocation entries apply. */
3882 if (d
->rel
.idx
!= 0)
3884 d
->rel
.hdr
->sh_link
= elf_onesymtab (abfd
);
3885 d
->rel
.hdr
->sh_info
= d
->this_idx
;
3886 d
->rel
.hdr
->sh_flags
|= SHF_INFO_LINK
;
3888 if (d
->rela
.idx
!= 0)
3890 d
->rela
.hdr
->sh_link
= elf_onesymtab (abfd
);
3891 d
->rela
.hdr
->sh_info
= d
->this_idx
;
3892 d
->rela
.hdr
->sh_flags
|= SHF_INFO_LINK
;
3895 /* We need to set up sh_link for SHF_LINK_ORDER. */
3896 if ((d
->this_hdr
.sh_flags
& SHF_LINK_ORDER
) != 0)
3898 s
= elf_linked_to_section (sec
);
3899 /* We can now have a NULL linked section pointer.
3900 This happens when the sh_link field is 0, which is done
3901 when a linked to section is discarded but the linking
3902 section has been retained for some reason. */
3905 /* Check discarded linkonce section. */
3906 if (discarded_section (s
))
3910 /* xgettext:c-format */
3911 (_("%pB: sh_link of section `%pA' points to"
3912 " discarded section `%pA' of `%pB'"),
3913 abfd
, d
->this_hdr
.bfd_section
, s
, s
->owner
);
3914 /* Point to the kept section if it has the same
3915 size as the discarded one. */
3916 kept
= _bfd_elf_check_kept_section (s
, link_info
);
3919 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value
);
3924 /* Handle objcopy. */
3925 else if (s
->output_section
== NULL
)
3928 /* xgettext:c-format */
3929 (_("%pB: sh_link of section `%pA' points to"
3930 " removed section `%pA' of `%pB'"),
3931 abfd
, d
->this_hdr
.bfd_section
, s
, s
->owner
);
3932 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value
);
3935 s
= s
->output_section
;
3936 d
->this_hdr
.sh_link
= elf_section_data (s
)->this_idx
;
3940 switch (d
->this_hdr
.sh_type
)
3944 /* A reloc section which we are treating as a normal BFD
3945 section. sh_link is the section index of the symbol
3946 table. sh_info is the section index of the section to
3947 which the relocation entries apply. We assume that an
3948 allocated reloc section uses the dynamic symbol table.
3949 FIXME: How can we be sure? */
3950 s
= bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd
, ".dynsym");
3952 d
->this_hdr
.sh_link
= elf_section_data (s
)->this_idx
;
3954 s
= elf_get_reloc_section (sec
);
3957 d
->this_hdr
.sh_info
= elf_section_data (s
)->this_idx
;
3958 d
->this_hdr
.sh_flags
|= SHF_INFO_LINK
;
3963 /* We assume that a section named .stab*str is a stabs
3964 string section. We look for a section with the same name
3965 but without the trailing ``str'', and set its sh_link
3966 field to point to this section. */
3967 if (CONST_STRNEQ (sec
->name
, ".stab")
3968 && strcmp (sec
->name
+ strlen (sec
->name
) - 3, "str") == 0)
3973 len
= strlen (sec
->name
);
3974 alc
= (char *) bfd_malloc (len
- 2);
3977 memcpy (alc
, sec
->name
, len
- 3);
3978 alc
[len
- 3] = '\0';
3979 s
= bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd
, alc
);
3983 elf_section_data (s
)->this_hdr
.sh_link
= d
->this_idx
;
3985 /* This is a .stab section. */
3986 elf_section_data (s
)->this_hdr
.sh_entsize
= 12;
3993 case SHT_GNU_verneed
:
3994 case SHT_GNU_verdef
:
3995 /* sh_link is the section header index of the string table
3996 used for the dynamic entries, or the symbol table, or the
3998 s
= bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd
, ".dynstr");
4000 d
->this_hdr
.sh_link
= elf_section_data (s
)->this_idx
;
4003 case SHT_GNU_LIBLIST
:
4004 /* sh_link is the section header index of the prelink library
4005 list used for the dynamic entries, or the symbol table, or
4006 the version strings. */
4007 s
= bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd
, (sec
->flags
& SEC_ALLOC
)
4008 ? ".dynstr" : ".gnu.libstr");
4010 d
->this_hdr
.sh_link
= elf_section_data (s
)->this_idx
;
4015 case SHT_GNU_versym
:
4016 /* sh_link is the section header index of the symbol table
4017 this hash table or version table is for. */
4018 s
= bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd
, ".dynsym");
4020 d
->this_hdr
.sh_link
= elf_section_data (s
)->this_idx
;
4024 d
->this_hdr
.sh_link
= elf_onesymtab (abfd
);
4028 /* Delay setting sh_name to _bfd_elf_write_object_contents so that
4029 _bfd_elf_assign_file_positions_for_non_load can convert DWARF
4030 debug section name from .debug_* to .zdebug_* if needed. */
4036 sym_is_global (bfd
*abfd
, asymbol
*sym
)
4038 /* If the backend has a special mapping, use it. */
4039 const struct elf_backend_data
*bed
= get_elf_backend_data (abfd
);
4040 if (bed
->elf_backend_sym_is_global
)
4041 return (*bed
->elf_backend_sym_is_global
) (abfd
, sym
);
4043 return ((sym
->flags
& (BSF_GLOBAL
| BSF_WEAK
| BSF_GNU_UNIQUE
)) != 0
4044 || bfd_is_und_section (bfd_asymbol_section (sym
))
4045 || bfd_is_com_section (bfd_asymbol_section (sym
)));
4048 /* Filter global symbols of ABFD to include in the import library. All
4049 SYMCOUNT symbols of ABFD can be examined from their pointers in
4050 SYMS. Pointers of symbols to keep should be stored contiguously at
4051 the beginning of that array.
4053 Returns the number of symbols to keep. */
4056 _bfd_elf_filter_global_symbols (bfd
*abfd
, struct bfd_link_info
*info
,
4057 asymbol
**syms
, long symcount
)
4059 long src_count
, dst_count
= 0;
4061 for (src_count
= 0; src_count
< symcount
; src_count
++)
4063 asymbol
*sym
= syms
[src_count
];
4064 char *name
= (char *) bfd_asymbol_name (sym
);
4065 struct bfd_link_hash_entry
*h
;
4067 if (!sym_is_global (abfd
, sym
))
4070 h
= bfd_link_hash_lookup (info
->hash
, name
, FALSE
, FALSE
, FALSE
);
4073 if (h
->type
!= bfd_link_hash_defined
&& h
->type
!= bfd_link_hash_defweak
)
4075 if (h
->linker_def
|| h
->ldscript_def
)
4078 syms
[dst_count
++] = sym
;
4081 syms
[dst_count
] = NULL
;
4086 /* Don't output section symbols for sections that are not going to be
4087 output, that are duplicates or there is no BFD section. */
4090 ignore_section_sym (bfd
*abfd
, asymbol
*sym
)
4092 elf_symbol_type
*type_ptr
;
4097 if ((sym
->flags
& BSF_SECTION_SYM
) == 0)
4100 if (sym
->section
== NULL
)
4103 type_ptr
= elf_symbol_from (sym
);
4104 return ((type_ptr
!= NULL
4105 && type_ptr
->internal_elf_sym
.st_shndx
!= 0
4106 && bfd_is_abs_section (sym
->section
))
4107 || !(sym
->section
->owner
== abfd
4108 || (sym
->section
->output_section
!= NULL
4109 && sym
->section
->output_section
->owner
== abfd
4110 && sym
->section
->output_offset
== 0)
4111 || bfd_is_abs_section (sym
->section
)));
4114 /* Map symbol from it's internal number to the external number, moving
4115 all local symbols to be at the head of the list. */
4118 elf_map_symbols (bfd
*abfd
, unsigned int *pnum_locals
)
4120 unsigned int symcount
= bfd_get_symcount (abfd
);
4121 asymbol
**syms
= bfd_get_outsymbols (abfd
);
4122 asymbol
**sect_syms
;
4123 unsigned int num_locals
= 0;
4124 unsigned int num_globals
= 0;
4125 unsigned int num_locals2
= 0;
4126 unsigned int num_globals2
= 0;
4127 unsigned int max_index
= 0;
4134 fprintf (stderr
, "elf_map_symbols\n");
4138 for (asect
= abfd
->sections
; asect
; asect
= asect
->next
)
4140 if (max_index
< asect
->index
)
4141 max_index
= asect
->index
;
4145 amt
= max_index
* sizeof (asymbol
*);
4146 sect_syms
= (asymbol
**) bfd_zalloc (abfd
, amt
);
4147 if (sect_syms
== NULL
)
4149 elf_section_syms (abfd
) = sect_syms
;
4150 elf_num_section_syms (abfd
) = max_index
;
4152 /* Init sect_syms entries for any section symbols we have already
4153 decided to output. */
4154 for (idx
= 0; idx
< symcount
; idx
++)
4156 asymbol
*sym
= syms
[idx
];
4158 if ((sym
->flags
& BSF_SECTION_SYM
) != 0
4160 && !ignore_section_sym (abfd
, sym
)
4161 && !bfd_is_abs_section (sym
->section
))
4163 asection
*sec
= sym
->section
;
4165 if (sec
->owner
!= abfd
)
4166 sec
= sec
->output_section
;
4168 sect_syms
[sec
->index
] = syms
[idx
];
4172 /* Classify all of the symbols. */
4173 for (idx
= 0; idx
< symcount
; idx
++)
4175 if (sym_is_global (abfd
, syms
[idx
]))
4177 else if (!ignore_section_sym (abfd
, syms
[idx
]))
4181 /* We will be adding a section symbol for each normal BFD section. Most
4182 sections will already have a section symbol in outsymbols, but
4183 eg. SHT_GROUP sections will not, and we need the section symbol mapped
4184 at least in that case. */
4185 for (asect
= abfd
->sections
; asect
; asect
= asect
->next
)
4187 if (sect_syms
[asect
->index
] == NULL
)
4189 if (!sym_is_global (abfd
, asect
->symbol
))
4196 /* Now sort the symbols so the local symbols are first. */
4197 amt
= (num_locals
+ num_globals
) * sizeof (asymbol
*);
4198 new_syms
= (asymbol
**) bfd_alloc (abfd
, amt
);
4199 if (new_syms
== NULL
)
4202 for (idx
= 0; idx
< symcount
; idx
++)
4204 asymbol
*sym
= syms
[idx
];
4207 if (sym_is_global (abfd
, sym
))
4208 i
= num_locals
+ num_globals2
++;
4209 else if (!ignore_section_sym (abfd
, sym
))
4214 sym
->udata
.i
= i
+ 1;
4216 for (asect
= abfd
->sections
; asect
; asect
= asect
->next
)
4218 if (sect_syms
[asect
->index
] == NULL
)
4220 asymbol
*sym
= asect
->symbol
;
4223 sect_syms
[asect
->index
] = sym
;
4224 if (!sym_is_global (abfd
, sym
))
4227 i
= num_locals
+ num_globals2
++;
4229 sym
->udata
.i
= i
+ 1;
4233 bfd_set_symtab (abfd
, new_syms
, num_locals
+ num_globals
);
4235 *pnum_locals
= num_locals
;
4239 /* Align to the maximum file alignment that could be required for any
4240 ELF data structure. */
4242 static inline file_ptr
4243 align_file_position (file_ptr off
, int align
)
4245 return (off
+ align
- 1) & ~(align
- 1);
4248 /* Assign a file position to a section, optionally aligning to the
4249 required section alignment. */
4252 _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (Elf_Internal_Shdr
*i_shdrp
,
4256 if (align
&& i_shdrp
->sh_addralign
> 1)
4257 offset
= BFD_ALIGN (offset
, i_shdrp
->sh_addralign
);
4258 i_shdrp
->sh_offset
= offset
;
4259 if (i_shdrp
->bfd_section
!= NULL
)
4260 i_shdrp
->bfd_section
->filepos
= offset
;
4261 if (i_shdrp
->sh_type
!= SHT_NOBITS
)
4262 offset
+= i_shdrp
->sh_size
;
4266 /* Compute the file positions we are going to put the sections at, and
4267 otherwise prepare to begin writing out the ELF file. If LINK_INFO
4268 is not NULL, this is being called by the ELF backend linker. */
4271 _bfd_elf_compute_section_file_positions (bfd
*abfd
,
4272 struct bfd_link_info
*link_info
)
4274 const struct elf_backend_data
*bed
= get_elf_backend_data (abfd
);
4275 struct fake_section_arg fsargs
;
4277 struct elf_strtab_hash
*strtab
= NULL
;
4278 Elf_Internal_Shdr
*shstrtab_hdr
;
4279 bfd_boolean need_symtab
;
4281 if (abfd
->output_has_begun
)
4284 /* Do any elf backend specific processing first. */
4285 if (bed
->elf_backend_begin_write_processing
)
4286 (*bed
->elf_backend_begin_write_processing
) (abfd
, link_info
);
4288 if (!(*bed
->elf_backend_init_file_header
) (abfd
, link_info
))
4291 fsargs
.failed
= FALSE
;
4292 fsargs
.link_info
= link_info
;
4293 bfd_map_over_sections (abfd
, elf_fake_sections
, &fsargs
);
4297 if (!assign_section_numbers (abfd
, link_info
))
4300 /* The backend linker builds symbol table information itself. */
4301 need_symtab
= (link_info
== NULL
4302 && (bfd_get_symcount (abfd
) > 0
4303 || ((abfd
->flags
& (EXEC_P
| DYNAMIC
| HAS_RELOC
))
4307 /* Non-zero if doing a relocatable link. */
4308 int relocatable_p
= ! (abfd
->flags
& (EXEC_P
| DYNAMIC
));
4310 if (! swap_out_syms (abfd
, &strtab
, relocatable_p
, link_info
))
4315 if (link_info
== NULL
)
4317 bfd_map_over_sections (abfd
, bfd_elf_set_group_contents
, &failed
);
4322 shstrtab_hdr
= &elf_tdata (abfd
)->shstrtab_hdr
;
4323 /* sh_name was set in init_file_header. */
4324 shstrtab_hdr
->sh_type
= SHT_STRTAB
;
4325 shstrtab_hdr
->sh_flags
= bed
->elf_strtab_flags
;
4326 shstrtab_hdr
->sh_addr
= 0;
4327 /* sh_size is set in _bfd_elf_assign_file_positions_for_non_load. */
4328 shstrtab_hdr
->sh_entsize
= 0;
4329 shstrtab_hdr
->sh_link
= 0;
4330 shstrtab_hdr
->sh_info
= 0;
4331 /* sh_offset is set in _bfd_elf_assign_file_positions_for_non_load. */
4332 shstrtab_hdr
->sh_addralign
= 1;
4334 if (!assign_file_positions_except_relocs (abfd
, link_info
))
4340 Elf_Internal_Shdr
*hdr
;
4342 off
= elf_next_file_pos (abfd
);
4344 hdr
= & elf_symtab_hdr (abfd
);
4345 off
= _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (hdr
, off
, TRUE
);
4347 if (elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd
) != NULL
)
4349 hdr
= & elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd
)->hdr
;
4350 if (hdr
->sh_size
!= 0)
4351 off
= _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (hdr
, off
, TRUE
);
4352 /* FIXME: What about other symtab_shndx sections in the list ? */
4355 hdr
= &elf_tdata (abfd
)->strtab_hdr
;
4356 off
= _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (hdr
, off
, TRUE
);
4358 elf_next_file_pos (abfd
) = off
;
4360 /* Now that we know where the .strtab section goes, write it
4362 if (bfd_seek (abfd
, hdr
->sh_offset
, SEEK_SET
) != 0
4363 || ! _bfd_elf_strtab_emit (abfd
, strtab
))
4365 _bfd_elf_strtab_free (strtab
);
4368 abfd
->output_has_begun
= TRUE
;
4373 /* Make an initial estimate of the size of the program header. If we
4374 get the number wrong here, we'll redo section placement. */
4376 static bfd_size_type
4377 get_program_header_size (bfd
*abfd
, struct bfd_link_info
*info
)
4381 const struct elf_backend_data
*bed
;
4383 /* Assume we will need exactly two PT_LOAD segments: one for text
4384 and one for data. */
4387 s
= bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd
, ".interp");
4388 if (s
!= NULL
&& (s
->flags
& SEC_LOAD
) != 0 && s
->size
!= 0)
4390 /* If we have a loadable interpreter section, we need a
4391 PT_INTERP segment. In this case, assume we also need a
4392 PT_PHDR segment, although that may not be true for all
4397 if (bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd
, ".dynamic") != NULL
)
4399 /* We need a PT_DYNAMIC segment. */
4403 if (info
!= NULL
&& info
->relro
)
4405 /* We need a PT_GNU_RELRO segment. */
4409 if (elf_eh_frame_hdr (abfd
))
4411 /* We need a PT_GNU_EH_FRAME segment. */
4415 if (elf_stack_flags (abfd
))
4417 /* We need a PT_GNU_STACK segment. */
4421 s
= bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd
,
4422 NOTE_GNU_PROPERTY_SECTION_NAME
);
4423 if (s
!= NULL
&& s
->size
!= 0)
4425 /* We need a PT_GNU_PROPERTY segment. */
4429 for (s
= abfd
->sections
; s
!= NULL
; s
= s
->next
)
4431 if ((s
->flags
& SEC_LOAD
) != 0
4432 && elf_section_type (s
) == SHT_NOTE
)
4434 unsigned int alignment_power
;
4435 /* We need a PT_NOTE segment. */
4437 /* Try to create just one PT_NOTE segment for all adjacent
4438 loadable SHT_NOTE sections. gABI requires that within a
4439 PT_NOTE segment (and also inside of each SHT_NOTE section)
4440 each note should have the same alignment. So we check
4441 whether the sections are correctly aligned. */
4442 alignment_power
= s
->alignment_power
;
4443 while (s
->next
!= NULL
4444 && s
->next
->alignment_power
== alignment_power
4445 && (s
->next
->flags
& SEC_LOAD
) != 0
4446 && elf_section_type (s
->next
) == SHT_NOTE
)
4451 for (s
= abfd
->sections
; s
!= NULL
; s
= s
->next
)
4453 if (s
->flags
& SEC_THREAD_LOCAL
)
4455 /* We need a PT_TLS segment. */
4461 bed
= get_elf_backend_data (abfd
);
4463 if ((abfd
->flags
& D_PAGED
) != 0
4464 && (elf_tdata (abfd
)->has_gnu_osabi
& elf_gnu_osabi_mbind
) != 0)
4466 /* Add a PT_GNU_MBIND segment for each mbind section. */
4467 unsigned int page_align_power
= bfd_log2 (bed
->commonpagesize
);
4468 for (s
= abfd
->sections
; s
!= NULL
; s
= s
->next
)
4469 if (elf_section_flags (s
) & SHF_GNU_MBIND
)
4471 if (elf_section_data (s
)->this_hdr
.sh_info
> PT_GNU_MBIND_NUM
)
4474 /* xgettext:c-format */
4475 (_("%pB: GNU_MBIND section `%pA' has invalid "
4476 "sh_info field: %d"),
4477 abfd
, s
, elf_section_data (s
)->this_hdr
.sh_info
);
4480 /* Align mbind section to page size. */
4481 if (s
->alignment_power
< page_align_power
)
4482 s
->alignment_power
= page_align_power
;
4487 /* Let the backend count up any program headers it might need. */
4488 if (bed
->elf_backend_additional_program_headers
)
4492 a
= (*bed
->elf_backend_additional_program_headers
) (abfd
, info
);
4498 return segs
* bed
->s
->sizeof_phdr
;
4501 /* Find the segment that contains the output_section of section. */
4504 _bfd_elf_find_segment_containing_section (bfd
* abfd
, asection
* section
)
4506 struct elf_segment_map
*m
;
4507 Elf_Internal_Phdr
*p
;
4509 for (m
= elf_seg_map (abfd
), p
= elf_tdata (abfd
)->phdr
;
4515 for (i
= m
->count
- 1; i
>= 0; i
--)
4516 if (m
->sections
[i
] == section
)
4523 /* Create a mapping from a set of sections to a program segment. */
4525 static struct elf_segment_map
*
4526 make_mapping (bfd
*abfd
,
4527 asection
**sections
,
4532 struct elf_segment_map
*m
;
4537 amt
= sizeof (struct elf_segment_map
) - sizeof (asection
*);
4538 amt
+= (to
- from
) * sizeof (asection
*);
4539 m
= (struct elf_segment_map
*) bfd_zalloc (abfd
, amt
);
4543 m
->p_type
= PT_LOAD
;
4544 for (i
= from
, hdrpp
= sections
+ from
; i
< to
; i
++, hdrpp
++)
4545 m
->sections
[i
- from
] = *hdrpp
;
4546 m
->count
= to
- from
;
4548 if (from
== 0 && phdr
)
4550 /* Include the headers in the first PT_LOAD segment. */
4551 m
->includes_filehdr
= 1;
4552 m
->includes_phdrs
= 1;
4558 /* Create the PT_DYNAMIC segment, which includes DYNSEC. Returns NULL
4561 struct elf_segment_map
*
4562 _bfd_elf_make_dynamic_segment (bfd
*abfd
, asection
*dynsec
)
4564 struct elf_segment_map
*m
;
4566 m
= (struct elf_segment_map
*) bfd_zalloc (abfd
,
4567 sizeof (struct elf_segment_map
));
4571 m
->p_type
= PT_DYNAMIC
;
4573 m
->sections
[0] = dynsec
;
4578 /* Possibly add or remove segments from the segment map. */
4581 elf_modify_segment_map (bfd
*abfd
,
4582 struct bfd_link_info
*info
,
4583 bfd_boolean remove_empty_load
)
4585 struct elf_segment_map
**m
;
4586 const struct elf_backend_data
*bed
;
4588 /* The placement algorithm assumes that non allocated sections are
4589 not in PT_LOAD segments. We ensure this here by removing such
4590 sections from the segment map. We also remove excluded
4591 sections. Finally, any PT_LOAD segment without sections is
4593 m
= &elf_seg_map (abfd
);
4596 unsigned int i
, new_count
;
4598 for (new_count
= 0, i
= 0; i
< (*m
)->count
; i
++)
4600 if (((*m
)->sections
[i
]->flags
& SEC_EXCLUDE
) == 0
4601 && (((*m
)->sections
[i
]->flags
& SEC_ALLOC
) != 0
4602 || (*m
)->p_type
!= PT_LOAD
))
4604 (*m
)->sections
[new_count
] = (*m
)->sections
[i
];
4608 (*m
)->count
= new_count
;
4610 if (remove_empty_load
4611 && (*m
)->p_type
== PT_LOAD
4613 && !(*m
)->includes_phdrs
)
4619 bed
= get_elf_backend_data (abfd
);
4620 if (bed
->elf_backend_modify_segment_map
!= NULL
)
4622 if (!(*bed
->elf_backend_modify_segment_map
) (abfd
, info
))
4629 #define IS_TBSS(s) \
4630 ((s->flags & (SEC_THREAD_LOCAL | SEC_LOAD)) == SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)
4632 /* Set up a mapping from BFD sections to program segments. */
4635 _bfd_elf_map_sections_to_segments (bfd
*abfd
, struct bfd_link_info
*info
)
4638 struct elf_segment_map
*m
;
4639 asection
**sections
= NULL
;
4640 const struct elf_backend_data
*bed
= get_elf_backend_data (abfd
);
4641 bfd_boolean no_user_phdrs
;
4643 no_user_phdrs
= elf_seg_map (abfd
) == NULL
;
4646 info
->user_phdrs
= !no_user_phdrs
;
4648 if (no_user_phdrs
&& bfd_count_sections (abfd
) != 0)
4652 struct elf_segment_map
*mfirst
;
4653 struct elf_segment_map
**pm
;
4656 unsigned int hdr_index
;
4657 bfd_vma maxpagesize
;
4659 bfd_boolean phdr_in_segment
;
4660 bfd_boolean writable
;
4661 bfd_boolean executable
;
4662 unsigned int tls_count
= 0;
4663 asection
*first_tls
= NULL
;
4664 asection
*first_mbind
= NULL
;
4665 asection
*dynsec
, *eh_frame_hdr
;
4667 bfd_vma addr_mask
, wrap_to
= 0; /* Bytes. */
4668 bfd_size_type phdr_size
; /* Octets/bytes. */
4669 unsigned int opb
= bfd_octets_per_byte (abfd
, NULL
);
4671 /* Select the allocated sections, and sort them. */
4673 amt
= bfd_count_sections (abfd
) * sizeof (asection
*);
4674 sections
= (asection
**) bfd_malloc (amt
);
4675 if (sections
== NULL
)
4678 /* Calculate top address, avoiding undefined behaviour of shift
4679 left operator when shift count is equal to size of type
4681 addr_mask
= ((bfd_vma
) 1 << (bfd_arch_bits_per_address (abfd
) - 1)) - 1;
4682 addr_mask
= (addr_mask
<< 1) + 1;
4685 for (s
= abfd
->sections
; s
!= NULL
; s
= s
->next
)
4687 if ((s
->flags
& SEC_ALLOC
) != 0)
4689 /* target_index is unused until bfd_elf_final_link
4690 starts output of section symbols. Use it to make
4692 s
->target_index
= i
;
4695 /* A wrapping section potentially clashes with header. */
4696 if (((s
->lma
+ s
->size
/ opb
) & addr_mask
) < (s
->lma
& addr_mask
))
4697 wrap_to
= (s
->lma
+ s
->size
/ opb
) & addr_mask
;
4700 BFD_ASSERT (i
<= bfd_count_sections (abfd
));
4703 qsort (sections
, (size_t) count
, sizeof (asection
*), elf_sort_sections
);
4705 phdr_size
= elf_program_header_size (abfd
);
4706 if (phdr_size
== (bfd_size_type
) -1)
4707 phdr_size
= get_program_header_size (abfd
, info
);
4708 phdr_size
+= bed
->s
->sizeof_ehdr
;
4709 /* phdr_size is compared to LMA values which are in bytes. */
4711 maxpagesize
= bed
->maxpagesize
;
4712 if (maxpagesize
== 0)
4714 phdr_in_segment
= info
!= NULL
&& info
->load_phdrs
;
4716 && (((sections
[0]->lma
& addr_mask
) & (maxpagesize
- 1))
4717 >= (phdr_size
& (maxpagesize
- 1))))
4718 /* For compatibility with old scripts that may not be using
4719 SIZEOF_HEADERS, add headers when it looks like space has
4720 been left for them. */
4721 phdr_in_segment
= TRUE
;
4723 /* Build the mapping. */
4727 /* If we have a .interp section, then create a PT_PHDR segment for
4728 the program headers and a PT_INTERP segment for the .interp
4730 s
= bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd
, ".interp");
4731 if (s
!= NULL
&& (s
->flags
& SEC_LOAD
) != 0 && s
->size
!= 0)
4733 amt
= sizeof (struct elf_segment_map
);
4734 m
= (struct elf_segment_map
*) bfd_zalloc (abfd
, amt
);
4738 m
->p_type
= PT_PHDR
;
4740 m
->p_flags_valid
= 1;
4741 m
->includes_phdrs
= 1;
4742 phdr_in_segment
= TRUE
;
4746 amt
= sizeof (struct elf_segment_map
);
4747 m
= (struct elf_segment_map
*) bfd_zalloc (abfd
, amt
);
4751 m
->p_type
= PT_INTERP
;
4759 /* Look through the sections. We put sections in the same program
4760 segment when the start of the second section can be placed within
4761 a few bytes of the end of the first section. */
4767 dynsec
= bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd
, ".dynamic");
4769 && (dynsec
->flags
& SEC_LOAD
) == 0)
4772 if ((abfd
->flags
& D_PAGED
) == 0)
4773 phdr_in_segment
= FALSE
;
4775 /* Deal with -Ttext or something similar such that the first section
4776 is not adjacent to the program headers. This is an
4777 approximation, since at this point we don't know exactly how many
4778 program headers we will need. */
4779 if (phdr_in_segment
&& count
> 0)
4781 bfd_vma phdr_lma
; /* Bytes. */
4782 bfd_boolean separate_phdr
= FALSE
;
4784 phdr_lma
= (sections
[0]->lma
- phdr_size
) & addr_mask
& -maxpagesize
;
4786 && info
->separate_code
4787 && (sections
[0]->flags
& SEC_CODE
) != 0)
4789 /* If data sections should be separate from code and
4790 thus not executable, and the first section is
4791 executable then put the file and program headers in
4792 their own PT_LOAD. */
4793 separate_phdr
= TRUE
;
4794 if ((((phdr_lma
+ phdr_size
- 1) & addr_mask
& -maxpagesize
)
4795 == (sections
[0]->lma
& addr_mask
& -maxpagesize
)))
4797 /* The file and program headers are currently on the
4798 same page as the first section. Put them on the
4799 previous page if we can. */
4800 if (phdr_lma
>= maxpagesize
)
4801 phdr_lma
-= maxpagesize
;
4803 separate_phdr
= FALSE
;
4806 if ((sections
[0]->lma
& addr_mask
) < phdr_lma
4807 || (sections
[0]->lma
& addr_mask
) < phdr_size
)
4808 /* If file and program headers would be placed at the end
4809 of memory then it's probably better to omit them. */
4810 phdr_in_segment
= FALSE
;
4811 else if (phdr_lma
< wrap_to
)
4812 /* If a section wraps around to where we'll be placing
4813 file and program headers, then the headers will be
4815 phdr_in_segment
= FALSE
;
4816 else if (separate_phdr
)
4818 m
= make_mapping (abfd
, sections
, 0, 0, phdr_in_segment
);
4821 m
->p_paddr
= phdr_lma
* opb
;
4823 = (sections
[0]->vma
- phdr_size
) & addr_mask
& -maxpagesize
;
4824 m
->p_paddr_valid
= 1;
4827 phdr_in_segment
= FALSE
;
4831 for (i
= 0, hdrpp
= sections
; i
< count
; i
++, hdrpp
++)
4834 bfd_boolean new_segment
;
4838 /* See if this section and the last one will fit in the same
4841 if (last_hdr
== NULL
)
4843 /* If we don't have a segment yet, then we don't need a new
4844 one (we build the last one after this loop). */
4845 new_segment
= FALSE
;
4847 else if (last_hdr
->lma
- last_hdr
->vma
!= hdr
->lma
- hdr
->vma
)
4849 /* If this section has a different relation between the
4850 virtual address and the load address, then we need a new
4854 else if (hdr
->lma
< last_hdr
->lma
+ last_size
4855 || last_hdr
->lma
+ last_size
< last_hdr
->lma
)
4857 /* If this section has a load address that makes it overlap
4858 the previous section, then we need a new segment. */
4861 else if ((abfd
->flags
& D_PAGED
) != 0
4862 && (((last_hdr
->lma
+ last_size
- 1) & -maxpagesize
)
4863 == (hdr
->lma
& -maxpagesize
)))
4865 /* If we are demand paged then we can't map two disk
4866 pages onto the same memory page. */
4867 new_segment
= FALSE
;
4869 /* In the next test we have to be careful when last_hdr->lma is close
4870 to the end of the address space. If the aligned address wraps
4871 around to the start of the address space, then there are no more
4872 pages left in memory and it is OK to assume that the current
4873 section can be included in the current segment. */
4874 else if ((BFD_ALIGN (last_hdr
->lma
+ last_size
, maxpagesize
)
4875 + maxpagesize
> last_hdr
->lma
)
4876 && (BFD_ALIGN (last_hdr
->lma
+ last_size
, maxpagesize
)
4877 + maxpagesize
<= hdr
->lma
))
4879 /* If putting this section in this segment would force us to
4880 skip a page in the segment, then we need a new segment. */
4883 else if ((last_hdr
->flags
& (SEC_LOAD
| SEC_THREAD_LOCAL
)) == 0
4884 && (hdr
->flags
& (SEC_LOAD
| SEC_THREAD_LOCAL
)) != 0)
4886 /* We don't want to put a loaded section after a
4887 nonloaded (ie. bss style) section in the same segment
4888 as that will force the non-loaded section to be loaded.
4889 Consider .tbss sections as loaded for this purpose. */
4892 else if ((abfd
->flags
& D_PAGED
) == 0)
4894 /* If the file is not demand paged, which means that we
4895 don't require the sections to be correctly aligned in the
4896 file, then there is no other reason for a new segment. */
4897 new_segment
= FALSE
;
4899 else if (info
!= NULL
4900 && info
->separate_code
4901 && executable
!= ((hdr
->flags
& SEC_CODE
) != 0))
4906 && (hdr
->flags
& SEC_READONLY
) == 0)
4908 /* We don't want to put a writable section in a read only
4914 /* Otherwise, we can use the same segment. */
4915 new_segment
= FALSE
;
4918 /* Allow interested parties a chance to override our decision. */
4919 if (last_hdr
!= NULL
4921 && info
->callbacks
->override_segment_assignment
!= NULL
)
4923 = info
->callbacks
->override_segment_assignment (info
, abfd
, hdr
,
4929 if ((hdr
->flags
& SEC_READONLY
) == 0)
4931 if ((hdr
->flags
& SEC_CODE
) != 0)
4934 /* .tbss sections effectively have zero size. */
4935 last_size
= (!IS_TBSS (hdr
) ? hdr
->size
: 0) / opb
;
4939 /* We need a new program segment. We must create a new program
4940 header holding all the sections from hdr_index until hdr. */
4942 m
= make_mapping (abfd
, sections
, hdr_index
, i
, phdr_in_segment
);
4949 if ((hdr
->flags
& SEC_READONLY
) == 0)
4954 if ((hdr
->flags
& SEC_CODE
) == 0)
4960 /* .tbss sections effectively have zero size. */
4961 last_size
= (!IS_TBSS (hdr
) ? hdr
->size
: 0) / opb
;
4963 phdr_in_segment
= FALSE
;
4966 /* Create a final PT_LOAD program segment, but not if it's just
4968 if (last_hdr
!= NULL
4969 && (i
- hdr_index
!= 1
4970 || !IS_TBSS (last_hdr
)))
4972 m
= make_mapping (abfd
, sections
, hdr_index
, i
, phdr_in_segment
);
4980 /* If there is a .dynamic section, throw in a PT_DYNAMIC segment. */
4983 m
= _bfd_elf_make_dynamic_segment (abfd
, dynsec
);
4990 /* For each batch of consecutive loadable SHT_NOTE sections,
4991 add a PT_NOTE segment. We don't use bfd_get_section_by_name,
4992 because if we link together nonloadable .note sections and
4993 loadable .note sections, we will generate two .note sections
4994 in the output file. */
4995 for (s
= abfd
->sections
; s
!= NULL
; s
= s
->next
)
4997 if ((s
->flags
& SEC_LOAD
) != 0
4998 && elf_section_type (s
) == SHT_NOTE
)
5001 unsigned int alignment_power
= s
->alignment_power
;
5004 for (s2
= s
; s2
->next
!= NULL
; s2
= s2
->next
)
5006 if (s2
->next
->alignment_power
== alignment_power
5007 && (s2
->next
->flags
& SEC_LOAD
) != 0
5008 && elf_section_type (s2
->next
) == SHT_NOTE
5009 && align_power (s2
->lma
+ s2
->size
/ opb
,
5016 amt
= sizeof (struct elf_segment_map
) - sizeof (asection
*);
5017 amt
+= count
* sizeof (asection
*);
5018 m
= (struct elf_segment_map
*) bfd_zalloc (abfd
, amt
);
5022 m
->p_type
= PT_NOTE
;
5026 m
->sections
[m
->count
- count
--] = s
;
5027 BFD_ASSERT ((s
->flags
& SEC_THREAD_LOCAL
) == 0);
5030 m
->sections
[m
->count
- 1] = s
;
5031 BFD_ASSERT ((s
->flags
& SEC_THREAD_LOCAL
) == 0);
5035 if (s
->flags
& SEC_THREAD_LOCAL
)
5041 if (first_mbind
== NULL
5042 && (elf_section_flags (s
) & SHF_GNU_MBIND
) != 0)
5046 /* If there are any SHF_TLS output sections, add PT_TLS segment. */
5049 amt
= sizeof (struct elf_segment_map
) - sizeof (asection
*);
5050 amt
+= tls_count
* sizeof (asection
*);
5051 m
= (struct elf_segment_map
*) bfd_zalloc (abfd
, amt
);
5056 m
->count
= tls_count
;
5057 /* Mandated PF_R. */
5059 m
->p_flags_valid
= 1;
5061 for (i
= 0; i
< tls_count
; ++i
)
5063 if ((s
->flags
& SEC_THREAD_LOCAL
) == 0)
5066 (_("%pB: TLS sections are not adjacent:"), abfd
);
5069 while (i
< tls_count
)
5071 if ((s
->flags
& SEC_THREAD_LOCAL
) != 0)
5073 _bfd_error_handler (_(" TLS: %pA"), s
);
5077 _bfd_error_handler (_(" non-TLS: %pA"), s
);
5080 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value
);
5092 && (abfd
->flags
& D_PAGED
) != 0
5093 && (elf_tdata (abfd
)->has_gnu_osabi
& elf_gnu_osabi_mbind
) != 0)
5094 for (s
= first_mbind
; s
!= NULL
; s
= s
->next
)
5095 if ((elf_section_flags (s
) & SHF_GNU_MBIND
) != 0
5096 && elf_section_data (s
)->this_hdr
.sh_info
<= PT_GNU_MBIND_NUM
)
5098 /* Mandated PF_R. */
5099 unsigned long p_flags
= PF_R
;
5100 if ((s
->flags
& SEC_READONLY
) == 0)
5102 if ((s
->flags
& SEC_CODE
) != 0)
5105 amt
= sizeof (struct elf_segment_map
) + sizeof (asection
*);
5106 m
= bfd_zalloc (abfd
, amt
);
5110 m
->p_type
= (PT_GNU_MBIND_LO
5111 + elf_section_data (s
)->this_hdr
.sh_info
);
5113 m
->p_flags_valid
= 1;
5115 m
->p_flags
= p_flags
;
5121 s
= bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd
,
5122 NOTE_GNU_PROPERTY_SECTION_NAME
);
5123 if (s
!= NULL
&& s
->size
!= 0)
5125 amt
= sizeof (struct elf_segment_map
) + sizeof (asection
*);
5126 m
= bfd_zalloc (abfd
, amt
);
5130 m
->p_type
= PT_GNU_PROPERTY
;
5132 m
->p_flags_valid
= 1;
5139 /* If there is a .eh_frame_hdr section, throw in a PT_GNU_EH_FRAME
5141 eh_frame_hdr
= elf_eh_frame_hdr (abfd
);
5142 if (eh_frame_hdr
!= NULL
5143 && (eh_frame_hdr
->output_section
->flags
& SEC_LOAD
) != 0)
5145 amt
= sizeof (struct elf_segment_map
);
5146 m
= (struct elf_segment_map
*) bfd_zalloc (abfd
, amt
);
5150 m
->p_type
= PT_GNU_EH_FRAME
;
5152 m
->sections
[0] = eh_frame_hdr
->output_section
;
5158 if (elf_stack_flags (abfd
))
5160 amt
= sizeof (struct elf_segment_map
);
5161 m
= (struct elf_segment_map
*) bfd_zalloc (abfd
, amt
);
5165 m
->p_type
= PT_GNU_STACK
;
5166 m
->p_flags
= elf_stack_flags (abfd
);
5167 m
->p_align
= bed
->stack_align
;
5168 m
->p_flags_valid
= 1;
5169 m
->p_align_valid
= m
->p_align
!= 0;
5170 if (info
->stacksize
> 0)
5172 m
->p_size
= info
->stacksize
;
5173 m
->p_size_valid
= 1;
5180 if (info
!= NULL
&& info
->relro
)
5182 for (m
= mfirst
; m
!= NULL
; m
= m
->next
)
5184 if (m
->p_type
== PT_LOAD
5186 && m
->sections
[0]->vma
>= info
->relro_start
5187 && m
->sections
[0]->vma
< info
->relro_end
)
5190 while (--i
!= (unsigned) -1)
5192 if (m
->sections
[i
]->size
> 0
5193 && (m
->sections
[i
]->flags
& (SEC_LOAD
| SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
))
5194 == (SEC_LOAD
| SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
))
5198 if (i
!= (unsigned) -1)
5203 /* Make a PT_GNU_RELRO segment only when it isn't empty. */
5206 amt
= sizeof (struct elf_segment_map
);
5207 m
= (struct elf_segment_map
*) bfd_zalloc (abfd
, amt
);
5211 m
->p_type
= PT_GNU_RELRO
;
5218 elf_seg_map (abfd
) = mfirst
;
5221 if (!elf_modify_segment_map (abfd
, info
, no_user_phdrs
))
5224 for (count
= 0, m
= elf_seg_map (abfd
); m
!= NULL
; m
= m
->next
)
5226 elf_program_header_size (abfd
) = count
* bed
->s
->sizeof_phdr
;
5235 /* Sort sections by address. */
5238 elf_sort_sections (const void *arg1
, const void *arg2
)
5240 const asection
*sec1
= *(const asection
**) arg1
;
5241 const asection
*sec2
= *(const asection
**) arg2
;
5242 bfd_size_type size1
, size2
;
5244 /* Sort by LMA first, since this is the address used to
5245 place the section into a segment. */
5246 if (sec1
->lma
< sec2
->lma
)
5248 else if (sec1
->lma
> sec2
->lma
)
5251 /* Then sort by VMA. Normally the LMA and the VMA will be
5252 the same, and this will do nothing. */
5253 if (sec1
->vma
< sec2
->vma
)
5255 else if (sec1
->vma
> sec2
->vma
)
5258 /* Put !SEC_LOAD sections after SEC_LOAD ones. */
5260 #define TOEND(x) (((x)->flags & (SEC_LOAD | SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)) == 0 \
5268 else if (TOEND (sec2
))
5273 /* Sort by size, to put zero sized sections
5274 before others at the same address. */
5276 size1
= (sec1
->flags
& SEC_LOAD
) ? sec1
->size
: 0;
5277 size2
= (sec2
->flags
& SEC_LOAD
) ? sec2
->size
: 0;
5284 return sec1
->target_index
- sec2
->target_index
;
5287 /* This qsort comparison functions sorts PT_LOAD segments first and
5288 by p_paddr, for assign_file_positions_for_load_sections. */
5291 elf_sort_segments (const void *arg1
, const void *arg2
)
5293 const struct elf_segment_map
*m1
= *(const struct elf_segment_map
**) arg1
;
5294 const struct elf_segment_map
*m2
= *(const struct elf_segment_map
**) arg2
;
5296 if (m1
->p_type
!= m2
->p_type
)
5298 if (m1
->p_type
== PT_NULL
)
5300 if (m2
->p_type
== PT_NULL
)
5302 return m1
->p_type
< m2
->p_type
? -1 : 1;
5304 if (m1
->includes_filehdr
!= m2
->includes_filehdr
)
5305 return m1
->includes_filehdr
? -1 : 1;
5306 if (m1
->no_sort_lma
!= m2
->no_sort_lma
)
5307 return m1
->no_sort_lma
? -1 : 1;
5308 if (m1
->p_type
== PT_LOAD
&& !m1
->no_sort_lma
)
5310 bfd_vma lma1
, lma2
; /* Octets. */
5312 if (m1
->p_paddr_valid
)
5314 else if (m1
->count
!= 0)
5316 unsigned int opb
= bfd_octets_per_byte (m1
->sections
[0]->owner
,
5318 lma1
= (m1
->sections
[0]->lma
+ m1
->p_vaddr_offset
) * opb
;
5321 if (m2
->p_paddr_valid
)
5323 else if (m2
->count
!= 0)
5325 unsigned int opb
= bfd_octets_per_byte (m2
->sections
[0]->owner
,
5327 lma2
= (m2
->sections
[0]->lma
+ m2
->p_vaddr_offset
) * opb
;
5330 return lma1
< lma2
? -1 : 1;
5332 if (m1
->idx
!= m2
->idx
)
5333 return m1
->idx
< m2
->idx
? -1 : 1;
5337 /* Ian Lance Taylor writes:
5339 We shouldn't be using % with a negative signed number. That's just
5340 not good. We have to make sure either that the number is not
5341 negative, or that the number has an unsigned type. When the types
5342 are all the same size they wind up as unsigned. When file_ptr is a
5343 larger signed type, the arithmetic winds up as signed long long,
5346 What we're trying to say here is something like ``increase OFF by
5347 the least amount that will cause it to be equal to the VMA modulo
5349 /* In other words, something like:
5351 vma_offset = m->sections[0]->vma % bed->maxpagesize;
5352 off_offset = off % bed->maxpagesize;
5353 if (vma_offset < off_offset)
5354 adjustment = vma_offset + bed->maxpagesize - off_offset;
5356 adjustment = vma_offset - off_offset;
5358 which can be collapsed into the expression below. */
5361 vma_page_aligned_bias (bfd_vma vma
, ufile_ptr off
, bfd_vma maxpagesize
)
5363 /* PR binutils/16199: Handle an alignment of zero. */
5364 if (maxpagesize
== 0)
5366 return ((vma
- off
) % maxpagesize
);
5370 print_segment_map (const struct elf_segment_map
*m
)
5373 const char *pt
= get_segment_type (m
->p_type
);
5378 if (m
->p_type
>= PT_LOPROC
&& m
->p_type
<= PT_HIPROC
)
5379 sprintf (buf
, "LOPROC+%7.7x",
5380 (unsigned int) (m
->p_type
- PT_LOPROC
));
5381 else if (m
->p_type
>= PT_LOOS
&& m
->p_type
<= PT_HIOS
)
5382 sprintf (buf
, "LOOS+%7.7x",
5383 (unsigned int) (m
->p_type
- PT_LOOS
));
5385 snprintf (buf
, sizeof (buf
), "%8.8x",
5386 (unsigned int) m
->p_type
);
5390 fprintf (stderr
, "%s:", pt
);
5391 for (j
= 0; j
< m
->count
; j
++)
5392 fprintf (stderr
, " %s", m
->sections
[j
]->name
);
5398 write_zeros (bfd
*abfd
, file_ptr pos
, bfd_size_type len
)
5403 if (bfd_seek (abfd
, pos
, SEEK_SET
) != 0)
5405 buf
= bfd_zmalloc (len
);
5408 ret
= bfd_bwrite (buf
, len
, abfd
) == len
;
5413 /* Assign file positions to the sections based on the mapping from
5414 sections to segments. This function also sets up some fields in
5418 assign_file_positions_for_load_sections (bfd
*abfd
,
5419 struct bfd_link_info
*link_info
)
5421 const struct elf_backend_data
*bed
= get_elf_backend_data (abfd
);
5422 struct elf_segment_map
*m
;
5423 struct elf_segment_map
*phdr_load_seg
;
5424 Elf_Internal_Phdr
*phdrs
;
5425 Elf_Internal_Phdr
*p
;
5426 file_ptr off
; /* Octets. */
5427 bfd_size_type maxpagesize
;
5428 unsigned int alloc
, actual
;
5430 struct elf_segment_map
**sorted_seg_map
;
5431 unsigned int opb
= bfd_octets_per_byte (abfd
, NULL
);
5433 if (link_info
== NULL
5434 && !_bfd_elf_map_sections_to_segments (abfd
, link_info
))
5438 for (m
= elf_seg_map (abfd
); m
!= NULL
; m
= m
->next
)
5443 elf_elfheader (abfd
)->e_phoff
= bed
->s
->sizeof_ehdr
;
5444 elf_elfheader (abfd
)->e_phentsize
= bed
->s
->sizeof_phdr
;
5448 /* PR binutils/12467. */
5449 elf_elfheader (abfd
)->e_phoff
= 0;
5450 elf_elfheader (abfd
)->e_phentsize
= 0;
5453 elf_elfheader (abfd
)->e_phnum
= alloc
;
5455 if (elf_program_header_size (abfd
) == (bfd_size_type
) -1)
5458 elf_program_header_size (abfd
) = alloc
* bed
->s
->sizeof_phdr
;
5462 actual
= elf_program_header_size (abfd
) / bed
->s
->sizeof_phdr
;
5463 BFD_ASSERT (elf_program_header_size (abfd
)
5464 == actual
* bed
->s
->sizeof_phdr
);
5465 BFD_ASSERT (actual
>= alloc
);
5470 elf_next_file_pos (abfd
) = bed
->s
->sizeof_ehdr
;
5474 /* We're writing the size in elf_program_header_size (abfd),
5475 see assign_file_positions_except_relocs, so make sure we have
5476 that amount allocated, with trailing space cleared.
5477 The variable alloc contains the computed need, while
5478 elf_program_header_size (abfd) contains the size used for the
5480 See ld/emultempl/elf-generic.em:gld${EMULATION_NAME}_map_segments
5481 where the layout is forced to according to a larger size in the
5482 last iterations for the testcase ld-elf/header. */
5483 phdrs
= bfd_zalloc (abfd
, (actual
* sizeof (*phdrs
)
5484 + alloc
* sizeof (*sorted_seg_map
)));
5485 sorted_seg_map
= (struct elf_segment_map
**) (phdrs
+ actual
);
5486 elf_tdata (abfd
)->phdr
= phdrs
;
5490 for (m
= elf_seg_map (abfd
), j
= 0; m
!= NULL
; m
= m
->next
, j
++)
5492 sorted_seg_map
[j
] = m
;
5493 /* If elf_segment_map is not from map_sections_to_segments, the
5494 sections may not be correctly ordered. NOTE: sorting should
5495 not be done to the PT_NOTE section of a corefile, which may
5496 contain several pseudo-sections artificially created by bfd.
5497 Sorting these pseudo-sections breaks things badly. */
5499 && !(elf_elfheader (abfd
)->e_type
== ET_CORE
5500 && m
->p_type
== PT_NOTE
))
5502 for (i
= 0; i
< m
->count
; i
++)
5503 m
->sections
[i
]->target_index
= i
;
5504 qsort (m
->sections
, (size_t) m
->count
, sizeof (asection
*),
5509 qsort (sorted_seg_map
, alloc
, sizeof (*sorted_seg_map
),
5513 if ((abfd
->flags
& D_PAGED
) != 0)
5514 maxpagesize
= bed
->maxpagesize
;
5516 /* Sections must map to file offsets past the ELF file header. */
5517 off
= bed
->s
->sizeof_ehdr
;
5518 /* And if one of the PT_LOAD headers doesn't include the program
5519 headers then we'll be mapping program headers in the usual
5520 position after the ELF file header. */
5521 phdr_load_seg
= NULL
;
5522 for (j
= 0; j
< alloc
; j
++)
5524 m
= sorted_seg_map
[j
];
5525 if (m
->p_type
!= PT_LOAD
)
5527 if (m
->includes_phdrs
)
5533 if (phdr_load_seg
== NULL
)
5534 off
+= actual
* bed
->s
->sizeof_phdr
;
5536 for (j
= 0; j
< alloc
; j
++)
5539 bfd_vma off_adjust
; /* Octets. */
5540 bfd_boolean no_contents
;
5542 /* An ELF segment (described by Elf_Internal_Phdr) may contain a
5543 number of sections with contents contributing to both p_filesz
5544 and p_memsz, followed by a number of sections with no contents
5545 that just contribute to p_memsz. In this loop, OFF tracks next
5546 available file offset for PT_LOAD and PT_NOTE segments. */
5547 m
= sorted_seg_map
[j
];
5549 p
->p_type
= m
->p_type
;
5550 p
->p_flags
= m
->p_flags
;
5553 p
->p_vaddr
= m
->p_vaddr_offset
* opb
;
5555 p
->p_vaddr
= (m
->sections
[0]->vma
+ m
->p_vaddr_offset
) * opb
;
5557 if (m
->p_paddr_valid
)
5558 p
->p_paddr
= m
->p_paddr
;
5559 else if (m
->count
== 0)
5562 p
->p_paddr
= (m
->sections
[0]->lma
+ m
->p_vaddr_offset
) * opb
;
5564 if (p
->p_type
== PT_LOAD
5565 && (abfd
->flags
& D_PAGED
) != 0)
5567 /* p_align in demand paged PT_LOAD segments effectively stores
5568 the maximum page size. When copying an executable with
5569 objcopy, we set m->p_align from the input file. Use this
5570 value for maxpagesize rather than bed->maxpagesize, which
5571 may be different. Note that we use maxpagesize for PT_TLS
5572 segment alignment later in this function, so we are relying
5573 on at least one PT_LOAD segment appearing before a PT_TLS
5575 if (m
->p_align_valid
)
5576 maxpagesize
= m
->p_align
;
5578 p
->p_align
= maxpagesize
;
5580 else if (m
->p_align_valid
)
5581 p
->p_align
= m
->p_align
;
5582 else if (m
->count
== 0)
5583 p
->p_align
= 1 << bed
->s
->log_file_align
;
5585 if (m
== phdr_load_seg
)
5587 if (!m
->includes_filehdr
)
5589 off
+= actual
* bed
->s
->sizeof_phdr
;
5592 no_contents
= FALSE
;
5594 if (p
->p_type
== PT_LOAD
5597 bfd_size_type align
; /* Bytes. */
5598 unsigned int align_power
= 0;
5600 if (m
->p_align_valid
)
5604 for (i
= 0, secpp
= m
->sections
; i
< m
->count
; i
++, secpp
++)
5606 unsigned int secalign
;
5608 secalign
= bfd_section_alignment (*secpp
);
5609 if (secalign
> align_power
)
5610 align_power
= secalign
;
5612 align
= (bfd_size_type
) 1 << align_power
;
5613 if (align
< maxpagesize
)
5614 align
= maxpagesize
;
5617 for (i
= 0; i
< m
->count
; i
++)
5618 if ((m
->sections
[i
]->flags
& (SEC_LOAD
| SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
)) == 0)
5619 /* If we aren't making room for this section, then
5620 it must be SHT_NOBITS regardless of what we've
5621 set via struct bfd_elf_special_section. */
5622 elf_section_type (m
->sections
[i
]) = SHT_NOBITS
;
5624 /* Find out whether this segment contains any loadable
5627 for (i
= 0; i
< m
->count
; i
++)
5628 if (elf_section_type (m
->sections
[i
]) != SHT_NOBITS
)
5630 no_contents
= FALSE
;
5634 off_adjust
= vma_page_aligned_bias (p
->p_vaddr
, off
, align
* opb
);
5636 /* Broken hardware and/or kernel require that files do not
5637 map the same page with different permissions on some hppa
5640 && (abfd
->flags
& D_PAGED
) != 0
5641 && bed
->no_page_alias
5642 && (off
& (maxpagesize
- 1)) != 0
5643 && ((off
& -maxpagesize
)
5644 == ((off
+ off_adjust
) & -maxpagesize
)))
5645 off_adjust
+= maxpagesize
;
5649 /* We shouldn't need to align the segment on disk since
5650 the segment doesn't need file space, but the gABI
5651 arguably requires the alignment and glibc ld.so
5652 checks it. So to comply with the alignment
5653 requirement but not waste file space, we adjust
5654 p_offset for just this segment. (OFF_ADJUST is
5655 subtracted from OFF later.) This may put p_offset
5656 past the end of file, but that shouldn't matter. */
5661 /* Make sure the .dynamic section is the first section in the
5662 PT_DYNAMIC segment. */
5663 else if (p
->p_type
== PT_DYNAMIC
5665 && strcmp (m
->sections
[0]->name
, ".dynamic") != 0)
5668 (_("%pB: The first section in the PT_DYNAMIC segment"
5669 " is not the .dynamic section"),
5671 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value
);
5674 /* Set the note section type to SHT_NOTE. */
5675 else if (p
->p_type
== PT_NOTE
)
5676 for (i
= 0; i
< m
->count
; i
++)
5677 elf_section_type (m
->sections
[i
]) = SHT_NOTE
;
5679 if (m
->includes_filehdr
)
5681 if (!m
->p_flags_valid
)
5683 p
->p_filesz
= bed
->s
->sizeof_ehdr
;
5684 p
->p_memsz
= bed
->s
->sizeof_ehdr
;
5685 if (p
->p_type
== PT_LOAD
)
5689 if (p
->p_vaddr
< (bfd_vma
) off
5690 || (!m
->p_paddr_valid
5691 && p
->p_paddr
< (bfd_vma
) off
))
5694 (_("%pB: not enough room for program headers,"
5695 " try linking with -N"),
5697 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value
);
5701 if (!m
->p_paddr_valid
)
5705 else if (sorted_seg_map
[0]->includes_filehdr
)
5707 Elf_Internal_Phdr
*filehdr
= phdrs
+ sorted_seg_map
[0]->idx
;
5708 p
->p_vaddr
= filehdr
->p_vaddr
;
5709 if (!m
->p_paddr_valid
)
5710 p
->p_paddr
= filehdr
->p_paddr
;
5714 if (m
->includes_phdrs
)
5716 if (!m
->p_flags_valid
)
5718 p
->p_filesz
+= actual
* bed
->s
->sizeof_phdr
;
5719 p
->p_memsz
+= actual
* bed
->s
->sizeof_phdr
;
5720 if (!m
->includes_filehdr
)
5722 if (p
->p_type
== PT_LOAD
)
5724 elf_elfheader (abfd
)->e_phoff
= p
->p_offset
;
5727 p
->p_vaddr
-= off
- p
->p_offset
;
5728 if (!m
->p_paddr_valid
)
5729 p
->p_paddr
-= off
- p
->p_offset
;
5732 else if (phdr_load_seg
!= NULL
)
5734 Elf_Internal_Phdr
*phdr
= phdrs
+ phdr_load_seg
->idx
;
5735 bfd_vma phdr_off
= 0; /* Octets. */
5736 if (phdr_load_seg
->includes_filehdr
)
5737 phdr_off
= bed
->s
->sizeof_ehdr
;
5738 p
->p_vaddr
= phdr
->p_vaddr
+ phdr_off
;
5739 if (!m
->p_paddr_valid
)
5740 p
->p_paddr
= phdr
->p_paddr
+ phdr_off
;
5741 p
->p_offset
= phdr
->p_offset
+ phdr_off
;
5744 p
->p_offset
= bed
->s
->sizeof_ehdr
;
5748 if (p
->p_type
== PT_LOAD
5749 || (p
->p_type
== PT_NOTE
&& bfd_get_format (abfd
) == bfd_core
))
5751 if (!m
->includes_filehdr
&& !m
->includes_phdrs
)
5756 /* Put meaningless p_offset for PT_LOAD segments
5757 without file contents somewhere within the first
5758 page, in an attempt to not point past EOF. */
5759 bfd_size_type align
= maxpagesize
;
5760 if (align
< p
->p_align
)
5764 p
->p_offset
= off
% align
;
5769 file_ptr adjust
; /* Octets. */
5771 adjust
= off
- (p
->p_offset
+ p
->p_filesz
);
5773 p
->p_filesz
+= adjust
;
5774 p
->p_memsz
+= adjust
;
5778 /* Set up p_filesz, p_memsz, p_align and p_flags from the section
5779 maps. Set filepos for sections in PT_LOAD segments, and in
5780 core files, for sections in PT_NOTE segments.
5781 assign_file_positions_for_non_load_sections will set filepos
5782 for other sections and update p_filesz for other segments. */
5783 for (i
= 0, secpp
= m
->sections
; i
< m
->count
; i
++, secpp
++)
5786 bfd_size_type align
;
5787 Elf_Internal_Shdr
*this_hdr
;
5790 this_hdr
= &elf_section_data (sec
)->this_hdr
;
5791 align
= (bfd_size_type
) 1 << bfd_section_alignment (sec
);
5793 if ((p
->p_type
== PT_LOAD
5794 || p
->p_type
== PT_TLS
)
5795 && (this_hdr
->sh_type
!= SHT_NOBITS
5796 || ((this_hdr
->sh_flags
& SHF_ALLOC
) != 0
5797 && ((this_hdr
->sh_flags
& SHF_TLS
) == 0
5798 || p
->p_type
== PT_TLS
))))
5800 bfd_vma p_start
= p
->p_paddr
; /* Octets. */
5801 bfd_vma p_end
= p_start
+ p
->p_memsz
; /* Octets. */
5802 bfd_vma s_start
= sec
->lma
* opb
; /* Octets. */
5803 bfd_vma adjust
= s_start
- p_end
; /* Octets. */
5807 || p_end
< p_start
))
5810 /* xgettext:c-format */
5811 (_("%pB: section %pA lma %#" PRIx64
" adjusted to %#" PRIx64
),
5812 abfd
, sec
, (uint64_t) s_start
/ opb
,
5813 (uint64_t) p_end
/ opb
);
5815 sec
->lma
= p_end
/ opb
;
5817 p
->p_memsz
+= adjust
;
5819 if (p
->p_type
== PT_LOAD
)
5821 if (this_hdr
->sh_type
!= SHT_NOBITS
)
5824 if (p
->p_filesz
+ adjust
< p
->p_memsz
)
5826 /* We have a PROGBITS section following NOBITS ones.
5827 Allocate file space for the NOBITS section(s) and
5829 adjust
= p
->p_memsz
- p
->p_filesz
;
5830 if (!write_zeros (abfd
, off
, adjust
))
5834 /* We only adjust sh_offset in SHT_NOBITS sections
5835 as would seem proper for their address when the
5836 section is first in the segment. sh_offset
5837 doesn't really have any significance for
5838 SHT_NOBITS anyway, apart from a notional position
5839 relative to other sections. Historically we
5840 didn't bother with adjusting sh_offset and some
5841 programs depend on it not being adjusted. See
5842 pr12921 and pr25662. */
5843 if (this_hdr
->sh_type
!= SHT_NOBITS
|| i
== 0)
5846 if (this_hdr
->sh_type
== SHT_NOBITS
)
5847 off_adjust
+= adjust
;
5850 if (this_hdr
->sh_type
!= SHT_NOBITS
)
5851 p
->p_filesz
+= adjust
;
5854 if (p
->p_type
== PT_NOTE
&& bfd_get_format (abfd
) == bfd_core
)
5856 /* The section at i == 0 is the one that actually contains
5860 this_hdr
->sh_offset
= sec
->filepos
= off
;
5861 off
+= this_hdr
->sh_size
;
5862 p
->p_filesz
= this_hdr
->sh_size
;
5868 /* The rest are fake sections that shouldn't be written. */
5877 if (p
->p_type
== PT_LOAD
)
5879 this_hdr
->sh_offset
= sec
->filepos
= off
;
5880 if (this_hdr
->sh_type
!= SHT_NOBITS
)
5881 off
+= this_hdr
->sh_size
;
5883 else if (this_hdr
->sh_type
== SHT_NOBITS
5884 && (this_hdr
->sh_flags
& SHF_TLS
) != 0
5885 && this_hdr
->sh_offset
== 0)
5887 /* This is a .tbss section that didn't get a PT_LOAD.
5888 (See _bfd_elf_map_sections_to_segments "Create a
5889 final PT_LOAD".) Set sh_offset to the value it
5890 would have if we had created a zero p_filesz and
5891 p_memsz PT_LOAD header for the section. This
5892 also makes the PT_TLS header have the same
5894 bfd_vma adjust
= vma_page_aligned_bias (this_hdr
->sh_addr
,
5896 this_hdr
->sh_offset
= sec
->filepos
= off
+ adjust
;
5899 if (this_hdr
->sh_type
!= SHT_NOBITS
)
5901 p
->p_filesz
+= this_hdr
->sh_size
;
5902 /* A load section without SHF_ALLOC is something like
5903 a note section in a PT_NOTE segment. These take
5904 file space but are not loaded into memory. */
5905 if ((this_hdr
->sh_flags
& SHF_ALLOC
) != 0)
5906 p
->p_memsz
+= this_hdr
->sh_size
;
5908 else if ((this_hdr
->sh_flags
& SHF_ALLOC
) != 0)
5910 if (p
->p_type
== PT_TLS
)
5911 p
->p_memsz
+= this_hdr
->sh_size
;
5913 /* .tbss is special. It doesn't contribute to p_memsz of
5915 else if ((this_hdr
->sh_flags
& SHF_TLS
) == 0)
5916 p
->p_memsz
+= this_hdr
->sh_size
;
5919 if (align
> p
->p_align
5920 && !m
->p_align_valid
5921 && (p
->p_type
!= PT_LOAD
5922 || (abfd
->flags
& D_PAGED
) == 0))
5926 if (!m
->p_flags_valid
)
5929 if ((this_hdr
->sh_flags
& SHF_EXECINSTR
) != 0)
5931 if ((this_hdr
->sh_flags
& SHF_WRITE
) != 0)
5938 /* PR ld/20815 - Check that the program header segment, if
5939 present, will be loaded into memory. */
5940 if (p
->p_type
== PT_PHDR
5941 && phdr_load_seg
== NULL
5942 && !(bed
->elf_backend_allow_non_load_phdr
!= NULL
5943 && bed
->elf_backend_allow_non_load_phdr (abfd
, phdrs
, alloc
)))
5945 /* The fix for this error is usually to edit the linker script being
5946 used and set up the program headers manually. Either that or
5947 leave room for the headers at the start of the SECTIONS. */
5948 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: error: PHDR segment not covered"
5949 " by LOAD segment"),
5951 if (link_info
== NULL
)
5953 /* Arrange for the linker to exit with an error, deleting
5954 the output file unless --noinhibit-exec is given. */
5955 link_info
->callbacks
->info ("%X");
5958 /* Check that all sections are in a PT_LOAD segment.
5959 Don't check funky gdb generated core files. */
5960 if (p
->p_type
== PT_LOAD
&& bfd_get_format (abfd
) != bfd_core
)
5962 bfd_boolean check_vma
= TRUE
;
5964 for (i
= 1; i
< m
->count
; i
++)
5965 if (m
->sections
[i
]->vma
== m
->sections
[i
- 1]->vma
5966 && ELF_SECTION_SIZE (&(elf_section_data (m
->sections
[i
])
5967 ->this_hdr
), p
) != 0
5968 && ELF_SECTION_SIZE (&(elf_section_data (m
->sections
[i
- 1])
5969 ->this_hdr
), p
) != 0)
5971 /* Looks like we have overlays packed into the segment. */
5976 for (i
= 0; i
< m
->count
; i
++)
5978 Elf_Internal_Shdr
*this_hdr
;
5981 sec
= m
->sections
[i
];
5982 this_hdr
= &(elf_section_data(sec
)->this_hdr
);
5983 if (!ELF_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT_1 (this_hdr
, p
, check_vma
, 0)
5984 && !ELF_TBSS_SPECIAL (this_hdr
, p
))
5987 /* xgettext:c-format */
5988 (_("%pB: section `%pA' can't be allocated in segment %d"),
5990 print_segment_map (m
);
5996 elf_next_file_pos (abfd
) = off
;
5998 if (link_info
!= NULL
5999 && phdr_load_seg
!= NULL
6000 && phdr_load_seg
->includes_filehdr
)
6002 /* There is a segment that contains both the file headers and the
6003 program headers, so provide a symbol __ehdr_start pointing there.
6004 A program can use this to examine itself robustly. */
6006 struct elf_link_hash_entry
*hash
6007 = elf_link_hash_lookup (elf_hash_table (link_info
), "__ehdr_start",
6008 FALSE
, FALSE
, TRUE
);
6009 /* If the symbol was referenced and not defined, define it. */
6011 && (hash
->root
.type
== bfd_link_hash_new
6012 || hash
->root
.type
== bfd_link_hash_undefined
6013 || hash
->root
.type
== bfd_link_hash_undefweak
6014 || hash
->root
.type
== bfd_link_hash_common
))
6017 bfd_vma filehdr_vaddr
= phdrs
[phdr_load_seg
->idx
].p_vaddr
/ opb
;
6019 if (phdr_load_seg
->count
!= 0)
6020 /* The segment contains sections, so use the first one. */
6021 s
= phdr_load_seg
->sections
[0];
6023 /* Use the first (i.e. lowest-addressed) section in any segment. */
6024 for (m
= elf_seg_map (abfd
); m
!= NULL
; m
= m
->next
)
6025 if (m
->p_type
== PT_LOAD
&& m
->count
!= 0)
6033 hash
->root
.u
.def
.value
= filehdr_vaddr
- s
->vma
;
6034 hash
->root
.u
.def
.section
= s
;
6038 hash
->root
.u
.def
.value
= filehdr_vaddr
;
6039 hash
->root
.u
.def
.section
= bfd_abs_section_ptr
;
6042 hash
->root
.type
= bfd_link_hash_defined
;
6043 hash
->def_regular
= 1;
6051 /* Determine if a bfd is a debuginfo file. Unfortunately there
6052 is no defined method for detecting such files, so we have to
6053 use heuristics instead. */
6056 is_debuginfo_file (bfd
*abfd
)
6058 if (abfd
== NULL
|| bfd_get_flavour (abfd
) != bfd_target_elf_flavour
)
6061 Elf_Internal_Shdr
**start_headers
= elf_elfsections (abfd
);
6062 Elf_Internal_Shdr
**end_headers
= start_headers
+ elf_numsections (abfd
);
6063 Elf_Internal_Shdr
**headerp
;
6065 for (headerp
= start_headers
; headerp
< end_headers
; headerp
++)
6067 Elf_Internal_Shdr
*header
= * headerp
;
6069 /* Debuginfo files do not have any allocated SHT_PROGBITS sections.
6070 The only allocated sections are SHT_NOBITS or SHT_NOTES. */
6071 if ((header
->sh_flags
& SHF_ALLOC
) == SHF_ALLOC
6072 && header
->sh_type
!= SHT_NOBITS
6073 && header
->sh_type
!= SHT_NOTE
)
6080 /* Assign file positions for the other sections, except for compressed debugging
6081 and other sections assigned in _bfd_elf_assign_file_positions_for_non_load(). */
6084 assign_file_positions_for_non_load_sections (bfd
*abfd
,
6085 struct bfd_link_info
*link_info
)
6087 const struct elf_backend_data
*bed
= get_elf_backend_data (abfd
);
6088 Elf_Internal_Shdr
**i_shdrpp
;
6089 Elf_Internal_Shdr
**hdrpp
, **end_hdrpp
;
6090 Elf_Internal_Phdr
*phdrs
;
6091 Elf_Internal_Phdr
*p
;
6092 struct elf_segment_map
*m
;
6094 unsigned int opb
= bfd_octets_per_byte (abfd
, NULL
);
6096 i_shdrpp
= elf_elfsections (abfd
);
6097 end_hdrpp
= i_shdrpp
+ elf_numsections (abfd
);
6098 off
= elf_next_file_pos (abfd
);
6099 for (hdrpp
= i_shdrpp
+ 1; hdrpp
< end_hdrpp
; hdrpp
++)
6101 Elf_Internal_Shdr
*hdr
;
6104 if (hdr
->bfd_section
!= NULL
6105 && (hdr
->bfd_section
->filepos
!= 0
6106 || (hdr
->sh_type
== SHT_NOBITS
6107 && hdr
->contents
== NULL
)))
6108 BFD_ASSERT (hdr
->sh_offset
== hdr
->bfd_section
->filepos
);
6109 else if ((hdr
->sh_flags
& SHF_ALLOC
) != 0)
6111 if (hdr
->sh_size
!= 0
6112 /* PR 24717 - debuginfo files are known to be not strictly
6113 compliant with the ELF standard. In particular they often
6114 have .note.gnu.property sections that are outside of any
6115 loadable segment. This is not a problem for such files,
6116 so do not warn about them. */
6117 && ! is_debuginfo_file (abfd
))
6119 /* xgettext:c-format */
6120 (_("%pB: warning: allocated section `%s' not in segment"),
6122 (hdr
->bfd_section
== NULL
6124 : hdr
->bfd_section
->name
));
6125 /* We don't need to page align empty sections. */
6126 if ((abfd
->flags
& D_PAGED
) != 0 && hdr
->sh_size
!= 0)
6127 off
+= vma_page_aligned_bias (hdr
->sh_addr
, off
,
6130 off
+= vma_page_aligned_bias (hdr
->sh_addr
, off
,
6132 off
= _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (hdr
, off
,
6135 else if (((hdr
->sh_type
== SHT_REL
|| hdr
->sh_type
== SHT_RELA
)
6136 && hdr
->bfd_section
== NULL
)
6137 /* We don't know the offset of these sections yet: their size has
6138 not been decided. */
6139 || (hdr
->bfd_section
!= NULL
6140 && (hdr
->bfd_section
->flags
& SEC_ELF_COMPRESS
6141 || (bfd_section_is_ctf (hdr
->bfd_section
)
6142 && abfd
->is_linker_output
)))
6143 || hdr
== i_shdrpp
[elf_onesymtab (abfd
)]
6144 || (elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd
) != NULL
6145 && hdr
== i_shdrpp
[elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd
)->ndx
])
6146 || hdr
== i_shdrpp
[elf_strtab_sec (abfd
)]
6147 || hdr
== i_shdrpp
[elf_shstrtab_sec (abfd
)])
6148 hdr
->sh_offset
= -1;
6150 off
= _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (hdr
, off
, TRUE
);
6152 elf_next_file_pos (abfd
) = off
;
6154 /* Now that we have set the section file positions, we can set up
6155 the file positions for the non PT_LOAD segments. */
6156 phdrs
= elf_tdata (abfd
)->phdr
;
6157 for (m
= elf_seg_map (abfd
), p
= phdrs
; m
!= NULL
; m
= m
->next
, p
++)
6159 if (p
->p_type
== PT_GNU_RELRO
)
6161 bfd_vma start
, end
; /* Bytes. */
6164 if (link_info
!= NULL
)
6166 /* During linking the range of the RELRO segment is passed
6167 in link_info. Note that there may be padding between
6168 relro_start and the first RELRO section. */
6169 start
= link_info
->relro_start
;
6170 end
= link_info
->relro_end
;
6172 else if (m
->count
!= 0)
6174 if (!m
->p_size_valid
)
6176 start
= m
->sections
[0]->vma
;
6177 end
= start
+ m
->p_size
/ opb
;
6188 struct elf_segment_map
*lm
;
6189 const Elf_Internal_Phdr
*lp
;
6192 /* Find a LOAD segment containing a section in the RELRO
6194 for (lm
= elf_seg_map (abfd
), lp
= phdrs
;
6196 lm
= lm
->next
, lp
++)
6198 if (lp
->p_type
== PT_LOAD
6200 && (lm
->sections
[lm
->count
- 1]->vma
6201 + (!IS_TBSS (lm
->sections
[lm
->count
- 1])
6202 ? lm
->sections
[lm
->count
- 1]->size
/ opb
6204 && lm
->sections
[0]->vma
< end
)
6210 /* Find the section starting the RELRO segment. */
6211 for (i
= 0; i
< lm
->count
; i
++)
6213 asection
*s
= lm
->sections
[i
];
6222 p
->p_vaddr
= lm
->sections
[i
]->vma
* opb
;
6223 p
->p_paddr
= lm
->sections
[i
]->lma
* opb
;
6224 p
->p_offset
= lm
->sections
[i
]->filepos
;
6225 p
->p_memsz
= end
* opb
- p
->p_vaddr
;
6226 p
->p_filesz
= p
->p_memsz
;
6228 /* The RELRO segment typically ends a few bytes
6229 into .got.plt but other layouts are possible.
6230 In cases where the end does not match any
6231 loaded section (for instance is in file
6232 padding), trim p_filesz back to correspond to
6233 the end of loaded section contents. */
6234 if (p
->p_filesz
> lp
->p_vaddr
+ lp
->p_filesz
- p
->p_vaddr
)
6235 p
->p_filesz
= lp
->p_vaddr
+ lp
->p_filesz
- p
->p_vaddr
;
6237 /* Preserve the alignment and flags if they are
6238 valid. The gold linker generates RW/4 for
6239 the PT_GNU_RELRO section. It is better for
6240 objcopy/strip to honor these attributes
6241 otherwise gdb will choke when using separate
6243 if (!m
->p_align_valid
)
6245 if (!m
->p_flags_valid
)
6251 if (link_info
!= NULL
)
6254 memset (p
, 0, sizeof *p
);
6256 else if (p
->p_type
== PT_GNU_STACK
)
6258 if (m
->p_size_valid
)
6259 p
->p_memsz
= m
->p_size
;
6261 else if (m
->count
!= 0)
6265 if (p
->p_type
!= PT_LOAD
6266 && (p
->p_type
!= PT_NOTE
6267 || bfd_get_format (abfd
) != bfd_core
))
6269 /* A user specified segment layout may include a PHDR
6270 segment that overlaps with a LOAD segment... */
6271 if (p
->p_type
== PT_PHDR
)
6277 if (m
->includes_filehdr
|| m
->includes_phdrs
)
6279 /* PR 17512: file: 2195325e. */
6281 (_("%pB: error: non-load segment %d includes file header "
6282 "and/or program header"),
6283 abfd
, (int) (p
- phdrs
));
6288 p
->p_offset
= m
->sections
[0]->filepos
;
6289 for (i
= m
->count
; i
-- != 0;)
6291 asection
*sect
= m
->sections
[i
];
6292 Elf_Internal_Shdr
*hdr
= &elf_section_data (sect
)->this_hdr
;
6293 if (hdr
->sh_type
!= SHT_NOBITS
)
6295 p
->p_filesz
= (sect
->filepos
- m
->sections
[0]->filepos
6307 static elf_section_list
*
6308 find_section_in_list (unsigned int i
, elf_section_list
* list
)
6310 for (;list
!= NULL
; list
= list
->next
)
6316 /* Work out the file positions of all the sections. This is called by
6317 _bfd_elf_compute_section_file_positions. All the section sizes and
6318 VMAs must be known before this is called.
6320 Reloc sections come in two flavours: Those processed specially as
6321 "side-channel" data attached to a section to which they apply, and those that
6322 bfd doesn't process as relocations. The latter sort are stored in a normal
6323 bfd section by bfd_section_from_shdr. We don't consider the former sort
6324 here, unless they form part of the loadable image. Reloc sections not
6325 assigned here (and compressed debugging sections and CTF sections which
6326 nothing else in the file can rely upon) will be handled later by
6327 assign_file_positions_for_relocs.
6329 We also don't set the positions of the .symtab and .strtab here. */
6332 assign_file_positions_except_relocs (bfd
*abfd
,
6333 struct bfd_link_info
*link_info
)
6335 struct elf_obj_tdata
*tdata
= elf_tdata (abfd
);
6336 Elf_Internal_Ehdr
*i_ehdrp
= elf_elfheader (abfd
);
6337 const struct elf_backend_data
*bed
= get_elf_backend_data (abfd
);
6340 if ((abfd
->flags
& (EXEC_P
| DYNAMIC
)) == 0
6341 && bfd_get_format (abfd
) != bfd_core
)
6343 Elf_Internal_Shdr
** const i_shdrpp
= elf_elfsections (abfd
);
6344 unsigned int num_sec
= elf_numsections (abfd
);
6345 Elf_Internal_Shdr
**hdrpp
;
6349 /* Start after the ELF header. */
6350 off
= i_ehdrp
->e_ehsize
;
6352 /* We are not creating an executable, which means that we are
6353 not creating a program header, and that the actual order of
6354 the sections in the file is unimportant. */
6355 for (i
= 1, hdrpp
= i_shdrpp
+ 1; i
< num_sec
; i
++, hdrpp
++)
6357 Elf_Internal_Shdr
*hdr
;
6360 if (((hdr
->sh_type
== SHT_REL
|| hdr
->sh_type
== SHT_RELA
)
6361 && hdr
->bfd_section
== NULL
)
6362 /* Do not assign offsets for these sections yet: we don't know
6364 || (hdr
->bfd_section
!= NULL
6365 && (hdr
->bfd_section
->flags
& SEC_ELF_COMPRESS
6366 || (bfd_section_is_ctf (hdr
->bfd_section
)
6367 && abfd
->is_linker_output
)))
6368 || i
== elf_onesymtab (abfd
)
6369 || (elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd
) != NULL
6370 && hdr
== i_shdrpp
[elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd
)->ndx
])
6371 || i
== elf_strtab_sec (abfd
)
6372 || i
== elf_shstrtab_sec (abfd
))
6374 hdr
->sh_offset
= -1;
6377 off
= _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (hdr
, off
, TRUE
);
6380 elf_next_file_pos (abfd
) = off
;
6381 elf_program_header_size (abfd
) = 0;
6385 /* Assign file positions for the loaded sections based on the
6386 assignment of sections to segments. */
6387 if (!assign_file_positions_for_load_sections (abfd
, link_info
))
6390 /* And for non-load sections. */
6391 if (!assign_file_positions_for_non_load_sections (abfd
, link_info
))
6395 if (!(*bed
->elf_backend_modify_headers
) (abfd
, link_info
))
6398 /* Write out the program headers. */
6399 alloc
= i_ehdrp
->e_phnum
;
6402 if (bfd_seek (abfd
, i_ehdrp
->e_phoff
, SEEK_SET
) != 0
6403 || bed
->s
->write_out_phdrs (abfd
, tdata
->phdr
, alloc
) != 0)
6411 _bfd_elf_init_file_header (bfd
*abfd
,
6412 struct bfd_link_info
*info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED
)
6414 Elf_Internal_Ehdr
*i_ehdrp
; /* Elf file header, internal form. */
6415 struct elf_strtab_hash
*shstrtab
;
6416 const struct elf_backend_data
*bed
= get_elf_backend_data (abfd
);
6418 i_ehdrp
= elf_elfheader (abfd
);
6420 shstrtab
= _bfd_elf_strtab_init ();
6421 if (shstrtab
== NULL
)
6424 elf_shstrtab (abfd
) = shstrtab
;
6426 i_ehdrp
->e_ident
[EI_MAG0
] = ELFMAG0
;
6427 i_ehdrp
->e_ident
[EI_MAG1
] = ELFMAG1
;
6428 i_ehdrp
->e_ident
[EI_MAG2
] = ELFMAG2
;
6429 i_ehdrp
->e_ident
[EI_MAG3
] = ELFMAG3
;
6431 i_ehdrp
->e_ident
[EI_CLASS
] = bed
->s
->elfclass
;
6432 i_ehdrp
->e_ident
[EI_DATA
] =
6433 bfd_big_endian (abfd
) ? ELFDATA2MSB
: ELFDATA2LSB
;
6434 i_ehdrp
->e_ident
[EI_VERSION
] = bed
->s
->ev_current
;
6436 if ((abfd
->flags
& DYNAMIC
) != 0)
6437 i_ehdrp
->e_type
= ET_DYN
;
6438 else if ((abfd
->flags
& EXEC_P
) != 0)
6439 i_ehdrp
->e_type
= ET_EXEC
;
6440 else if (bfd_get_format (abfd
) == bfd_core
)
6441 i_ehdrp
->e_type
= ET_CORE
;
6443 i_ehdrp
->e_type
= ET_REL
;
6445 switch (bfd_get_arch (abfd
))
6447 case bfd_arch_unknown
:
6448 i_ehdrp
->e_machine
= EM_NONE
;
6451 /* There used to be a long list of cases here, each one setting
6452 e_machine to the same EM_* macro #defined as ELF_MACHINE_CODE
6453 in the corresponding bfd definition. To avoid duplication,
6454 the switch was removed. Machines that need special handling
6455 can generally do it in elf_backend_final_write_processing(),
6456 unless they need the information earlier than the final write.
6457 Such need can generally be supplied by replacing the tests for
6458 e_machine with the conditions used to determine it. */
6460 i_ehdrp
->e_machine
= bed
->elf_machine_code
;
6463 i_ehdrp
->e_version
= bed
->s
->ev_current
;
6464 i_ehdrp
->e_ehsize
= bed
->s
->sizeof_ehdr
;
6466 /* No program header, for now. */
6467 i_ehdrp
->e_phoff
= 0;
6468 i_ehdrp
->e_phentsize
= 0;
6469 i_ehdrp
->e_phnum
= 0;
6471 /* Each bfd section is section header entry. */
6472 i_ehdrp
->e_entry
= bfd_get_start_address (abfd
);
6473 i_ehdrp
->e_shentsize
= bed
->s
->sizeof_shdr
;
6475 elf_tdata (abfd
)->symtab_hdr
.sh_name
=
6476 (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (shstrtab
, ".symtab", FALSE
);
6477 elf_tdata (abfd
)->strtab_hdr
.sh_name
=
6478 (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (shstrtab
, ".strtab", FALSE
);
6479 elf_tdata (abfd
)->shstrtab_hdr
.sh_name
=
6480 (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (shstrtab
, ".shstrtab", FALSE
);
6481 if (elf_tdata (abfd
)->symtab_hdr
.sh_name
== (unsigned int) -1
6482 || elf_tdata (abfd
)->strtab_hdr
.sh_name
== (unsigned int) -1
6483 || elf_tdata (abfd
)->shstrtab_hdr
.sh_name
== (unsigned int) -1)
6489 /* Set e_type in ELF header to ET_EXEC for -pie -Ttext-segment=.
6491 FIXME: We used to have code here to sort the PT_LOAD segments into
6492 ascending order, as per the ELF spec. But this breaks some programs,
6493 including the Linux kernel. But really either the spec should be
6494 changed or the programs updated. */
6497 _bfd_elf_modify_headers (bfd
*obfd
, struct bfd_link_info
*link_info
)
6499 if (link_info
!= NULL
&& bfd_link_pie (link_info
))
6501 Elf_Internal_Ehdr
*i_ehdrp
= elf_elfheader (obfd
);
6502 unsigned int num_segments
= i_ehdrp
->e_phnum
;
6503 struct elf_obj_tdata
*tdata
= elf_tdata (obfd
);
6504 Elf_Internal_Phdr
*segment
= tdata
->phdr
;
6505 Elf_Internal_Phdr
*end_segment
= &segment
[num_segments
];
6507 /* Find the lowest p_vaddr in PT_LOAD segments. */
6508 bfd_vma p_vaddr
= (bfd_vma
) -1;
6509 for (; segment
< end_segment
; segment
++)
6510 if (segment
->p_type
== PT_LOAD
&& p_vaddr
> segment
->p_vaddr
)
6511 p_vaddr
= segment
->p_vaddr
;
6513 /* Set e_type to ET_EXEC if the lowest p_vaddr in PT_LOAD
6514 segments is non-zero. */
6516 i_ehdrp
->e_type
= ET_EXEC
;
6521 /* Assign file positions for all the reloc sections which are not part
6522 of the loadable file image, and the file position of section headers. */
6525 _bfd_elf_assign_file_positions_for_non_load (bfd
*abfd
)
6528 Elf_Internal_Shdr
**shdrpp
, **end_shdrpp
;
6529 Elf_Internal_Shdr
*shdrp
;
6530 Elf_Internal_Ehdr
*i_ehdrp
;
6531 const struct elf_backend_data
*bed
;
6533 off
= elf_next_file_pos (abfd
);
6535 shdrpp
= elf_elfsections (abfd
);
6536 end_shdrpp
= shdrpp
+ elf_numsections (abfd
);
6537 for (shdrpp
++; shdrpp
< end_shdrpp
; shdrpp
++)
6540 if (shdrp
->sh_offset
== -1)
6542 asection
*sec
= shdrp
->bfd_section
;
6543 bfd_boolean is_rel
= (shdrp
->sh_type
== SHT_REL
6544 || shdrp
->sh_type
== SHT_RELA
);
6545 bfd_boolean is_ctf
= sec
&& bfd_section_is_ctf (sec
);
6548 || (sec
!= NULL
&& (sec
->flags
& SEC_ELF_COMPRESS
)))
6550 if (!is_rel
&& !is_ctf
)
6552 const char *name
= sec
->name
;
6553 struct bfd_elf_section_data
*d
;
6555 /* Compress DWARF debug sections. */
6556 if (!bfd_compress_section (abfd
, sec
,
6560 if (sec
->compress_status
== COMPRESS_SECTION_DONE
6561 && (abfd
->flags
& BFD_COMPRESS_GABI
) == 0)
6563 /* If section is compressed with zlib-gnu, convert
6564 section name from .debug_* to .zdebug_*. */
6566 = convert_debug_to_zdebug (abfd
, name
);
6567 if (new_name
== NULL
)
6571 /* Add section name to section name section. */
6572 if (shdrp
->sh_name
!= (unsigned int) -1)
6575 = (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (elf_shstrtab (abfd
),
6577 d
= elf_section_data (sec
);
6579 /* Add reloc section name to section name section. */
6581 && !_bfd_elf_set_reloc_sh_name (abfd
,
6586 && !_bfd_elf_set_reloc_sh_name (abfd
,
6591 /* Update section size and contents. */
6592 shdrp
->sh_size
= sec
->size
;
6593 shdrp
->contents
= sec
->contents
;
6594 shdrp
->bfd_section
->contents
= NULL
;
6598 /* Update section size and contents. */
6599 shdrp
->sh_size
= sec
->size
;
6600 shdrp
->contents
= sec
->contents
;
6603 off
= _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (shdrp
,
6610 /* Place section name section after DWARF debug sections have been
6612 _bfd_elf_strtab_finalize (elf_shstrtab (abfd
));
6613 shdrp
= &elf_tdata (abfd
)->shstrtab_hdr
;
6614 shdrp
->sh_size
= _bfd_elf_strtab_size (elf_shstrtab (abfd
));
6615 off
= _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (shdrp
, off
, TRUE
);
6617 /* Place the section headers. */
6618 i_ehdrp
= elf_elfheader (abfd
);
6619 bed
= get_elf_backend_data (abfd
);
6620 off
= align_file_position (off
, 1 << bed
->s
->log_file_align
);
6621 i_ehdrp
->e_shoff
= off
;
6622 off
+= i_ehdrp
->e_shnum
* i_ehdrp
->e_shentsize
;
6623 elf_next_file_pos (abfd
) = off
;
6629 _bfd_elf_write_object_contents (bfd
*abfd
)
6631 const struct elf_backend_data
*bed
= get_elf_backend_data (abfd
);
6632 Elf_Internal_Shdr
**i_shdrp
;
6634 unsigned int count
, num_sec
;
6635 struct elf_obj_tdata
*t
;
6637 if (! abfd
->output_has_begun
6638 && ! _bfd_elf_compute_section_file_positions (abfd
, NULL
))
6640 /* Do not rewrite ELF data when the BFD has been opened for update.
6641 abfd->output_has_begun was set to TRUE on opening, so creation of new
6642 sections, and modification of existing section sizes was restricted.
6643 This means the ELF header, program headers and section headers can't have
6645 If the contents of any sections has been modified, then those changes have
6646 already been written to the BFD. */
6647 else if (abfd
->direction
== both_direction
)
6649 BFD_ASSERT (abfd
->output_has_begun
);
6653 i_shdrp
= elf_elfsections (abfd
);
6656 bfd_map_over_sections (abfd
, bed
->s
->write_relocs
, &failed
);
6660 if (!_bfd_elf_assign_file_positions_for_non_load (abfd
))
6663 /* After writing the headers, we need to write the sections too... */
6664 num_sec
= elf_numsections (abfd
);
6665 for (count
= 1; count
< num_sec
; count
++)
6667 i_shdrp
[count
]->sh_name
6668 = _bfd_elf_strtab_offset (elf_shstrtab (abfd
),
6669 i_shdrp
[count
]->sh_name
);
6670 if (bed
->elf_backend_section_processing
)
6671 if (!(*bed
->elf_backend_section_processing
) (abfd
, i_shdrp
[count
]))
6673 if (i_shdrp
[count
]->contents
)
6675 bfd_size_type amt
= i_shdrp
[count
]->sh_size
;
6677 if (bfd_seek (abfd
, i_shdrp
[count
]->sh_offset
, SEEK_SET
) != 0
6678 || bfd_bwrite (i_shdrp
[count
]->contents
, amt
, abfd
) != amt
)
6683 /* Write out the section header names. */
6684 t
= elf_tdata (abfd
);
6685 if (elf_shstrtab (abfd
) != NULL
6686 && (bfd_seek (abfd
, t
->shstrtab_hdr
.sh_offset
, SEEK_SET
) != 0
6687 || !_bfd_elf_strtab_emit (abfd
, elf_shstrtab (abfd
))))
6690 if (!(*bed
->elf_backend_final_write_processing
) (abfd
))
6693 if (!bed
->s
->write_shdrs_and_ehdr (abfd
))
6696 /* This is last since write_shdrs_and_ehdr can touch i_shdrp[0]. */
6697 if (t
->o
->build_id
.after_write_object_contents
!= NULL
)
6698 return (*t
->o
->build_id
.after_write_object_contents
) (abfd
);
6704 _bfd_elf_write_corefile_contents (bfd
*abfd
)
6706 /* Hopefully this can be done just like an object file. */
6707 return _bfd_elf_write_object_contents (abfd
);
6710 /* Given a section, search the header to find them. */
6713 _bfd_elf_section_from_bfd_section (bfd
*abfd
, struct bfd_section
*asect
)
6715 const struct elf_backend_data
*bed
;
6716 unsigned int sec_index
;
6718 if (elf_section_data (asect
) != NULL
6719 && elf_section_data (asect
)->this_idx
!= 0)
6720 return elf_section_data (asect
)->this_idx
;
6722 if (bfd_is_abs_section (asect
))
6723 sec_index
= SHN_ABS
;
6724 else if (bfd_is_com_section (asect
))
6725 sec_index
= SHN_COMMON
;
6726 else if (bfd_is_und_section (asect
))
6727 sec_index
= SHN_UNDEF
;
6729 sec_index
= SHN_BAD
;
6731 bed
= get_elf_backend_data (abfd
);
6732 if (bed
->elf_backend_section_from_bfd_section
)
6734 int retval
= sec_index
;
6736 if ((*bed
->elf_backend_section_from_bfd_section
) (abfd
, asect
, &retval
))
6740 if (sec_index
== SHN_BAD
)
6741 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_nonrepresentable_section
);
6746 /* Given a BFD symbol, return the index in the ELF symbol table, or -1
6750 _bfd_elf_symbol_from_bfd_symbol (bfd
*abfd
, asymbol
**asym_ptr_ptr
)
6752 asymbol
*asym_ptr
= *asym_ptr_ptr
;
6754 flagword flags
= asym_ptr
->flags
;
6756 /* When gas creates relocations against local labels, it creates its
6757 own symbol for the section, but does put the symbol into the
6758 symbol chain, so udata is 0. When the linker is generating
6759 relocatable output, this section symbol may be for one of the
6760 input sections rather than the output section. */
6761 if (asym_ptr
->udata
.i
== 0
6762 && (flags
& BSF_SECTION_SYM
)
6763 && asym_ptr
->section
)
6768 sec
= asym_ptr
->section
;
6769 if (sec
->owner
!= abfd
&& sec
->output_section
!= NULL
)
6770 sec
= sec
->output_section
;
6771 if (sec
->owner
== abfd
6772 && (indx
= sec
->index
) < elf_num_section_syms (abfd
)
6773 && elf_section_syms (abfd
)[indx
] != NULL
)
6774 asym_ptr
->udata
.i
= elf_section_syms (abfd
)[indx
]->udata
.i
;
6777 idx
= asym_ptr
->udata
.i
;
6781 /* This case can occur when using --strip-symbol on a symbol
6782 which is used in a relocation entry. */
6784 /* xgettext:c-format */
6785 (_("%pB: symbol `%s' required but not present"),
6786 abfd
, bfd_asymbol_name (asym_ptr
));
6787 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_no_symbols
);
6794 "elf_symbol_from_bfd_symbol 0x%.8lx, name = %s, sym num = %d, flags = 0x%.8x\n",
6795 (long) asym_ptr
, asym_ptr
->name
, idx
, flags
);
6803 /* Rewrite program header information. */
6806 rewrite_elf_program_header (bfd
*ibfd
, bfd
*obfd
)
6808 Elf_Internal_Ehdr
*iehdr
;
6809 struct elf_segment_map
*map
;
6810 struct elf_segment_map
*map_first
;
6811 struct elf_segment_map
**pointer_to_map
;
6812 Elf_Internal_Phdr
*segment
;
6815 unsigned int num_segments
;
6816 bfd_boolean phdr_included
= FALSE
;
6817 bfd_boolean p_paddr_valid
;
6818 bfd_vma maxpagesize
;
6819 struct elf_segment_map
*phdr_adjust_seg
= NULL
;
6820 unsigned int phdr_adjust_num
= 0;
6821 const struct elf_backend_data
*bed
;
6822 unsigned int opb
= bfd_octets_per_byte (ibfd
, NULL
);
6824 bed
= get_elf_backend_data (ibfd
);
6825 iehdr
= elf_elfheader (ibfd
);
6828 pointer_to_map
= &map_first
;
6830 num_segments
= elf_elfheader (ibfd
)->e_phnum
;
6831 maxpagesize
= get_elf_backend_data (obfd
)->maxpagesize
;
6833 /* Returns the end address of the segment + 1. */
6834 #define SEGMENT_END(segment, start) \
6835 (start + (segment->p_memsz > segment->p_filesz \
6836 ? segment->p_memsz : segment->p_filesz))
6838 #define SECTION_SIZE(section, segment) \
6839 (((section->flags & (SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)) \
6840 != SEC_THREAD_LOCAL || segment->p_type == PT_TLS) \
6841 ? section->size : 0)
6843 /* Returns TRUE if the given section is contained within
6844 the given segment. VMA addresses are compared. */
6845 #define IS_CONTAINED_BY_VMA(section, segment, opb) \
6846 (section->vma * (opb) >= segment->p_vaddr \
6847 && (section->vma * (opb) + SECTION_SIZE (section, segment) \
6848 <= (SEGMENT_END (segment, segment->p_vaddr))))
6850 /* Returns TRUE if the given section is contained within
6851 the given segment. LMA addresses are compared. */
6852 #define IS_CONTAINED_BY_LMA(section, segment, base, opb) \
6853 (section->lma * (opb) >= base \
6854 && (section->lma + SECTION_SIZE (section, segment) / (opb) >= section->lma) \
6855 && (section->lma * (opb) + SECTION_SIZE (section, segment) \
6856 <= SEGMENT_END (segment, base)))
6858 /* Handle PT_NOTE segment. */
6859 #define IS_NOTE(p, s) \
6860 (p->p_type == PT_NOTE \
6861 && elf_section_type (s) == SHT_NOTE \
6862 && (bfd_vma) s->filepos >= p->p_offset \
6863 && ((bfd_vma) s->filepos + s->size \
6864 <= p->p_offset + p->p_filesz))
6866 /* Special case: corefile "NOTE" section containing regs, prpsinfo
6868 #define IS_COREFILE_NOTE(p, s) \
6870 && bfd_get_format (ibfd) == bfd_core \
6874 /* The complicated case when p_vaddr is 0 is to handle the Solaris
6875 linker, which generates a PT_INTERP section with p_vaddr and
6876 p_memsz set to 0. */
6877 #define IS_SOLARIS_PT_INTERP(p, s) \
6879 && p->p_paddr == 0 \
6880 && p->p_memsz == 0 \
6881 && p->p_filesz > 0 \
6882 && (s->flags & SEC_HAS_CONTENTS) != 0 \
6884 && (bfd_vma) s->filepos >= p->p_offset \
6885 && ((bfd_vma) s->filepos + s->size \
6886 <= p->p_offset + p->p_filesz))
6888 /* Decide if the given section should be included in the given segment.
6889 A section will be included if:
6890 1. It is within the address space of the segment -- we use the LMA
6891 if that is set for the segment and the VMA otherwise,
6892 2. It is an allocated section or a NOTE section in a PT_NOTE
6894 3. There is an output section associated with it,
6895 4. The section has not already been allocated to a previous segment.
6896 5. PT_GNU_STACK segments do not include any sections.
6897 6. PT_TLS segment includes only SHF_TLS sections.
6898 7. SHF_TLS sections are only in PT_TLS or PT_LOAD segments.
6899 8. PT_DYNAMIC should not contain empty sections at the beginning
6900 (with the possible exception of .dynamic). */
6901 #define IS_SECTION_IN_INPUT_SEGMENT(section, segment, bed, opb) \
6902 ((((segment->p_paddr \
6903 ? IS_CONTAINED_BY_LMA (section, segment, segment->p_paddr, opb) \
6904 : IS_CONTAINED_BY_VMA (section, segment, opb)) \
6905 && (section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0) \
6906 || IS_NOTE (segment, section)) \
6907 && segment->p_type != PT_GNU_STACK \
6908 && (segment->p_type != PT_TLS \
6909 || (section->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)) \
6910 && (segment->p_type == PT_LOAD \
6911 || segment->p_type == PT_TLS \
6912 || (section->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL) == 0) \
6913 && (segment->p_type != PT_DYNAMIC \
6914 || SECTION_SIZE (section, segment) > 0 \
6915 || (segment->p_paddr \
6916 ? segment->p_paddr != section->lma * (opb) \
6917 : segment->p_vaddr != section->vma * (opb)) \
6918 || (strcmp (bfd_section_name (section), ".dynamic") == 0)) \
6919 && (segment->p_type != PT_LOAD || !section->segment_mark))
6921 /* If the output section of a section in the input segment is NULL,
6922 it is removed from the corresponding output segment. */
6923 #define INCLUDE_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT(section, segment, bed, opb) \
6924 (IS_SECTION_IN_INPUT_SEGMENT (section, segment, bed, opb) \
6925 && section->output_section != NULL)
6927 /* Returns TRUE iff seg1 starts after the end of seg2. */
6928 #define SEGMENT_AFTER_SEGMENT(seg1, seg2, field) \
6929 (seg1->field >= SEGMENT_END (seg2, seg2->field))
6931 /* Returns TRUE iff seg1 and seg2 overlap. Segments overlap iff both
6932 their VMA address ranges and their LMA address ranges overlap.
6933 It is possible to have overlapping VMA ranges without overlapping LMA
6934 ranges. RedBoot images for example can have both .data and .bss mapped
6935 to the same VMA range, but with the .data section mapped to a different
6937 #define SEGMENT_OVERLAPS(seg1, seg2) \
6938 ( !(SEGMENT_AFTER_SEGMENT (seg1, seg2, p_vaddr) \
6939 || SEGMENT_AFTER_SEGMENT (seg2, seg1, p_vaddr)) \
6940 && !(SEGMENT_AFTER_SEGMENT (seg1, seg2, p_paddr) \
6941 || SEGMENT_AFTER_SEGMENT (seg2, seg1, p_paddr)))
6943 /* Initialise the segment mark field. */
6944 for (section
= ibfd
->sections
; section
!= NULL
; section
= section
->next
)
6945 section
->segment_mark
= FALSE
;
6947 /* The Solaris linker creates program headers in which all the
6948 p_paddr fields are zero. When we try to objcopy or strip such a
6949 file, we get confused. Check for this case, and if we find it
6950 don't set the p_paddr_valid fields. */
6951 p_paddr_valid
= FALSE
;
6952 for (i
= 0, segment
= elf_tdata (ibfd
)->phdr
;
6955 if (segment
->p_paddr
!= 0)
6957 p_paddr_valid
= TRUE
;
6961 /* Scan through the segments specified in the program header
6962 of the input BFD. For this first scan we look for overlaps
6963 in the loadable segments. These can be created by weird
6964 parameters to objcopy. Also, fix some solaris weirdness. */
6965 for (i
= 0, segment
= elf_tdata (ibfd
)->phdr
;
6970 Elf_Internal_Phdr
*segment2
;
6972 if (segment
->p_type
== PT_INTERP
)
6973 for (section
= ibfd
->sections
; section
; section
= section
->next
)
6974 if (IS_SOLARIS_PT_INTERP (segment
, section
))
6976 /* Mininal change so that the normal section to segment
6977 assignment code will work. */
6978 segment
->p_vaddr
= section
->vma
* opb
;
6982 if (segment
->p_type
!= PT_LOAD
)
6984 /* Remove PT_GNU_RELRO segment. */
6985 if (segment
->p_type
== PT_GNU_RELRO
)
6986 segment
->p_type
= PT_NULL
;
6990 /* Determine if this segment overlaps any previous segments. */
6991 for (j
= 0, segment2
= elf_tdata (ibfd
)->phdr
; j
< i
; j
++, segment2
++)
6993 bfd_signed_vma extra_length
;
6995 if (segment2
->p_type
!= PT_LOAD
6996 || !SEGMENT_OVERLAPS (segment
, segment2
))
6999 /* Merge the two segments together. */
7000 if (segment2
->p_vaddr
< segment
->p_vaddr
)
7002 /* Extend SEGMENT2 to include SEGMENT and then delete
7004 extra_length
= (SEGMENT_END (segment
, segment
->p_vaddr
)
7005 - SEGMENT_END (segment2
, segment2
->p_vaddr
));
7007 if (extra_length
> 0)
7009 segment2
->p_memsz
+= extra_length
;
7010 segment2
->p_filesz
+= extra_length
;
7013 segment
->p_type
= PT_NULL
;
7015 /* Since we have deleted P we must restart the outer loop. */
7017 segment
= elf_tdata (ibfd
)->phdr
;
7022 /* Extend SEGMENT to include SEGMENT2 and then delete
7024 extra_length
= (SEGMENT_END (segment2
, segment2
->p_vaddr
)
7025 - SEGMENT_END (segment
, segment
->p_vaddr
));
7027 if (extra_length
> 0)
7029 segment
->p_memsz
+= extra_length
;
7030 segment
->p_filesz
+= extra_length
;
7033 segment2
->p_type
= PT_NULL
;
7038 /* The second scan attempts to assign sections to segments. */
7039 for (i
= 0, segment
= elf_tdata (ibfd
)->phdr
;
7043 unsigned int section_count
;
7044 asection
**sections
;
7045 asection
*output_section
;
7047 asection
*matching_lma
;
7048 asection
*suggested_lma
;
7051 asection
*first_section
;
7053 if (segment
->p_type
== PT_NULL
)
7056 first_section
= NULL
;
7057 /* Compute how many sections might be placed into this segment. */
7058 for (section
= ibfd
->sections
, section_count
= 0;
7060 section
= section
->next
)
7062 /* Find the first section in the input segment, which may be
7063 removed from the corresponding output segment. */
7064 if (IS_SECTION_IN_INPUT_SEGMENT (section
, segment
, bed
, opb
))
7066 if (first_section
== NULL
)
7067 first_section
= section
;
7068 if (section
->output_section
!= NULL
)
7073 /* Allocate a segment map big enough to contain
7074 all of the sections we have selected. */
7075 amt
= sizeof (struct elf_segment_map
) - sizeof (asection
*);
7076 amt
+= section_count
* sizeof (asection
*);
7077 map
= (struct elf_segment_map
*) bfd_zalloc (obfd
, amt
);
7081 /* Initialise the fields of the segment map. Default to
7082 using the physical address of the segment in the input BFD. */
7084 map
->p_type
= segment
->p_type
;
7085 map
->p_flags
= segment
->p_flags
;
7086 map
->p_flags_valid
= 1;
7088 /* If the first section in the input segment is removed, there is
7089 no need to preserve segment physical address in the corresponding
7091 if (!first_section
|| first_section
->output_section
!= NULL
)
7093 map
->p_paddr
= segment
->p_paddr
;
7094 map
->p_paddr_valid
= p_paddr_valid
;
7097 /* Determine if this segment contains the ELF file header
7098 and if it contains the program headers themselves. */
7099 map
->includes_filehdr
= (segment
->p_offset
== 0
7100 && segment
->p_filesz
>= iehdr
->e_ehsize
);
7101 map
->includes_phdrs
= 0;
7103 if (!phdr_included
|| segment
->p_type
!= PT_LOAD
)
7105 map
->includes_phdrs
=
7106 (segment
->p_offset
<= (bfd_vma
) iehdr
->e_phoff
7107 && (segment
->p_offset
+ segment
->p_filesz
7108 >= ((bfd_vma
) iehdr
->e_phoff
7109 + iehdr
->e_phnum
* iehdr
->e_phentsize
)));
7111 if (segment
->p_type
== PT_LOAD
&& map
->includes_phdrs
)
7112 phdr_included
= TRUE
;
7115 if (section_count
== 0)
7117 /* Special segments, such as the PT_PHDR segment, may contain
7118 no sections, but ordinary, loadable segments should contain
7119 something. They are allowed by the ELF spec however, so only
7120 a warning is produced.
7121 There is however the valid use case of embedded systems which
7122 have segments with p_filesz of 0 and a p_memsz > 0 to initialize
7123 flash memory with zeros. No warning is shown for that case. */
7124 if (segment
->p_type
== PT_LOAD
7125 && (segment
->p_filesz
> 0 || segment
->p_memsz
== 0))
7126 /* xgettext:c-format */
7128 (_("%pB: warning: empty loadable segment detected"
7129 " at vaddr=%#" PRIx64
", is this intentional?"),
7130 ibfd
, (uint64_t) segment
->p_vaddr
);
7132 map
->p_vaddr_offset
= segment
->p_vaddr
/ opb
;
7134 *pointer_to_map
= map
;
7135 pointer_to_map
= &map
->next
;
7140 /* Now scan the sections in the input BFD again and attempt
7141 to add their corresponding output sections to the segment map.
7142 The problem here is how to handle an output section which has
7143 been moved (ie had its LMA changed). There are four possibilities:
7145 1. None of the sections have been moved.
7146 In this case we can continue to use the segment LMA from the
7149 2. All of the sections have been moved by the same amount.
7150 In this case we can change the segment's LMA to match the LMA
7151 of the first section.
7153 3. Some of the sections have been moved, others have not.
7154 In this case those sections which have not been moved can be
7155 placed in the current segment which will have to have its size,
7156 and possibly its LMA changed, and a new segment or segments will
7157 have to be created to contain the other sections.
7159 4. The sections have been moved, but not by the same amount.
7160 In this case we can change the segment's LMA to match the LMA
7161 of the first section and we will have to create a new segment
7162 or segments to contain the other sections.
7164 In order to save time, we allocate an array to hold the section
7165 pointers that we are interested in. As these sections get assigned
7166 to a segment, they are removed from this array. */
7168 amt
= section_count
* sizeof (asection
*);
7169 sections
= (asection
**) bfd_malloc (amt
);
7170 if (sections
== NULL
)
7173 /* Step One: Scan for segment vs section LMA conflicts.
7174 Also add the sections to the section array allocated above.
7175 Also add the sections to the current segment. In the common
7176 case, where the sections have not been moved, this means that
7177 we have completely filled the segment, and there is nothing
7180 matching_lma
= NULL
;
7181 suggested_lma
= NULL
;
7183 for (section
= first_section
, j
= 0;
7185 section
= section
->next
)
7187 if (INCLUDE_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT (section
, segment
, bed
, opb
))
7189 output_section
= section
->output_section
;
7191 sections
[j
++] = section
;
7193 /* The Solaris native linker always sets p_paddr to 0.
7194 We try to catch that case here, and set it to the
7195 correct value. Note - some backends require that
7196 p_paddr be left as zero. */
7198 && segment
->p_vaddr
!= 0
7199 && !bed
->want_p_paddr_set_to_zero
7201 && output_section
->lma
!= 0
7202 && (align_power (segment
->p_vaddr
7203 + (map
->includes_filehdr
7204 ? iehdr
->e_ehsize
: 0)
7205 + (map
->includes_phdrs
7206 ? iehdr
->e_phnum
* iehdr
->e_phentsize
7208 output_section
->alignment_power
* opb
)
7209 == (output_section
->vma
* opb
)))
7210 map
->p_paddr
= segment
->p_vaddr
;
7212 /* Match up the physical address of the segment with the
7213 LMA address of the output section. */
7214 if (IS_CONTAINED_BY_LMA (output_section
, segment
, map
->p_paddr
,
7216 || IS_COREFILE_NOTE (segment
, section
)
7217 || (bed
->want_p_paddr_set_to_zero
7218 && IS_CONTAINED_BY_VMA (output_section
, segment
, opb
)))
7220 if (matching_lma
== NULL
7221 || output_section
->lma
< matching_lma
->lma
)
7222 matching_lma
= output_section
;
7224 /* We assume that if the section fits within the segment
7225 then it does not overlap any other section within that
7227 map
->sections
[isec
++] = output_section
;
7229 else if (suggested_lma
== NULL
)
7230 suggested_lma
= output_section
;
7232 if (j
== section_count
)
7237 BFD_ASSERT (j
== section_count
);
7239 /* Step Two: Adjust the physical address of the current segment,
7241 if (isec
== section_count
)
7243 /* All of the sections fitted within the segment as currently
7244 specified. This is the default case. Add the segment to
7245 the list of built segments and carry on to process the next
7246 program header in the input BFD. */
7247 map
->count
= section_count
;
7248 *pointer_to_map
= map
;
7249 pointer_to_map
= &map
->next
;
7252 && !bed
->want_p_paddr_set_to_zero
)
7254 bfd_vma hdr_size
= 0;
7255 if (map
->includes_filehdr
)
7256 hdr_size
= iehdr
->e_ehsize
;
7257 if (map
->includes_phdrs
)
7258 hdr_size
+= iehdr
->e_phnum
* iehdr
->e_phentsize
;
7260 /* Account for padding before the first section in the
7262 map
->p_vaddr_offset
= ((map
->p_paddr
+ hdr_size
) / opb
7263 - matching_lma
->lma
);
7271 /* Change the current segment's physical address to match
7272 the LMA of the first section that fitted, or if no
7273 section fitted, the first section. */
7274 if (matching_lma
== NULL
)
7275 matching_lma
= suggested_lma
;
7277 map
->p_paddr
= matching_lma
->lma
* opb
;
7279 /* Offset the segment physical address from the lma
7280 to allow for space taken up by elf headers. */
7281 if (map
->includes_phdrs
)
7283 map
->p_paddr
-= iehdr
->e_phnum
* iehdr
->e_phentsize
;
7285 /* iehdr->e_phnum is just an estimate of the number
7286 of program headers that we will need. Make a note
7287 here of the number we used and the segment we chose
7288 to hold these headers, so that we can adjust the
7289 offset when we know the correct value. */
7290 phdr_adjust_num
= iehdr
->e_phnum
;
7291 phdr_adjust_seg
= map
;
7294 if (map
->includes_filehdr
)
7296 bfd_vma align
= (bfd_vma
) 1 << matching_lma
->alignment_power
;
7297 map
->p_paddr
-= iehdr
->e_ehsize
;
7298 /* We've subtracted off the size of headers from the
7299 first section lma, but there may have been some
7300 alignment padding before that section too. Try to
7301 account for that by adjusting the segment lma down to
7302 the same alignment. */
7303 if (segment
->p_align
!= 0 && segment
->p_align
< align
)
7304 align
= segment
->p_align
;
7305 map
->p_paddr
&= -(align
* opb
);
7309 /* Step Three: Loop over the sections again, this time assigning
7310 those that fit to the current segment and removing them from the
7311 sections array; but making sure not to leave large gaps. Once all
7312 possible sections have been assigned to the current segment it is
7313 added to the list of built segments and if sections still remain
7314 to be assigned, a new segment is constructed before repeating
7320 suggested_lma
= NULL
;
7322 /* Fill the current segment with sections that fit. */
7323 for (j
= 0; j
< section_count
; j
++)
7325 section
= sections
[j
];
7327 if (section
== NULL
)
7330 output_section
= section
->output_section
;
7332 BFD_ASSERT (output_section
!= NULL
);
7334 if (IS_CONTAINED_BY_LMA (output_section
, segment
, map
->p_paddr
,
7336 || IS_COREFILE_NOTE (segment
, section
))
7338 if (map
->count
== 0)
7340 /* If the first section in a segment does not start at
7341 the beginning of the segment, then something is
7343 if (align_power (map
->p_paddr
7344 + (map
->includes_filehdr
7345 ? iehdr
->e_ehsize
: 0)
7346 + (map
->includes_phdrs
7347 ? iehdr
->e_phnum
* iehdr
->e_phentsize
7349 output_section
->alignment_power
* opb
)
7350 != output_section
->lma
* opb
)
7357 prev_sec
= map
->sections
[map
->count
- 1];
7359 /* If the gap between the end of the previous section
7360 and the start of this section is more than
7361 maxpagesize then we need to start a new segment. */
7362 if ((BFD_ALIGN (prev_sec
->lma
+ prev_sec
->size
,
7364 < BFD_ALIGN (output_section
->lma
, maxpagesize
))
7365 || (prev_sec
->lma
+ prev_sec
->size
7366 > output_section
->lma
))
7368 if (suggested_lma
== NULL
)
7369 suggested_lma
= output_section
;
7375 map
->sections
[map
->count
++] = output_section
;
7378 if (segment
->p_type
== PT_LOAD
)
7379 section
->segment_mark
= TRUE
;
7381 else if (suggested_lma
== NULL
)
7382 suggested_lma
= output_section
;
7385 /* PR 23932. A corrupt input file may contain sections that cannot
7386 be assigned to any segment - because for example they have a
7387 negative size - or segments that do not contain any sections.
7388 But there are also valid reasons why a segment can be empty.
7389 So allow a count of zero. */
7391 /* Add the current segment to the list of built segments. */
7392 *pointer_to_map
= map
;
7393 pointer_to_map
= &map
->next
;
7395 if (isec
< section_count
)
7397 /* We still have not allocated all of the sections to
7398 segments. Create a new segment here, initialise it
7399 and carry on looping. */
7400 amt
= sizeof (struct elf_segment_map
) - sizeof (asection
*);
7401 amt
+= section_count
* sizeof (asection
*);
7402 map
= (struct elf_segment_map
*) bfd_zalloc (obfd
, amt
);
7409 /* Initialise the fields of the segment map. Set the physical
7410 physical address to the LMA of the first section that has
7411 not yet been assigned. */
7413 map
->p_type
= segment
->p_type
;
7414 map
->p_flags
= segment
->p_flags
;
7415 map
->p_flags_valid
= 1;
7416 map
->p_paddr
= suggested_lma
->lma
* opb
;
7417 map
->p_paddr_valid
= p_paddr_valid
;
7418 map
->includes_filehdr
= 0;
7419 map
->includes_phdrs
= 0;
7424 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_sorry
);
7428 while (isec
< section_count
);
7433 elf_seg_map (obfd
) = map_first
;
7435 /* If we had to estimate the number of program headers that were
7436 going to be needed, then check our estimate now and adjust
7437 the offset if necessary. */
7438 if (phdr_adjust_seg
!= NULL
)
7442 for (count
= 0, map
= map_first
; map
!= NULL
; map
= map
->next
)
7445 if (count
> phdr_adjust_num
)
7446 phdr_adjust_seg
->p_paddr
7447 -= (count
- phdr_adjust_num
) * iehdr
->e_phentsize
;
7449 for (map
= map_first
; map
!= NULL
; map
= map
->next
)
7450 if (map
->p_type
== PT_PHDR
)
7453 = phdr_adjust_seg
->includes_filehdr
? iehdr
->e_ehsize
: 0;
7454 map
->p_paddr
= phdr_adjust_seg
->p_paddr
+ adjust
;
7461 #undef IS_CONTAINED_BY_VMA
7462 #undef IS_CONTAINED_BY_LMA
7464 #undef IS_COREFILE_NOTE
7465 #undef IS_SOLARIS_PT_INTERP
7466 #undef IS_SECTION_IN_INPUT_SEGMENT
7467 #undef INCLUDE_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT
7468 #undef SEGMENT_AFTER_SEGMENT
7469 #undef SEGMENT_OVERLAPS
7473 /* Copy ELF program header information. */
7476 copy_elf_program_header (bfd
*ibfd
, bfd
*obfd
)
7478 Elf_Internal_Ehdr
*iehdr
;
7479 struct elf_segment_map
*map
;
7480 struct elf_segment_map
*map_first
;
7481 struct elf_segment_map
**pointer_to_map
;
7482 Elf_Internal_Phdr
*segment
;
7484 unsigned int num_segments
;
7485 bfd_boolean phdr_included
= FALSE
;
7486 bfd_boolean p_paddr_valid
;
7487 unsigned int opb
= bfd_octets_per_byte (ibfd
, NULL
);
7489 iehdr
= elf_elfheader (ibfd
);
7492 pointer_to_map
= &map_first
;
7494 /* If all the segment p_paddr fields are zero, don't set
7495 map->p_paddr_valid. */
7496 p_paddr_valid
= FALSE
;
7497 num_segments
= elf_elfheader (ibfd
)->e_phnum
;
7498 for (i
= 0, segment
= elf_tdata (ibfd
)->phdr
;
7501 if (segment
->p_paddr
!= 0)
7503 p_paddr_valid
= TRUE
;
7507 for (i
= 0, segment
= elf_tdata (ibfd
)->phdr
;
7512 unsigned int section_count
;
7514 Elf_Internal_Shdr
*this_hdr
;
7515 asection
*first_section
= NULL
;
7516 asection
*lowest_section
;
7518 /* Compute how many sections are in this segment. */
7519 for (section
= ibfd
->sections
, section_count
= 0;
7521 section
= section
->next
)
7523 this_hdr
= &(elf_section_data(section
)->this_hdr
);
7524 if (ELF_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT (this_hdr
, segment
))
7526 if (first_section
== NULL
)
7527 first_section
= section
;
7532 /* Allocate a segment map big enough to contain
7533 all of the sections we have selected. */
7534 amt
= sizeof (struct elf_segment_map
) - sizeof (asection
*);
7535 amt
+= section_count
* sizeof (asection
*);
7536 map
= (struct elf_segment_map
*) bfd_zalloc (obfd
, amt
);
7540 /* Initialize the fields of the output segment map with the
7543 map
->p_type
= segment
->p_type
;
7544 map
->p_flags
= segment
->p_flags
;
7545 map
->p_flags_valid
= 1;
7546 map
->p_paddr
= segment
->p_paddr
;
7547 map
->p_paddr_valid
= p_paddr_valid
;
7548 map
->p_align
= segment
->p_align
;
7549 map
->p_align_valid
= 1;
7550 map
->p_vaddr_offset
= 0;
7552 if (map
->p_type
== PT_GNU_RELRO
7553 || map
->p_type
== PT_GNU_STACK
)
7555 /* The PT_GNU_RELRO segment may contain the first a few
7556 bytes in the .got.plt section even if the whole .got.plt
7557 section isn't in the PT_GNU_RELRO segment. We won't
7558 change the size of the PT_GNU_RELRO segment.
7559 Similarly, PT_GNU_STACK size is significant on uclinux
7561 map
->p_size
= segment
->p_memsz
;
7562 map
->p_size_valid
= 1;
7565 /* Determine if this segment contains the ELF file header
7566 and if it contains the program headers themselves. */
7567 map
->includes_filehdr
= (segment
->p_offset
== 0
7568 && segment
->p_filesz
>= iehdr
->e_ehsize
);
7570 map
->includes_phdrs
= 0;
7571 if (! phdr_included
|| segment
->p_type
!= PT_LOAD
)
7573 map
->includes_phdrs
=
7574 (segment
->p_offset
<= (bfd_vma
) iehdr
->e_phoff
7575 && (segment
->p_offset
+ segment
->p_filesz
7576 >= ((bfd_vma
) iehdr
->e_phoff
7577 + iehdr
->e_phnum
* iehdr
->e_phentsize
)));
7579 if (segment
->p_type
== PT_LOAD
&& map
->includes_phdrs
)
7580 phdr_included
= TRUE
;
7583 lowest_section
= NULL
;
7584 if (section_count
!= 0)
7586 unsigned int isec
= 0;
7588 for (section
= first_section
;
7590 section
= section
->next
)
7592 this_hdr
= &(elf_section_data(section
)->this_hdr
);
7593 if (ELF_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT (this_hdr
, segment
))
7595 map
->sections
[isec
++] = section
->output_section
;
7596 if ((section
->flags
& SEC_ALLOC
) != 0)
7600 if (lowest_section
== NULL
7601 || section
->lma
< lowest_section
->lma
)
7602 lowest_section
= section
;
7604 /* Section lmas are set up from PT_LOAD header
7605 p_paddr in _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr.
7606 If this header has a p_paddr that disagrees
7607 with the section lma, flag the p_paddr as
7609 if ((section
->flags
& SEC_LOAD
) != 0)
7610 seg_off
= this_hdr
->sh_offset
- segment
->p_offset
;
7612 seg_off
= this_hdr
->sh_addr
- segment
->p_vaddr
;
7613 if (section
->lma
* opb
- segment
->p_paddr
!= seg_off
)
7614 map
->p_paddr_valid
= FALSE
;
7616 if (isec
== section_count
)
7622 if (section_count
== 0)
7623 map
->p_vaddr_offset
= segment
->p_vaddr
/ opb
;
7624 else if (map
->p_paddr_valid
)
7626 /* Account for padding before the first section in the segment. */
7627 bfd_vma hdr_size
= 0;
7628 if (map
->includes_filehdr
)
7629 hdr_size
= iehdr
->e_ehsize
;
7630 if (map
->includes_phdrs
)
7631 hdr_size
+= iehdr
->e_phnum
* iehdr
->e_phentsize
;
7633 map
->p_vaddr_offset
= ((map
->p_paddr
+ hdr_size
) / opb
7634 - (lowest_section
? lowest_section
->lma
: 0));
7637 map
->count
= section_count
;
7638 *pointer_to_map
= map
;
7639 pointer_to_map
= &map
->next
;
7642 elf_seg_map (obfd
) = map_first
;
7646 /* Copy private BFD data. This copies or rewrites ELF program header
7650 copy_private_bfd_data (bfd
*ibfd
, bfd
*obfd
)
7652 if (bfd_get_flavour (ibfd
) != bfd_target_elf_flavour
7653 || bfd_get_flavour (obfd
) != bfd_target_elf_flavour
)
7656 if (elf_tdata (ibfd
)->phdr
== NULL
)
7659 if (ibfd
->xvec
== obfd
->xvec
)
7661 /* Check to see if any sections in the input BFD
7662 covered by ELF program header have changed. */
7663 Elf_Internal_Phdr
*segment
;
7664 asection
*section
, *osec
;
7665 unsigned int i
, num_segments
;
7666 Elf_Internal_Shdr
*this_hdr
;
7667 const struct elf_backend_data
*bed
;
7669 bed
= get_elf_backend_data (ibfd
);
7671 /* Regenerate the segment map if p_paddr is set to 0. */
7672 if (bed
->want_p_paddr_set_to_zero
)
7675 /* Initialize the segment mark field. */
7676 for (section
= obfd
->sections
; section
!= NULL
;
7677 section
= section
->next
)
7678 section
->segment_mark
= FALSE
;
7680 num_segments
= elf_elfheader (ibfd
)->e_phnum
;
7681 for (i
= 0, segment
= elf_tdata (ibfd
)->phdr
;
7685 /* PR binutils/3535. The Solaris linker always sets the p_paddr
7686 and p_memsz fields of special segments (DYNAMIC, INTERP) to 0
7687 which severly confuses things, so always regenerate the segment
7688 map in this case. */
7689 if (segment
->p_paddr
== 0
7690 && segment
->p_memsz
== 0
7691 && (segment
->p_type
== PT_INTERP
|| segment
->p_type
== PT_DYNAMIC
))
7694 for (section
= ibfd
->sections
;
7695 section
!= NULL
; section
= section
->next
)
7697 /* We mark the output section so that we know it comes
7698 from the input BFD. */
7699 osec
= section
->output_section
;
7701 osec
->segment_mark
= TRUE
;
7703 /* Check if this section is covered by the segment. */
7704 this_hdr
= &(elf_section_data(section
)->this_hdr
);
7705 if (ELF_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT (this_hdr
, segment
))
7707 /* FIXME: Check if its output section is changed or
7708 removed. What else do we need to check? */
7710 || section
->flags
!= osec
->flags
7711 || section
->lma
!= osec
->lma
7712 || section
->vma
!= osec
->vma
7713 || section
->size
!= osec
->size
7714 || section
->rawsize
!= osec
->rawsize
7715 || section
->alignment_power
!= osec
->alignment_power
)
7721 /* Check to see if any output section do not come from the
7723 for (section
= obfd
->sections
; section
!= NULL
;
7724 section
= section
->next
)
7726 if (!section
->segment_mark
)
7729 section
->segment_mark
= FALSE
;
7732 return copy_elf_program_header (ibfd
, obfd
);
7736 if (ibfd
->xvec
== obfd
->xvec
)
7738 /* When rewriting program header, set the output maxpagesize to
7739 the maximum alignment of input PT_LOAD segments. */
7740 Elf_Internal_Phdr
*segment
;
7742 unsigned int num_segments
= elf_elfheader (ibfd
)->e_phnum
;
7743 bfd_vma maxpagesize
= 0;
7745 for (i
= 0, segment
= elf_tdata (ibfd
)->phdr
;
7748 if (segment
->p_type
== PT_LOAD
7749 && maxpagesize
< segment
->p_align
)
7751 /* PR 17512: file: f17299af. */
7752 if (segment
->p_align
> (bfd_vma
) 1 << ((sizeof (bfd_vma
) * 8) - 2))
7753 /* xgettext:c-format */
7754 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: warning: segment alignment of %#"
7755 PRIx64
" is too large"),
7756 ibfd
, (uint64_t) segment
->p_align
);
7758 maxpagesize
= segment
->p_align
;
7761 if (maxpagesize
!= get_elf_backend_data (obfd
)->maxpagesize
)
7762 bfd_emul_set_maxpagesize (bfd_get_target (obfd
), maxpagesize
);
7765 return rewrite_elf_program_header (ibfd
, obfd
);
7768 /* Initialize private output section information from input section. */
7771 _bfd_elf_init_private_section_data (bfd
*ibfd
,
7775 struct bfd_link_info
*link_info
)
7778 Elf_Internal_Shdr
*ihdr
, *ohdr
;
7779 bfd_boolean final_link
= (link_info
!= NULL
7780 && !bfd_link_relocatable (link_info
));
7782 if (ibfd
->xvec
->flavour
!= bfd_target_elf_flavour
7783 || obfd
->xvec
->flavour
!= bfd_target_elf_flavour
)
7786 BFD_ASSERT (elf_section_data (osec
) != NULL
);
7788 /* If this is a known ABI section, ELF section type and flags may
7789 have been set up when OSEC was created. For normal sections we
7790 allow the user to override the type and flags other than
7791 SHF_MASKOS and SHF_MASKPROC. */
7792 if (elf_section_type (osec
) == SHT_PROGBITS
7793 || elf_section_type (osec
) == SHT_NOTE
7794 || elf_section_type (osec
) == SHT_NOBITS
)
7795 elf_section_type (osec
) = SHT_NULL
;
7796 /* For objcopy and relocatable link, copy the ELF section type from
7797 the input file if the BFD section flags are the same. (If they
7798 are different the user may be doing something like
7799 "objcopy --set-section-flags .text=alloc,data".) For a final
7800 link allow some flags that the linker clears to differ. */
7801 if (elf_section_type (osec
) == SHT_NULL
7802 && (osec
->flags
== isec
->flags
7804 && ((osec
->flags
^ isec
->flags
)
7805 & ~(SEC_LINK_ONCE
| SEC_LINK_DUPLICATES
| SEC_RELOC
)) == 0)))
7806 elf_section_type (osec
) = elf_section_type (isec
);
7808 /* FIXME: Is this correct for all OS/PROC specific flags? */
7809 elf_section_flags (osec
) = (elf_section_flags (isec
)
7810 & (SHF_MASKOS
| SHF_MASKPROC
));
7812 /* Copy sh_info from input for mbind section. */
7813 if ((elf_tdata (ibfd
)->has_gnu_osabi
& elf_gnu_osabi_mbind
) != 0
7814 && elf_section_flags (isec
) & SHF_GNU_MBIND
)
7815 elf_section_data (osec
)->this_hdr
.sh_info
7816 = elf_section_data (isec
)->this_hdr
.sh_info
;
7818 /* Set things up for objcopy and relocatable link. The output
7819 SHT_GROUP section will have its elf_next_in_group pointing back
7820 to the input group members. Ignore linker created group section.
7821 See elfNN_ia64_object_p in elfxx-ia64.c. */
7822 if ((link_info
== NULL
7823 || !link_info
->resolve_section_groups
)
7824 && (elf_sec_group (isec
) == NULL
7825 || (elf_sec_group (isec
)->flags
& SEC_LINKER_CREATED
) == 0))
7827 if (elf_section_flags (isec
) & SHF_GROUP
)
7828 elf_section_flags (osec
) |= SHF_GROUP
;
7829 elf_next_in_group (osec
) = elf_next_in_group (isec
);
7830 elf_section_data (osec
)->group
= elf_section_data (isec
)->group
;
7833 /* If not decompress, preserve SHF_COMPRESSED. */
7834 if (!final_link
&& (ibfd
->flags
& BFD_DECOMPRESS
) == 0)
7835 elf_section_flags (osec
) |= (elf_section_flags (isec
)
7838 ihdr
= &elf_section_data (isec
)->this_hdr
;
7840 /* We need to handle elf_linked_to_section for SHF_LINK_ORDER. We
7841 don't use the output section of the linked-to section since it
7842 may be NULL at this point. */
7843 if ((ihdr
->sh_flags
& SHF_LINK_ORDER
) != 0)
7845 ohdr
= &elf_section_data (osec
)->this_hdr
;
7846 ohdr
->sh_flags
|= SHF_LINK_ORDER
;
7847 elf_linked_to_section (osec
) = elf_linked_to_section (isec
);
7850 osec
->use_rela_p
= isec
->use_rela_p
;
7855 /* Copy private section information. This copies over the entsize
7856 field, and sometimes the info field. */
7859 _bfd_elf_copy_private_section_data (bfd
*ibfd
,
7864 Elf_Internal_Shdr
*ihdr
, *ohdr
;
7866 if (ibfd
->xvec
->flavour
!= bfd_target_elf_flavour
7867 || obfd
->xvec
->flavour
!= bfd_target_elf_flavour
)
7870 ihdr
= &elf_section_data (isec
)->this_hdr
;
7871 ohdr
= &elf_section_data (osec
)->this_hdr
;
7873 ohdr
->sh_entsize
= ihdr
->sh_entsize
;
7875 if (ihdr
->sh_type
== SHT_SYMTAB
7876 || ihdr
->sh_type
== SHT_DYNSYM
7877 || ihdr
->sh_type
== SHT_GNU_verneed
7878 || ihdr
->sh_type
== SHT_GNU_verdef
)
7879 ohdr
->sh_info
= ihdr
->sh_info
;
7881 return _bfd_elf_init_private_section_data (ibfd
, isec
, obfd
, osec
,
7885 /* Look at all the SHT_GROUP sections in IBFD, making any adjustments
7886 necessary if we are removing either the SHT_GROUP section or any of
7887 the group member sections. DISCARDED is the value that a section's
7888 output_section has if the section will be discarded, NULL when this
7889 function is called from objcopy, bfd_abs_section_ptr when called
7893 _bfd_elf_fixup_group_sections (bfd
*ibfd
, asection
*discarded
)
7897 for (isec
= ibfd
->sections
; isec
!= NULL
; isec
= isec
->next
)
7898 if (elf_section_type (isec
) == SHT_GROUP
)
7900 asection
*first
= elf_next_in_group (isec
);
7901 asection
*s
= first
;
7902 bfd_size_type removed
= 0;
7906 /* If this member section is being output but the
7907 SHT_GROUP section is not, then clear the group info
7908 set up by _bfd_elf_copy_private_section_data. */
7909 if (s
->output_section
!= discarded
7910 && isec
->output_section
== discarded
)
7912 elf_section_flags (s
->output_section
) &= ~SHF_GROUP
;
7913 elf_group_name (s
->output_section
) = NULL
;
7917 struct bfd_elf_section_data
*elf_sec
= elf_section_data (s
);
7918 if (s
->output_section
== discarded
7919 && isec
->output_section
!= discarded
)
7921 /* Conversely, if the member section is not being
7922 output but the SHT_GROUP section is, then adjust
7925 if (elf_sec
->rel
.hdr
!= NULL
7926 && (elf_sec
->rel
.hdr
->sh_flags
& SHF_GROUP
) != 0)
7928 if (elf_sec
->rela
.hdr
!= NULL
7929 && (elf_sec
->rela
.hdr
->sh_flags
& SHF_GROUP
) != 0)
7934 /* Also adjust for zero-sized relocation member
7936 if (elf_sec
->rel
.hdr
!= NULL
7937 && elf_sec
->rel
.hdr
->sh_size
== 0)
7939 if (elf_sec
->rela
.hdr
!= NULL
7940 && elf_sec
->rela
.hdr
->sh_size
== 0)
7944 s
= elf_next_in_group (s
);
7950 if (discarded
!= NULL
)
7952 /* If we've been called for ld -r, then we need to
7953 adjust the input section size. */
7954 if (isec
->rawsize
== 0)
7955 isec
->rawsize
= isec
->size
;
7956 isec
->size
= isec
->rawsize
- removed
;
7957 if (isec
->size
<= 4)
7960 isec
->flags
|= SEC_EXCLUDE
;
7965 /* Adjust the output section size when called from
7967 isec
->output_section
->size
-= removed
;
7968 if (isec
->output_section
->size
<= 4)
7970 isec
->output_section
->size
= 0;
7971 isec
->output_section
->flags
|= SEC_EXCLUDE
;
7980 /* Copy private header information. */
7983 _bfd_elf_copy_private_header_data (bfd
*ibfd
, bfd
*obfd
)
7985 if (bfd_get_flavour (ibfd
) != bfd_target_elf_flavour
7986 || bfd_get_flavour (obfd
) != bfd_target_elf_flavour
)
7989 /* Copy over private BFD data if it has not already been copied.
7990 This must be done here, rather than in the copy_private_bfd_data
7991 entry point, because the latter is called after the section
7992 contents have been set, which means that the program headers have
7993 already been worked out. */
7994 if (elf_seg_map (obfd
) == NULL
&& elf_tdata (ibfd
)->phdr
!= NULL
)
7996 if (! copy_private_bfd_data (ibfd
, obfd
))
8000 return _bfd_elf_fixup_group_sections (ibfd
, NULL
);
8003 /* Copy private symbol information. If this symbol is in a section
8004 which we did not map into a BFD section, try to map the section
8005 index correctly. We use special macro definitions for the mapped
8006 section indices; these definitions are interpreted by the
8007 swap_out_syms function. */
8009 #define MAP_ONESYMTAB (SHN_HIOS + 1)
8010 #define MAP_DYNSYMTAB (SHN_HIOS + 2)
8011 #define MAP_STRTAB (SHN_HIOS + 3)
8012 #define MAP_SHSTRTAB (SHN_HIOS + 4)
8013 #define MAP_SYM_SHNDX (SHN_HIOS + 5)
8016 _bfd_elf_copy_private_symbol_data (bfd
*ibfd
,
8021 elf_symbol_type
*isym
, *osym
;
8023 if (bfd_get_flavour (ibfd
) != bfd_target_elf_flavour
8024 || bfd_get_flavour (obfd
) != bfd_target_elf_flavour
)
8027 isym
= elf_symbol_from (isymarg
);
8028 osym
= elf_symbol_from (osymarg
);
8031 && isym
->internal_elf_sym
.st_shndx
!= 0
8033 && bfd_is_abs_section (isym
->symbol
.section
))
8037 shndx
= isym
->internal_elf_sym
.st_shndx
;
8038 if (shndx
== elf_onesymtab (ibfd
))
8039 shndx
= MAP_ONESYMTAB
;
8040 else if (shndx
== elf_dynsymtab (ibfd
))
8041 shndx
= MAP_DYNSYMTAB
;
8042 else if (shndx
== elf_strtab_sec (ibfd
))
8044 else if (shndx
== elf_shstrtab_sec (ibfd
))
8045 shndx
= MAP_SHSTRTAB
;
8046 else if (find_section_in_list (shndx
, elf_symtab_shndx_list (ibfd
)))
8047 shndx
= MAP_SYM_SHNDX
;
8048 osym
->internal_elf_sym
.st_shndx
= shndx
;
8054 /* Swap out the symbols. */
8057 swap_out_syms (bfd
*abfd
,
8058 struct elf_strtab_hash
**sttp
,
8060 struct bfd_link_info
*info
)
8062 const struct elf_backend_data
*bed
;
8063 unsigned int symcount
;
8065 struct elf_strtab_hash
*stt
;
8066 Elf_Internal_Shdr
*symtab_hdr
;
8067 Elf_Internal_Shdr
*symtab_shndx_hdr
;
8068 Elf_Internal_Shdr
*symstrtab_hdr
;
8069 struct elf_sym_strtab
*symstrtab
;
8070 bfd_byte
*outbound_syms
;
8071 bfd_byte
*outbound_shndx
;
8072 unsigned long outbound_syms_index
;
8073 unsigned long outbound_shndx_index
;
8075 unsigned int num_locals
;
8077 bfd_boolean name_local_sections
;
8079 if (!elf_map_symbols (abfd
, &num_locals
))
8082 /* Dump out the symtabs. */
8083 stt
= _bfd_elf_strtab_init ();
8087 bed
= get_elf_backend_data (abfd
);
8088 symcount
= bfd_get_symcount (abfd
);
8089 symtab_hdr
= &elf_tdata (abfd
)->symtab_hdr
;
8090 symtab_hdr
->sh_type
= SHT_SYMTAB
;
8091 symtab_hdr
->sh_entsize
= bed
->s
->sizeof_sym
;
8092 symtab_hdr
->sh_size
= symtab_hdr
->sh_entsize
* (symcount
+ 1);
8093 symtab_hdr
->sh_info
= num_locals
+ 1;
8094 symtab_hdr
->sh_addralign
= (bfd_vma
) 1 << bed
->s
->log_file_align
;
8096 symstrtab_hdr
= &elf_tdata (abfd
)->strtab_hdr
;
8097 symstrtab_hdr
->sh_type
= SHT_STRTAB
;
8099 /* Allocate buffer to swap out the .strtab section. */
8100 if (_bfd_mul_overflow (symcount
+ 1, sizeof (*symstrtab
), &amt
)
8101 || (symstrtab
= (struct elf_sym_strtab
*) bfd_malloc (amt
)) == NULL
)
8103 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_no_memory
);
8104 _bfd_elf_strtab_free (stt
);
8108 if (_bfd_mul_overflow (symcount
+ 1, bed
->s
->sizeof_sym
, &amt
)
8109 || (outbound_syms
= (bfd_byte
*) bfd_alloc (abfd
, amt
)) == NULL
)
8112 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_no_memory
);
8115 _bfd_elf_strtab_free (stt
);
8118 symtab_hdr
->contents
= outbound_syms
;
8119 outbound_syms_index
= 0;
8121 outbound_shndx
= NULL
;
8122 outbound_shndx_index
= 0;
8124 if (elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd
))
8126 symtab_shndx_hdr
= & elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd
)->hdr
;
8127 if (symtab_shndx_hdr
->sh_name
!= 0)
8129 if (_bfd_mul_overflow (symcount
+ 1,
8130 sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx
), &amt
))
8132 outbound_shndx
= (bfd_byte
*) bfd_zalloc (abfd
, amt
);
8133 if (outbound_shndx
== NULL
)
8136 symtab_shndx_hdr
->contents
= outbound_shndx
;
8137 symtab_shndx_hdr
->sh_type
= SHT_SYMTAB_SHNDX
;
8138 symtab_shndx_hdr
->sh_size
= amt
;
8139 symtab_shndx_hdr
->sh_addralign
= sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx
);
8140 symtab_shndx_hdr
->sh_entsize
= sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx
);
8142 /* FIXME: What about any other headers in the list ? */
8145 /* Now generate the data (for "contents"). */
8147 /* Fill in zeroth symbol and swap it out. */
8148 Elf_Internal_Sym sym
;
8154 sym
.st_shndx
= SHN_UNDEF
;
8155 sym
.st_target_internal
= 0;
8156 symstrtab
[0].sym
= sym
;
8157 symstrtab
[0].dest_index
= outbound_syms_index
;
8158 symstrtab
[0].destshndx_index
= outbound_shndx_index
;
8159 outbound_syms_index
++;
8160 if (outbound_shndx
!= NULL
)
8161 outbound_shndx_index
++;
8165 = (bed
->elf_backend_name_local_section_symbols
8166 && bed
->elf_backend_name_local_section_symbols (abfd
));
8168 syms
= bfd_get_outsymbols (abfd
);
8169 for (idx
= 0; idx
< symcount
;)
8171 Elf_Internal_Sym sym
;
8172 bfd_vma value
= syms
[idx
]->value
;
8173 elf_symbol_type
*type_ptr
;
8174 flagword flags
= syms
[idx
]->flags
;
8177 if (!name_local_sections
8178 && (flags
& (BSF_SECTION_SYM
| BSF_GLOBAL
)) == BSF_SECTION_SYM
)
8180 /* Local section symbols have no name. */
8181 sym
.st_name
= (unsigned long) -1;
8185 /* Call _bfd_elf_strtab_offset after _bfd_elf_strtab_finalize
8186 to get the final offset for st_name. */
8188 = (unsigned long) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (stt
, syms
[idx
]->name
,
8190 if (sym
.st_name
== (unsigned long) -1)
8194 type_ptr
= elf_symbol_from (syms
[idx
]);
8196 if ((flags
& BSF_SECTION_SYM
) == 0
8197 && bfd_is_com_section (syms
[idx
]->section
))
8199 /* ELF common symbols put the alignment into the `value' field,
8200 and the size into the `size' field. This is backwards from
8201 how BFD handles it, so reverse it here. */
8202 sym
.st_size
= value
;
8203 if (type_ptr
== NULL
8204 || type_ptr
->internal_elf_sym
.st_value
== 0)
8205 sym
.st_value
= value
>= 16 ? 16 : (1 << bfd_log2 (value
));
8207 sym
.st_value
= type_ptr
->internal_elf_sym
.st_value
;
8208 sym
.st_shndx
= _bfd_elf_section_from_bfd_section
8209 (abfd
, syms
[idx
]->section
);
8213 asection
*sec
= syms
[idx
]->section
;
8216 if (sec
->output_section
)
8218 value
+= sec
->output_offset
;
8219 sec
= sec
->output_section
;
8222 /* Don't add in the section vma for relocatable output. */
8223 if (! relocatable_p
)
8225 sym
.st_value
= value
;
8226 sym
.st_size
= type_ptr
? type_ptr
->internal_elf_sym
.st_size
: 0;
8228 if (bfd_is_abs_section (sec
)
8230 && type_ptr
->internal_elf_sym
.st_shndx
!= 0)
8232 /* This symbol is in a real ELF section which we did
8233 not create as a BFD section. Undo the mapping done
8234 by copy_private_symbol_data. */
8235 shndx
= type_ptr
->internal_elf_sym
.st_shndx
;
8239 shndx
= elf_onesymtab (abfd
);
8242 shndx
= elf_dynsymtab (abfd
);
8245 shndx
= elf_strtab_sec (abfd
);
8248 shndx
= elf_shstrtab_sec (abfd
);
8251 if (elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd
))
8252 shndx
= elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd
)->ndx
;
8259 if (shndx
>= SHN_LOPROC
&& shndx
<= SHN_HIOS
)
8261 if (bed
->symbol_section_index
)
8262 shndx
= bed
->symbol_section_index (abfd
, type_ptr
);
8263 /* Otherwise just leave the index alone. */
8267 if (shndx
> SHN_HIOS
&& shndx
< SHN_HIRESERVE
)
8268 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: \
8269 Unable to handle section index %x in ELF symbol. Using ABS instead."),
8278 shndx
= _bfd_elf_section_from_bfd_section (abfd
, sec
);
8280 if (shndx
== SHN_BAD
)
8284 /* Writing this would be a hell of a lot easier if
8285 we had some decent documentation on bfd, and
8286 knew what to expect of the library, and what to
8287 demand of applications. For example, it
8288 appears that `objcopy' might not set the
8289 section of a symbol to be a section that is
8290 actually in the output file. */
8291 sec2
= bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd
, sec
->name
);
8293 shndx
= _bfd_elf_section_from_bfd_section (abfd
, sec2
);
8294 if (shndx
== SHN_BAD
)
8296 /* xgettext:c-format */
8298 (_("unable to find equivalent output section"
8299 " for symbol '%s' from section '%s'"),
8300 syms
[idx
]->name
? syms
[idx
]->name
: "<Local sym>",
8302 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_invalid_operation
);
8308 sym
.st_shndx
= shndx
;
8311 if ((flags
& BSF_THREAD_LOCAL
) != 0)
8313 else if ((flags
& BSF_GNU_INDIRECT_FUNCTION
) != 0)
8314 type
= STT_GNU_IFUNC
;
8315 else if ((flags
& BSF_FUNCTION
) != 0)
8317 else if ((flags
& BSF_OBJECT
) != 0)
8319 else if ((flags
& BSF_RELC
) != 0)
8321 else if ((flags
& BSF_SRELC
) != 0)
8326 if (syms
[idx
]->section
->flags
& SEC_THREAD_LOCAL
)
8329 /* Processor-specific types. */
8330 if (type_ptr
!= NULL
8331 && bed
->elf_backend_get_symbol_type
)
8332 type
= ((*bed
->elf_backend_get_symbol_type
)
8333 (&type_ptr
->internal_elf_sym
, type
));
8335 if (flags
& BSF_SECTION_SYM
)
8337 if (flags
& BSF_GLOBAL
)
8338 sym
.st_info
= ELF_ST_INFO (STB_GLOBAL
, STT_SECTION
);
8340 sym
.st_info
= ELF_ST_INFO (STB_LOCAL
, STT_SECTION
);
8342 else if (bfd_is_com_section (syms
[idx
]->section
))
8344 if (type
!= STT_TLS
)
8346 if ((abfd
->flags
& BFD_CONVERT_ELF_COMMON
))
8347 type
= ((abfd
->flags
& BFD_USE_ELF_STT_COMMON
)
8348 ? STT_COMMON
: STT_OBJECT
);
8350 type
= ((flags
& BSF_ELF_COMMON
) != 0
8351 ? STT_COMMON
: STT_OBJECT
);
8353 sym
.st_info
= ELF_ST_INFO (STB_GLOBAL
, type
);
8355 else if (bfd_is_und_section (syms
[idx
]->section
))
8356 sym
.st_info
= ELF_ST_INFO (((flags
& BSF_WEAK
)
8360 else if (flags
& BSF_FILE
)
8361 sym
.st_info
= ELF_ST_INFO (STB_LOCAL
, STT_FILE
);
8364 int bind
= STB_LOCAL
;
8366 if (flags
& BSF_LOCAL
)
8368 else if (flags
& BSF_GNU_UNIQUE
)
8369 bind
= STB_GNU_UNIQUE
;
8370 else if (flags
& BSF_WEAK
)
8372 else if (flags
& BSF_GLOBAL
)
8375 sym
.st_info
= ELF_ST_INFO (bind
, type
);
8378 if (type_ptr
!= NULL
)
8380 sym
.st_other
= type_ptr
->internal_elf_sym
.st_other
;
8381 sym
.st_target_internal
8382 = type_ptr
->internal_elf_sym
.st_target_internal
;
8387 sym
.st_target_internal
= 0;
8391 symstrtab
[idx
].sym
= sym
;
8392 symstrtab
[idx
].dest_index
= outbound_syms_index
;
8393 symstrtab
[idx
].destshndx_index
= outbound_shndx_index
;
8395 outbound_syms_index
++;
8396 if (outbound_shndx
!= NULL
)
8397 outbound_shndx_index
++;
8400 /* Finalize the .strtab section. */
8401 _bfd_elf_strtab_finalize (stt
);
8403 /* Swap out the .strtab section. */
8404 for (idx
= 0; idx
<= symcount
; idx
++)
8406 struct elf_sym_strtab
*elfsym
= &symstrtab
[idx
];
8407 if (elfsym
->sym
.st_name
== (unsigned long) -1)
8408 elfsym
->sym
.st_name
= 0;
8410 elfsym
->sym
.st_name
= _bfd_elf_strtab_offset (stt
,
8411 elfsym
->sym
.st_name
);
8412 if (info
&& info
->callbacks
->ctf_new_symbol
)
8413 info
->callbacks
->ctf_new_symbol (elfsym
->dest_index
,
8416 /* Inform the linker of the addition of this symbol. */
8418 bed
->s
->swap_symbol_out (abfd
, &elfsym
->sym
,
8420 + (elfsym
->dest_index
8421 * bed
->s
->sizeof_sym
)),
8423 + (elfsym
->destshndx_index
8424 * sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx
))));
8429 symstrtab_hdr
->sh_size
= _bfd_elf_strtab_size (stt
);
8430 symstrtab_hdr
->sh_type
= SHT_STRTAB
;
8431 symstrtab_hdr
->sh_flags
= bed
->elf_strtab_flags
;
8432 symstrtab_hdr
->sh_addr
= 0;
8433 symstrtab_hdr
->sh_entsize
= 0;
8434 symstrtab_hdr
->sh_link
= 0;
8435 symstrtab_hdr
->sh_info
= 0;
8436 symstrtab_hdr
->sh_addralign
= 1;
8441 /* Return the number of bytes required to hold the symtab vector.
8443 Note that we base it on the count plus 1, since we will null terminate
8444 the vector allocated based on this size. However, the ELF symbol table
8445 always has a dummy entry as symbol #0, so it ends up even. */
8448 _bfd_elf_get_symtab_upper_bound (bfd
*abfd
)
8450 bfd_size_type symcount
;
8452 Elf_Internal_Shdr
*hdr
= &elf_tdata (abfd
)->symtab_hdr
;
8454 symcount
= hdr
->sh_size
/ get_elf_backend_data (abfd
)->s
->sizeof_sym
;
8455 if (symcount
> LONG_MAX
/ sizeof (asymbol
*))
8457 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_file_too_big
);
8460 symtab_size
= symcount
* (sizeof (asymbol
*));
8462 symtab_size
= sizeof (asymbol
*);
8463 else if (!bfd_write_p (abfd
))
8465 ufile_ptr filesize
= bfd_get_file_size (abfd
);
8467 if (filesize
!= 0 && (unsigned long) symtab_size
> filesize
)
8469 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_file_truncated
);
8478 _bfd_elf_get_dynamic_symtab_upper_bound (bfd
*abfd
)
8480 bfd_size_type symcount
;
8482 Elf_Internal_Shdr
*hdr
= &elf_tdata (abfd
)->dynsymtab_hdr
;
8484 if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd
) == 0)
8486 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_invalid_operation
);
8490 symcount
= hdr
->sh_size
/ get_elf_backend_data (abfd
)->s
->sizeof_sym
;
8491 if (symcount
> LONG_MAX
/ sizeof (asymbol
*))
8493 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_file_too_big
);
8496 symtab_size
= symcount
* (sizeof (asymbol
*));
8498 symtab_size
= sizeof (asymbol
*);
8499 else if (!bfd_write_p (abfd
))
8501 ufile_ptr filesize
= bfd_get_file_size (abfd
);
8503 if (filesize
!= 0 && (unsigned long) symtab_size
> filesize
)
8505 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_file_truncated
);
8514 _bfd_elf_get_reloc_upper_bound (bfd
*abfd
, sec_ptr asect
)
8516 if (asect
->reloc_count
!= 0 && !bfd_write_p (abfd
))
8518 /* Sanity check reloc section size. */
8519 struct bfd_elf_section_data
*d
= elf_section_data (asect
);
8520 Elf_Internal_Shdr
*rel_hdr
= &d
->this_hdr
;
8521 bfd_size_type ext_rel_size
= rel_hdr
->sh_size
;
8522 ufile_ptr filesize
= bfd_get_file_size (abfd
);
8524 if (filesize
!= 0 && ext_rel_size
> filesize
)
8526 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_file_truncated
);
8531 #if SIZEOF_LONG == SIZEOF_INT
8532 if (asect
->reloc_count
>= LONG_MAX
/ sizeof (arelent
*))
8534 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_file_too_big
);
8538 return (asect
->reloc_count
+ 1) * sizeof (arelent
*);
8541 /* Canonicalize the relocs. */
8544 _bfd_elf_canonicalize_reloc (bfd
*abfd
,
8551 const struct elf_backend_data
*bed
= get_elf_backend_data (abfd
);
8553 if (! bed
->s
->slurp_reloc_table (abfd
, section
, symbols
, FALSE
))
8556 tblptr
= section
->relocation
;
8557 for (i
= 0; i
< section
->reloc_count
; i
++)
8558 *relptr
++ = tblptr
++;
8562 return section
->reloc_count
;
8566 _bfd_elf_canonicalize_symtab (bfd
*abfd
, asymbol
**allocation
)
8568 const struct elf_backend_data
*bed
= get_elf_backend_data (abfd
);
8569 long symcount
= bed
->s
->slurp_symbol_table (abfd
, allocation
, FALSE
);
8572 abfd
->symcount
= symcount
;
8577 _bfd_elf_canonicalize_dynamic_symtab (bfd
*abfd
,
8578 asymbol
**allocation
)
8580 const struct elf_backend_data
*bed
= get_elf_backend_data (abfd
);
8581 long symcount
= bed
->s
->slurp_symbol_table (abfd
, allocation
, TRUE
);
8584 abfd
->dynsymcount
= symcount
;
8588 /* Return the size required for the dynamic reloc entries. Any loadable
8589 section that was actually installed in the BFD, and has type SHT_REL
8590 or SHT_RELA, and uses the dynamic symbol table, is considered to be a
8591 dynamic reloc section. */
8594 _bfd_elf_get_dynamic_reloc_upper_bound (bfd
*abfd
)
8596 bfd_size_type count
, ext_rel_size
;
8599 if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd
) == 0)
8601 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_invalid_operation
);
8607 for (s
= abfd
->sections
; s
!= NULL
; s
= s
->next
)
8608 if (elf_section_data (s
)->this_hdr
.sh_link
== elf_dynsymtab (abfd
)
8609 && (elf_section_data (s
)->this_hdr
.sh_type
== SHT_REL
8610 || elf_section_data (s
)->this_hdr
.sh_type
== SHT_RELA
))
8612 ext_rel_size
+= s
->size
;
8613 if (ext_rel_size
< s
->size
)
8615 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_file_truncated
);
8618 count
+= s
->size
/ elf_section_data (s
)->this_hdr
.sh_entsize
;
8619 if (count
> LONG_MAX
/ sizeof (arelent
*))
8621 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_file_too_big
);
8625 if (count
> 1 && !bfd_write_p (abfd
))
8627 /* Sanity check reloc section sizes. */
8628 ufile_ptr filesize
= bfd_get_file_size (abfd
);
8629 if (filesize
!= 0 && ext_rel_size
> filesize
)
8631 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_file_truncated
);
8635 return count
* sizeof (arelent
*);
8638 /* Canonicalize the dynamic relocation entries. Note that we return the
8639 dynamic relocations as a single block, although they are actually
8640 associated with particular sections; the interface, which was
8641 designed for SunOS style shared libraries, expects that there is only
8642 one set of dynamic relocs. Any loadable section that was actually
8643 installed in the BFD, and has type SHT_REL or SHT_RELA, and uses the
8644 dynamic symbol table, is considered to be a dynamic reloc section. */
8647 _bfd_elf_canonicalize_dynamic_reloc (bfd
*abfd
,
8651 bfd_boolean (*slurp_relocs
) (bfd
*, asection
*, asymbol
**, bfd_boolean
);
8655 if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd
) == 0)
8657 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_invalid_operation
);
8661 slurp_relocs
= get_elf_backend_data (abfd
)->s
->slurp_reloc_table
;
8663 for (s
= abfd
->sections
; s
!= NULL
; s
= s
->next
)
8665 if (elf_section_data (s
)->this_hdr
.sh_link
== elf_dynsymtab (abfd
)
8666 && (elf_section_data (s
)->this_hdr
.sh_type
== SHT_REL
8667 || elf_section_data (s
)->this_hdr
.sh_type
== SHT_RELA
))
8672 if (! (*slurp_relocs
) (abfd
, s
, syms
, TRUE
))
8674 count
= s
->size
/ elf_section_data (s
)->this_hdr
.sh_entsize
;
8676 for (i
= 0; i
< count
; i
++)
8687 /* Read in the version information. */
8690 _bfd_elf_slurp_version_tables (bfd
*abfd
, bfd_boolean default_imported_symver
)
8692 bfd_byte
*contents
= NULL
;
8693 unsigned int freeidx
= 0;
8696 if (elf_dynverref (abfd
) != 0)
8698 Elf_Internal_Shdr
*hdr
;
8699 Elf_External_Verneed
*everneed
;
8700 Elf_Internal_Verneed
*iverneed
;
8702 bfd_byte
*contents_end
;
8704 hdr
= &elf_tdata (abfd
)->dynverref_hdr
;
8706 if (hdr
->sh_info
== 0
8707 || hdr
->sh_info
> hdr
->sh_size
/ sizeof (Elf_External_Verneed
))
8709 error_return_bad_verref
:
8711 (_("%pB: .gnu.version_r invalid entry"), abfd
);
8712 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value
);
8713 error_return_verref
:
8714 elf_tdata (abfd
)->verref
= NULL
;
8715 elf_tdata (abfd
)->cverrefs
= 0;
8719 if (bfd_seek (abfd
, hdr
->sh_offset
, SEEK_SET
) != 0)
8720 goto error_return_verref
;
8721 contents
= _bfd_malloc_and_read (abfd
, hdr
->sh_size
, hdr
->sh_size
);
8722 if (contents
== NULL
)
8723 goto error_return_verref
;
8725 if (_bfd_mul_overflow (hdr
->sh_info
, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Verneed
), &amt
))
8727 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_file_too_big
);
8728 goto error_return_verref
;
8730 elf_tdata (abfd
)->verref
= (Elf_Internal_Verneed
*) bfd_alloc (abfd
, amt
);
8731 if (elf_tdata (abfd
)->verref
== NULL
)
8732 goto error_return_verref
;
8734 BFD_ASSERT (sizeof (Elf_External_Verneed
)
8735 == sizeof (Elf_External_Vernaux
));
8736 contents_end
= contents
+ hdr
->sh_size
- sizeof (Elf_External_Verneed
);
8737 everneed
= (Elf_External_Verneed
*) contents
;
8738 iverneed
= elf_tdata (abfd
)->verref
;
8739 for (i
= 0; i
< hdr
->sh_info
; i
++, iverneed
++)
8741 Elf_External_Vernaux
*evernaux
;
8742 Elf_Internal_Vernaux
*ivernaux
;
8745 _bfd_elf_swap_verneed_in (abfd
, everneed
, iverneed
);
8747 iverneed
->vn_bfd
= abfd
;
8749 iverneed
->vn_filename
=
8750 bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd
, hdr
->sh_link
,
8752 if (iverneed
->vn_filename
== NULL
)
8753 goto error_return_bad_verref
;
8755 if (iverneed
->vn_cnt
== 0)
8756 iverneed
->vn_auxptr
= NULL
;
8759 if (_bfd_mul_overflow (iverneed
->vn_cnt
,
8760 sizeof (Elf_Internal_Vernaux
), &amt
))
8762 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_file_too_big
);
8763 goto error_return_verref
;
8765 iverneed
->vn_auxptr
= (struct elf_internal_vernaux
*)
8766 bfd_alloc (abfd
, amt
);
8767 if (iverneed
->vn_auxptr
== NULL
)
8768 goto error_return_verref
;
8771 if (iverneed
->vn_aux
8772 > (size_t) (contents_end
- (bfd_byte
*) everneed
))
8773 goto error_return_bad_verref
;
8775 evernaux
= ((Elf_External_Vernaux
*)
8776 ((bfd_byte
*) everneed
+ iverneed
->vn_aux
));
8777 ivernaux
= iverneed
->vn_auxptr
;
8778 for (j
= 0; j
< iverneed
->vn_cnt
; j
++, ivernaux
++)
8780 _bfd_elf_swap_vernaux_in (abfd
, evernaux
, ivernaux
);
8782 ivernaux
->vna_nodename
=
8783 bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd
, hdr
->sh_link
,
8784 ivernaux
->vna_name
);
8785 if (ivernaux
->vna_nodename
== NULL
)
8786 goto error_return_bad_verref
;
8788 if (ivernaux
->vna_other
> freeidx
)
8789 freeidx
= ivernaux
->vna_other
;
8791 ivernaux
->vna_nextptr
= NULL
;
8792 if (ivernaux
->vna_next
== 0)
8794 iverneed
->vn_cnt
= j
+ 1;
8797 if (j
+ 1 < iverneed
->vn_cnt
)
8798 ivernaux
->vna_nextptr
= ivernaux
+ 1;
8800 if (ivernaux
->vna_next
8801 > (size_t) (contents_end
- (bfd_byte
*) evernaux
))
8802 goto error_return_bad_verref
;
8804 evernaux
= ((Elf_External_Vernaux
*)
8805 ((bfd_byte
*) evernaux
+ ivernaux
->vna_next
));
8808 iverneed
->vn_nextref
= NULL
;
8809 if (iverneed
->vn_next
== 0)
8811 if (i
+ 1 < hdr
->sh_info
)
8812 iverneed
->vn_nextref
= iverneed
+ 1;
8814 if (iverneed
->vn_next
8815 > (size_t) (contents_end
- (bfd_byte
*) everneed
))
8816 goto error_return_bad_verref
;
8818 everneed
= ((Elf_External_Verneed
*)
8819 ((bfd_byte
*) everneed
+ iverneed
->vn_next
));
8821 elf_tdata (abfd
)->cverrefs
= i
;
8827 if (elf_dynverdef (abfd
) != 0)
8829 Elf_Internal_Shdr
*hdr
;
8830 Elf_External_Verdef
*everdef
;
8831 Elf_Internal_Verdef
*iverdef
;
8832 Elf_Internal_Verdef
*iverdefarr
;
8833 Elf_Internal_Verdef iverdefmem
;
8835 unsigned int maxidx
;
8836 bfd_byte
*contents_end_def
, *contents_end_aux
;
8838 hdr
= &elf_tdata (abfd
)->dynverdef_hdr
;
8840 if (hdr
->sh_info
== 0 || hdr
->sh_size
< sizeof (Elf_External_Verdef
))
8842 error_return_bad_verdef
:
8844 (_("%pB: .gnu.version_d invalid entry"), abfd
);
8845 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value
);
8846 error_return_verdef
:
8847 elf_tdata (abfd
)->verdef
= NULL
;
8848 elf_tdata (abfd
)->cverdefs
= 0;
8852 if (bfd_seek (abfd
, hdr
->sh_offset
, SEEK_SET
) != 0)
8853 goto error_return_verdef
;
8854 contents
= _bfd_malloc_and_read (abfd
, hdr
->sh_size
, hdr
->sh_size
);
8855 if (contents
== NULL
)
8856 goto error_return_verdef
;
8858 BFD_ASSERT (sizeof (Elf_External_Verdef
)
8859 >= sizeof (Elf_External_Verdaux
));
8860 contents_end_def
= contents
+ hdr
->sh_size
8861 - sizeof (Elf_External_Verdef
);
8862 contents_end_aux
= contents
+ hdr
->sh_size
8863 - sizeof (Elf_External_Verdaux
);
8865 /* We know the number of entries in the section but not the maximum
8866 index. Therefore we have to run through all entries and find
8868 everdef
= (Elf_External_Verdef
*) contents
;
8870 for (i
= 0; i
< hdr
->sh_info
; ++i
)
8872 _bfd_elf_swap_verdef_in (abfd
, everdef
, &iverdefmem
);
8874 if ((iverdefmem
.vd_ndx
& ((unsigned) VERSYM_VERSION
)) == 0)
8875 goto error_return_bad_verdef
;
8876 if ((iverdefmem
.vd_ndx
& ((unsigned) VERSYM_VERSION
)) > maxidx
)
8877 maxidx
= iverdefmem
.vd_ndx
& ((unsigned) VERSYM_VERSION
);
8879 if (iverdefmem
.vd_next
== 0)
8882 if (iverdefmem
.vd_next
8883 > (size_t) (contents_end_def
- (bfd_byte
*) everdef
))
8884 goto error_return_bad_verdef
;
8886 everdef
= ((Elf_External_Verdef
*)
8887 ((bfd_byte
*) everdef
+ iverdefmem
.vd_next
));
8890 if (default_imported_symver
)
8892 if (freeidx
> maxidx
)
8897 if (_bfd_mul_overflow (maxidx
, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Verdef
), &amt
))
8899 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_file_too_big
);
8900 goto error_return_verdef
;
8902 elf_tdata (abfd
)->verdef
= (Elf_Internal_Verdef
*) bfd_zalloc (abfd
, amt
);
8903 if (elf_tdata (abfd
)->verdef
== NULL
)
8904 goto error_return_verdef
;
8906 elf_tdata (abfd
)->cverdefs
= maxidx
;
8908 everdef
= (Elf_External_Verdef
*) contents
;
8909 iverdefarr
= elf_tdata (abfd
)->verdef
;
8910 for (i
= 0; i
< hdr
->sh_info
; i
++)
8912 Elf_External_Verdaux
*everdaux
;
8913 Elf_Internal_Verdaux
*iverdaux
;
8916 _bfd_elf_swap_verdef_in (abfd
, everdef
, &iverdefmem
);
8918 if ((iverdefmem
.vd_ndx
& VERSYM_VERSION
) == 0)
8919 goto error_return_bad_verdef
;
8921 iverdef
= &iverdefarr
[(iverdefmem
.vd_ndx
& VERSYM_VERSION
) - 1];
8922 memcpy (iverdef
, &iverdefmem
, offsetof (Elf_Internal_Verdef
, vd_bfd
));
8924 iverdef
->vd_bfd
= abfd
;
8926 if (iverdef
->vd_cnt
== 0)
8927 iverdef
->vd_auxptr
= NULL
;
8930 if (_bfd_mul_overflow (iverdef
->vd_cnt
,
8931 sizeof (Elf_Internal_Verdaux
), &amt
))
8933 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_file_too_big
);
8934 goto error_return_verdef
;
8936 iverdef
->vd_auxptr
= (struct elf_internal_verdaux
*)
8937 bfd_alloc (abfd
, amt
);
8938 if (iverdef
->vd_auxptr
== NULL
)
8939 goto error_return_verdef
;
8943 > (size_t) (contents_end_aux
- (bfd_byte
*) everdef
))
8944 goto error_return_bad_verdef
;
8946 everdaux
= ((Elf_External_Verdaux
*)
8947 ((bfd_byte
*) everdef
+ iverdef
->vd_aux
));
8948 iverdaux
= iverdef
->vd_auxptr
;
8949 for (j
= 0; j
< iverdef
->vd_cnt
; j
++, iverdaux
++)
8951 _bfd_elf_swap_verdaux_in (abfd
, everdaux
, iverdaux
);
8953 iverdaux
->vda_nodename
=
8954 bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd
, hdr
->sh_link
,
8955 iverdaux
->vda_name
);
8956 if (iverdaux
->vda_nodename
== NULL
)
8957 goto error_return_bad_verdef
;
8959 iverdaux
->vda_nextptr
= NULL
;
8960 if (iverdaux
->vda_next
== 0)
8962 iverdef
->vd_cnt
= j
+ 1;
8965 if (j
+ 1 < iverdef
->vd_cnt
)
8966 iverdaux
->vda_nextptr
= iverdaux
+ 1;
8968 if (iverdaux
->vda_next
8969 > (size_t) (contents_end_aux
- (bfd_byte
*) everdaux
))
8970 goto error_return_bad_verdef
;
8972 everdaux
= ((Elf_External_Verdaux
*)
8973 ((bfd_byte
*) everdaux
+ iverdaux
->vda_next
));
8976 iverdef
->vd_nodename
= NULL
;
8977 if (iverdef
->vd_cnt
)
8978 iverdef
->vd_nodename
= iverdef
->vd_auxptr
->vda_nodename
;
8980 iverdef
->vd_nextdef
= NULL
;
8981 if (iverdef
->vd_next
== 0)
8983 if ((size_t) (iverdef
- iverdefarr
) + 1 < maxidx
)
8984 iverdef
->vd_nextdef
= iverdef
+ 1;
8986 everdef
= ((Elf_External_Verdef
*)
8987 ((bfd_byte
*) everdef
+ iverdef
->vd_next
));
8993 else if (default_imported_symver
)
9000 if (_bfd_mul_overflow (freeidx
, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Verdef
), &amt
))
9002 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_file_too_big
);
9005 elf_tdata (abfd
)->verdef
= (Elf_Internal_Verdef
*) bfd_zalloc (abfd
, amt
);
9006 if (elf_tdata (abfd
)->verdef
== NULL
)
9009 elf_tdata (abfd
)->cverdefs
= freeidx
;
9012 /* Create a default version based on the soname. */
9013 if (default_imported_symver
)
9015 Elf_Internal_Verdef
*iverdef
;
9016 Elf_Internal_Verdaux
*iverdaux
;
9018 iverdef
= &elf_tdata (abfd
)->verdef
[freeidx
- 1];
9020 iverdef
->vd_version
= VER_DEF_CURRENT
;
9021 iverdef
->vd_flags
= 0;
9022 iverdef
->vd_ndx
= freeidx
;
9023 iverdef
->vd_cnt
= 1;
9025 iverdef
->vd_bfd
= abfd
;
9027 iverdef
->vd_nodename
= bfd_elf_get_dt_soname (abfd
);
9028 if (iverdef
->vd_nodename
== NULL
)
9029 goto error_return_verdef
;
9030 iverdef
->vd_nextdef
= NULL
;
9031 iverdef
->vd_auxptr
= ((struct elf_internal_verdaux
*)
9032 bfd_zalloc (abfd
, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Verdaux
)));
9033 if (iverdef
->vd_auxptr
== NULL
)
9034 goto error_return_verdef
;
9036 iverdaux
= iverdef
->vd_auxptr
;
9037 iverdaux
->vda_nodename
= iverdef
->vd_nodename
;
9048 _bfd_elf_make_empty_symbol (bfd
*abfd
)
9050 elf_symbol_type
*newsym
;
9052 newsym
= (elf_symbol_type
*) bfd_zalloc (abfd
, sizeof (*newsym
));
9055 newsym
->symbol
.the_bfd
= abfd
;
9056 return &newsym
->symbol
;
9060 _bfd_elf_get_symbol_info (bfd
*abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED
,
9064 bfd_symbol_info (symbol
, ret
);
9067 /* Return whether a symbol name implies a local symbol. Most targets
9068 use this function for the is_local_label_name entry point, but some
9072 _bfd_elf_is_local_label_name (bfd
*abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED
,
9075 /* Normal local symbols start with ``.L''. */
9076 if (name
[0] == '.' && name
[1] == 'L')
9079 /* At least some SVR4 compilers (e.g., UnixWare 2.1 cc) generate
9080 DWARF debugging symbols starting with ``..''. */
9081 if (name
[0] == '.' && name
[1] == '.')
9084 /* gcc will sometimes generate symbols beginning with ``_.L_'' when
9085 emitting DWARF debugging output. I suspect this is actually a
9086 small bug in gcc (it calls ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL when it should call
9087 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL, and this causes the leading
9088 underscore to be emitted on some ELF targets). For ease of use,
9089 we treat such symbols as local. */
9090 if (name
[0] == '_' && name
[1] == '.' && name
[2] == 'L' && name
[3] == '_')
9093 /* Treat assembler generated fake symbols, dollar local labels and
9094 forward-backward labels (aka local labels) as locals.
9095 These labels have the form:
9097 L0^A.* (fake symbols)
9099 [.]?L[0123456789]+{^A|^B}[0123456789]* (local labels)
9101 Versions which start with .L will have already been matched above,
9102 so we only need to match the rest. */
9103 if (name
[0] == 'L' && ISDIGIT (name
[1]))
9105 bfd_boolean ret
= FALSE
;
9109 for (p
= name
+ 2; (c
= *p
); p
++)
9111 if (c
== 1 || c
== 2)
9113 if (c
== 1 && p
== name
+ 2)
9114 /* A fake symbol. */
9117 /* FIXME: We are being paranoid here and treating symbols like
9118 L0^Bfoo as if there were non-local, on the grounds that the
9119 assembler will never generate them. But can any symbol
9120 containing an ASCII value in the range 1-31 ever be anything
9121 other than some kind of local ? */
9138 _bfd_elf_get_lineno (bfd
*abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED
,
9139 asymbol
*symbol ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED
)
9146 _bfd_elf_set_arch_mach (bfd
*abfd
,
9147 enum bfd_architecture arch
,
9148 unsigned long machine
)
9150 /* If this isn't the right architecture for this backend, and this
9151 isn't the generic backend, fail. */
9152 if (arch
!= get_elf_backend_data (abfd
)->arch
9153 && arch
!= bfd_arch_unknown
9154 && get_elf_backend_data (abfd
)->arch
!= bfd_arch_unknown
)
9157 return bfd_default_set_arch_mach (abfd
, arch
, machine
);
9160 /* Find the nearest line to a particular section and offset,
9161 for error reporting. */
9164 _bfd_elf_find_nearest_line (bfd
*abfd
,
9168 const char **filename_ptr
,
9169 const char **functionname_ptr
,
9170 unsigned int *line_ptr
,
9171 unsigned int *discriminator_ptr
)
9175 if (_bfd_dwarf2_find_nearest_line (abfd
, symbols
, NULL
, section
, offset
,
9176 filename_ptr
, functionname_ptr
,
9177 line_ptr
, discriminator_ptr
,
9178 dwarf_debug_sections
,
9179 &elf_tdata (abfd
)->dwarf2_find_line_info
))
9182 if (_bfd_dwarf1_find_nearest_line (abfd
, symbols
, section
, offset
,
9183 filename_ptr
, functionname_ptr
, line_ptr
))
9185 if (!*functionname_ptr
)
9186 _bfd_elf_find_function (abfd
, symbols
, section
, offset
,
9187 *filename_ptr
? NULL
: filename_ptr
,
9192 if (! _bfd_stab_section_find_nearest_line (abfd
, symbols
, section
, offset
,
9193 &found
, filename_ptr
,
9194 functionname_ptr
, line_ptr
,
9195 &elf_tdata (abfd
)->line_info
))
9197 if (found
&& (*functionname_ptr
|| *line_ptr
))
9200 if (symbols
== NULL
)
9203 if (! _bfd_elf_find_function (abfd
, symbols
, section
, offset
,
9204 filename_ptr
, functionname_ptr
))
9211 /* Find the line for a symbol. */
9214 _bfd_elf_find_line (bfd
*abfd
, asymbol
**symbols
, asymbol
*symbol
,
9215 const char **filename_ptr
, unsigned int *line_ptr
)
9217 return _bfd_dwarf2_find_nearest_line (abfd
, symbols
, symbol
, NULL
, 0,
9218 filename_ptr
, NULL
, line_ptr
, NULL
,
9219 dwarf_debug_sections
,
9220 &elf_tdata (abfd
)->dwarf2_find_line_info
);
9223 /* After a call to bfd_find_nearest_line, successive calls to
9224 bfd_find_inliner_info can be used to get source information about
9225 each level of function inlining that terminated at the address
9226 passed to bfd_find_nearest_line. Currently this is only supported
9227 for DWARF2 with appropriate DWARF3 extensions. */
9230 _bfd_elf_find_inliner_info (bfd
*abfd
,
9231 const char **filename_ptr
,
9232 const char **functionname_ptr
,
9233 unsigned int *line_ptr
)
9236 found
= _bfd_dwarf2_find_inliner_info (abfd
, filename_ptr
,
9237 functionname_ptr
, line_ptr
,
9238 & elf_tdata (abfd
)->dwarf2_find_line_info
);
9243 _bfd_elf_sizeof_headers (bfd
*abfd
, struct bfd_link_info
*info
)
9245 const struct elf_backend_data
*bed
= get_elf_backend_data (abfd
);
9246 int ret
= bed
->s
->sizeof_ehdr
;
9248 if (!bfd_link_relocatable (info
))
9250 bfd_size_type phdr_size
= elf_program_header_size (abfd
);
9252 if (phdr_size
== (bfd_size_type
) -1)
9254 struct elf_segment_map
*m
;
9257 for (m
= elf_seg_map (abfd
); m
!= NULL
; m
= m
->next
)
9258 phdr_size
+= bed
->s
->sizeof_phdr
;
9261 phdr_size
= get_program_header_size (abfd
, info
);
9264 elf_program_header_size (abfd
) = phdr_size
;
9272 _bfd_elf_set_section_contents (bfd
*abfd
,
9274 const void *location
,
9276 bfd_size_type count
)
9278 Elf_Internal_Shdr
*hdr
;
9281 if (! abfd
->output_has_begun
9282 && ! _bfd_elf_compute_section_file_positions (abfd
, NULL
))
9288 hdr
= &elf_section_data (section
)->this_hdr
;
9289 if (hdr
->sh_offset
== (file_ptr
) -1)
9291 unsigned char *contents
;
9293 if (bfd_section_is_ctf (section
))
9294 /* Nothing to do with this section: the contents are generated
9298 if ((section
->flags
& SEC_ELF_COMPRESS
) == 0)
9301 (_("%pB:%pA: error: attempting to write into an unallocated compressed section"),
9303 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_invalid_operation
);
9307 if ((offset
+ count
) > hdr
->sh_size
)
9310 (_("%pB:%pA: error: attempting to write over the end of the section"),
9313 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_invalid_operation
);
9317 contents
= hdr
->contents
;
9318 if (contents
== NULL
)
9321 (_("%pB:%pA: error: attempting to write section into an empty buffer"),
9324 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_invalid_operation
);
9328 memcpy (contents
+ offset
, location
, count
);
9332 pos
= hdr
->sh_offset
+ offset
;
9333 if (bfd_seek (abfd
, pos
, SEEK_SET
) != 0
9334 || bfd_bwrite (location
, count
, abfd
) != count
)
9341 _bfd_elf_no_info_to_howto (bfd
*abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED
,
9342 arelent
*cache_ptr ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED
,
9343 Elf_Internal_Rela
*dst ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED
)
9349 /* Try to convert a non-ELF reloc into an ELF one. */
9352 _bfd_elf_validate_reloc (bfd
*abfd
, arelent
*areloc
)
9354 /* Check whether we really have an ELF howto. */
9356 if ((*areloc
->sym_ptr_ptr
)->the_bfd
->xvec
!= abfd
->xvec
)
9358 bfd_reloc_code_real_type code
;
9359 reloc_howto_type
*howto
;
9361 /* Alien reloc: Try to determine its type to replace it with an
9362 equivalent ELF reloc. */
9364 if (areloc
->howto
->pc_relative
)
9366 switch (areloc
->howto
->bitsize
)
9369 code
= BFD_RELOC_8_PCREL
;
9372 code
= BFD_RELOC_12_PCREL
;
9375 code
= BFD_RELOC_16_PCREL
;
9378 code
= BFD_RELOC_24_PCREL
;
9381 code
= BFD_RELOC_32_PCREL
;
9384 code
= BFD_RELOC_64_PCREL
;
9390 howto
= bfd_reloc_type_lookup (abfd
, code
);
9392 if (howto
&& areloc
->howto
->pcrel_offset
!= howto
->pcrel_offset
)
9394 if (howto
->pcrel_offset
)
9395 areloc
->addend
+= areloc
->address
;
9397 areloc
->addend
-= areloc
->address
; /* addend is unsigned!! */
9402 switch (areloc
->howto
->bitsize
)
9408 code
= BFD_RELOC_14
;
9411 code
= BFD_RELOC_16
;
9414 code
= BFD_RELOC_26
;
9417 code
= BFD_RELOC_32
;
9420 code
= BFD_RELOC_64
;
9426 howto
= bfd_reloc_type_lookup (abfd
, code
);
9430 areloc
->howto
= howto
;
9438 /* xgettext:c-format */
9439 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: %s unsupported"),
9440 abfd
, areloc
->howto
->name
);
9441 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_sorry
);
9446 _bfd_elf_close_and_cleanup (bfd
*abfd
)
9448 struct elf_obj_tdata
*tdata
= elf_tdata (abfd
);
9450 && (bfd_get_format (abfd
) == bfd_object
9451 || bfd_get_format (abfd
) == bfd_core
))
9453 if (elf_tdata (abfd
)->o
!= NULL
&& elf_shstrtab (abfd
) != NULL
)
9454 _bfd_elf_strtab_free (elf_shstrtab (abfd
));
9455 _bfd_dwarf2_cleanup_debug_info (abfd
, &tdata
->dwarf2_find_line_info
);
9458 return _bfd_generic_close_and_cleanup (abfd
);
9461 /* For Rel targets, we encode meaningful data for BFD_RELOC_VTABLE_ENTRY
9462 in the relocation's offset. Thus we cannot allow any sort of sanity
9463 range-checking to interfere. There is nothing else to do in processing
9466 bfd_reloc_status_type
9467 _bfd_elf_rel_vtable_reloc_fn
9468 (bfd
*abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED
, arelent
*re ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED
,
9469 struct bfd_symbol
*symbol ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED
,
9470 void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED
, asection
*is ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED
,
9471 bfd
*obfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED
, char **errmsg ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED
)
9473 return bfd_reloc_ok
;
9476 /* Elf core file support. Much of this only works on native
9477 toolchains, since we rely on knowing the
9478 machine-dependent procfs structure in order to pick
9479 out details about the corefile. */
9481 #ifdef HAVE_SYS_PROCFS_H
9482 # include <sys/procfs.h>
9485 /* Return a PID that identifies a "thread" for threaded cores, or the
9486 PID of the main process for non-threaded cores. */
9489 elfcore_make_pid (bfd
*abfd
)
9493 pid
= elf_tdata (abfd
)->core
->lwpid
;
9495 pid
= elf_tdata (abfd
)->core
->pid
;
9500 /* If there isn't a section called NAME, make one, using
9501 data from SECT. Note, this function will generate a
9502 reference to NAME, so you shouldn't deallocate or
9506 elfcore_maybe_make_sect (bfd
*abfd
, char *name
, asection
*sect
)
9510 if (bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd
, name
) != NULL
)
9513 sect2
= bfd_make_section_with_flags (abfd
, name
, sect
->flags
);
9517 sect2
->size
= sect
->size
;
9518 sect2
->filepos
= sect
->filepos
;
9519 sect2
->alignment_power
= sect
->alignment_power
;
9523 /* Create a pseudosection containing SIZE bytes at FILEPOS. This
9524 actually creates up to two pseudosections:
9525 - For the single-threaded case, a section named NAME, unless
9526 such a section already exists.
9527 - For the multi-threaded case, a section named "NAME/PID", where
9528 PID is elfcore_make_pid (abfd).
9529 Both pseudosections have identical contents. */
9531 _bfd_elfcore_make_pseudosection (bfd
*abfd
,
9537 char *threaded_name
;
9541 /* Build the section name. */
9543 sprintf (buf
, "%s/%d", name
, elfcore_make_pid (abfd
));
9544 len
= strlen (buf
) + 1;
9545 threaded_name
= (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd
, len
);
9546 if (threaded_name
== NULL
)
9548 memcpy (threaded_name
, buf
, len
);
9550 sect
= bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd
, threaded_name
,
9555 sect
->filepos
= filepos
;
9556 sect
->alignment_power
= 2;
9558 return elfcore_maybe_make_sect (abfd
, name
, sect
);
9562 elfcore_make_auxv_note_section (bfd
*abfd
, Elf_Internal_Note
*note
,
9565 asection
*sect
= bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd
, ".auxv",
9571 sect
->size
= note
->descsz
- offs
;
9572 sect
->filepos
= note
->descpos
+ offs
;
9573 sect
->alignment_power
= 1 + bfd_get_arch_size (abfd
) / 32;
9578 /* prstatus_t exists on:
9580 linux 2.[01] + glibc
9584 #if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS_T)
9587 elfcore_grok_prstatus (bfd
*abfd
, Elf_Internal_Note
*note
)
9592 if (note
->descsz
== sizeof (prstatus_t
))
9596 size
= sizeof (prstat
.pr_reg
);
9597 offset
= offsetof (prstatus_t
, pr_reg
);
9598 memcpy (&prstat
, note
->descdata
, sizeof (prstat
));
9600 /* Do not overwrite the core signal if it
9601 has already been set by another thread. */
9602 if (elf_tdata (abfd
)->core
->signal
== 0)
9603 elf_tdata (abfd
)->core
->signal
= prstat
.pr_cursig
;
9604 if (elf_tdata (abfd
)->core
->pid
== 0)
9605 elf_tdata (abfd
)->core
->pid
= prstat
.pr_pid
;
9607 /* pr_who exists on:
9610 pr_who doesn't exist on:
9613 #if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS_T_PR_WHO)
9614 elf_tdata (abfd
)->core
->lwpid
= prstat
.pr_who
;
9616 elf_tdata (abfd
)->core
->lwpid
= prstat
.pr_pid
;
9619 #if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS32_T)
9620 else if (note
->descsz
== sizeof (prstatus32_t
))
9622 /* 64-bit host, 32-bit corefile */
9623 prstatus32_t prstat
;
9625 size
= sizeof (prstat
.pr_reg
);
9626 offset
= offsetof (prstatus32_t
, pr_reg
);
9627 memcpy (&prstat
, note
->descdata
, sizeof (prstat
));
9629 /* Do not overwrite the core signal if it
9630 has already been set by another thread. */
9631 if (elf_tdata (abfd
)->core
->signal
== 0)
9632 elf_tdata (abfd
)->core
->signal
= prstat
.pr_cursig
;
9633 if (elf_tdata (abfd
)->core
->pid
== 0)
9634 elf_tdata (abfd
)->core
->pid
= prstat
.pr_pid
;
9636 /* pr_who exists on:
9639 pr_who doesn't exist on:
9642 #if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS32_T_PR_WHO)
9643 elf_tdata (abfd
)->core
->lwpid
= prstat
.pr_who
;
9645 elf_tdata (abfd
)->core
->lwpid
= prstat
.pr_pid
;
9648 #endif /* HAVE_PRSTATUS32_T */
9651 /* Fail - we don't know how to handle any other
9652 note size (ie. data object type). */
9656 /* Make a ".reg/999" section and a ".reg" section. */
9657 return _bfd_elfcore_make_pseudosection (abfd
, ".reg",
9658 size
, note
->descpos
+ offset
);
9660 #endif /* defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS_T) */
9662 /* Create a pseudosection containing the exact contents of NOTE. */
9664 elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (bfd
*abfd
,
9666 Elf_Internal_Note
*note
)
9668 return _bfd_elfcore_make_pseudosection (abfd
, name
,
9669 note
->descsz
, note
->descpos
);
9672 /* There isn't a consistent prfpregset_t across platforms,
9673 but it doesn't matter, because we don't have to pick this
9674 data structure apart. */
9677 elfcore_grok_prfpreg (bfd
*abfd
, Elf_Internal_Note
*note
)
9679 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd
, ".reg2", note
);
9682 /* Linux dumps the Intel SSE regs in a note named "LINUX" with a note
9683 type of NT_PRXFPREG. Just include the whole note's contents
9687 elfcore_grok_prxfpreg (bfd
*abfd
, Elf_Internal_Note
*note
)
9689 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd
, ".reg-xfp", note
);
9692 /* Linux dumps the Intel XSAVE extended state in a note named "LINUX"
9693 with a note type of NT_X86_XSTATE. Just include the whole note's
9694 contents literally. */
9697 elfcore_grok_xstatereg (bfd
*abfd
, Elf_Internal_Note
*note
)
9699 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd
, ".reg-xstate", note
);
9703 elfcore_grok_ppc_vmx (bfd
*abfd
, Elf_Internal_Note
*note
)
9705 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd
, ".reg-ppc-vmx", note
);
9709 elfcore_grok_ppc_vsx (bfd
*abfd
, Elf_Internal_Note
*note
)
9711 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd
, ".reg-ppc-vsx", note
);
9715 elfcore_grok_ppc_tar (bfd
*abfd
, Elf_Internal_Note
*note
)
9717 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd
, ".reg-ppc-tar", note
);
9721 elfcore_grok_ppc_ppr (bfd
*abfd
, Elf_Internal_Note
*note
)
9723 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd
, ".reg-ppc-ppr", note
);
9727 elfcore_grok_ppc_dscr (bfd
*abfd
, Elf_Internal_Note
*note
)
9729 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd
, ".reg-ppc-dscr", note
);
9733 elfcore_grok_ppc_ebb (bfd
*abfd
, Elf_Internal_Note
*note
)
9735 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd
, ".reg-ppc-ebb", note
);
9739 elfcore_grok_ppc_pmu (bfd
*abfd
, Elf_Internal_Note
*note
)
9741 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd
, ".reg-ppc-pmu", note
);
9745 elfcore_grok_ppc_tm_cgpr (bfd
*abfd
, Elf_Internal_Note
*note
)
9747 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd
, ".reg-ppc-tm-cgpr", note
);
9751 elfcore_grok_ppc_tm_cfpr (bfd
*abfd
, Elf_Internal_Note
*note
)
9753 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd
, ".reg-ppc-tm-cfpr", note
);
9757 elfcore_grok_ppc_tm_cvmx (bfd
*abfd
, Elf_Internal_Note
*note
)
9759 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd
, ".reg-ppc-tm-cvmx", note
);
9763 elfcore_grok_ppc_tm_cvsx (bfd
*abfd
, Elf_Internal_Note
*note
)
9765 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd
, ".reg-ppc-tm-cvsx", note
);
9769 elfcore_grok_ppc_tm_spr (bfd
*abfd
, Elf_Internal_Note
*note
)
9771 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd
, ".reg-ppc-tm-spr", note
);
9775 elfcore_grok_ppc_tm_ctar (bfd
*abfd
, Elf_Internal_Note
*note
)
9777 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd
, ".reg-ppc-tm-ctar", note
);
9781 elfcore_grok_ppc_tm_cppr (bfd
*abfd
, Elf_Internal_Note
*note
)
9783 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd
, ".reg-ppc-tm-cppr", note
);
9787 elfcore_grok_ppc_tm_cdscr (bfd
*abfd
, Elf_Internal_Note
*note
)
9789 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd
, ".reg-ppc-tm-cdscr", note
);
9793 elfcore_grok_s390_high_gprs (bfd
*abfd
, Elf_Internal_Note
*note
)
9795 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd
, ".reg-s390-high-gprs", note
);
9799 elfcore_grok_s390_timer (bfd
*abfd
, Elf_Internal_Note
*note
)
9801 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd
, ".reg-s390-timer", note
);
9805 elfcore_grok_s390_todcmp (bfd
*abfd
, Elf_Internal_Note
*note
)
9807 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd
, ".reg-s390-todcmp", note
);
9811 elfcore_grok_s390_todpreg (bfd
*abfd
, Elf_Internal_Note
*note
)
9813 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd
, ".reg-s390-todpreg", note
);
9817 elfcore_grok_s390_ctrs (bfd
*abfd
, Elf_Internal_Note
*note
)
9819 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd
, ".reg-s390-ctrs", note
);
9823 elfcore_grok_s390_prefix (bfd
*abfd
, Elf_Internal_Note
*note
)
9825 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd
, ".reg-s390-prefix", note
);
9829 elfcore_grok_s390_last_break (bfd
*abfd
, Elf_Internal_Note
*note
)
9831 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd
, ".reg-s390-last-break", note
);
9835 elfcore_grok_s390_system_call (bfd
*abfd
, Elf_Internal_Note
*note
)
9837 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd
, ".reg-s390-system-call", note
);
9841 elfcore_grok_s390_tdb (bfd
*abfd
, Elf_Internal_Note
*note
)
9843 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd
, ".reg-s390-tdb", note
);
9847 elfcore_grok_s390_vxrs_low (bfd
*abfd
, Elf_Internal_Note
*note
)
9849 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd
, ".reg-s390-vxrs-low", note
);
9853 elfcore_grok_s390_vxrs_high (bfd
*abfd
, Elf_Internal_Note
*note
)
9855 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd
, ".reg-s390-vxrs-high", note
);
9859 elfcore_grok_s390_gs_cb (bfd
*abfd
, Elf_Internal_Note
*note
)
9861 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd
, ".reg-s390-gs-cb", note
);
9865 elfcore_grok_s390_gs_bc (bfd
*abfd
, Elf_Internal_Note
*note
)
9867 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd
, ".reg-s390-gs-bc", note
);
9871 elfcore_grok_arm_vfp (bfd
*abfd
, Elf_Internal_Note
*note
)
9873 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd
, ".reg-arm-vfp", note
);
9877 elfcore_grok_aarch_tls (bfd
*abfd
, Elf_Internal_Note
*note
)
9879 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd
, ".reg-aarch-tls", note
);
9883 elfcore_grok_aarch_hw_break (bfd
*abfd
, Elf_Internal_Note
*note
)
9885 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd
, ".reg-aarch-hw-break", note
);
9889 elfcore_grok_aarch_hw_watch (bfd
*abfd
, Elf_Internal_Note
*note
)
9891 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd
, ".reg-aarch-hw-watch", note
);
9895 elfcore_grok_aarch_sve (bfd
*abfd
, Elf_Internal_Note
*note
)
9897 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd
, ".reg-aarch-sve", note
);
9901 elfcore_grok_aarch_pauth (bfd
*abfd
, Elf_Internal_Note
*note
)
9903 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd
, ".reg-aarch-pauth", note
);
9907 elfcore_grok_arc_v2 (bfd
*abfd
, Elf_Internal_Note
*note
)
9909 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd
, ".reg-arc-v2", note
);
9912 #if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO_T)
9913 typedef prpsinfo_t elfcore_psinfo_t
;
9914 #if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO32_T) /* Sparc64 cross Sparc32 */
9915 typedef prpsinfo32_t elfcore_psinfo32_t
;
9919 #if defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T)
9920 typedef psinfo_t elfcore_psinfo_t
;
9921 #if defined (HAVE_PSINFO32_T) /* Sparc64 cross Sparc32 */
9922 typedef psinfo32_t elfcore_psinfo32_t
;
9926 /* return a malloc'ed copy of a string at START which is at
9927 most MAX bytes long, possibly without a terminating '\0'.
9928 the copy will always have a terminating '\0'. */
9931 _bfd_elfcore_strndup (bfd
*abfd
, char *start
, size_t max
)
9934 char *end
= (char *) memchr (start
, '\0', max
);
9942 dups
= (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd
, len
+ 1);
9946 memcpy (dups
, start
, len
);
9952 #if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO_T) || defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T)
9954 elfcore_grok_psinfo (bfd
*abfd
, Elf_Internal_Note
*note
)
9956 if (note
->descsz
== sizeof (elfcore_psinfo_t
))
9958 elfcore_psinfo_t psinfo
;
9960 memcpy (&psinfo
, note
->descdata
, sizeof (psinfo
));
9962 #if defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T_PR_PID) || defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO_T_PR_PID)
9963 elf_tdata (abfd
)->core
->pid
= psinfo
.pr_pid
;
9965 elf_tdata (abfd
)->core
->program
9966 = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd
, psinfo
.pr_fname
,
9967 sizeof (psinfo
.pr_fname
));
9969 elf_tdata (abfd
)->core
->command
9970 = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd
, psinfo
.pr_psargs
,
9971 sizeof (psinfo
.pr_psargs
));
9973 #if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO32_T) || defined (HAVE_PSINFO32_T)
9974 else if (note
->descsz
== sizeof (elfcore_psinfo32_t
))
9976 /* 64-bit host, 32-bit corefile */
9977 elfcore_psinfo32_t psinfo
;
9979 memcpy (&psinfo
, note
->descdata
, sizeof (psinfo
));
9981 #if defined (HAVE_PSINFO32_T_PR_PID) || defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO32_T_PR_PID)
9982 elf_tdata (abfd
)->core
->pid
= psinfo
.pr_pid
;
9984 elf_tdata (abfd
)->core
->program
9985 = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd
, psinfo
.pr_fname
,
9986 sizeof (psinfo
.pr_fname
));
9988 elf_tdata (abfd
)->core
->command
9989 = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd
, psinfo
.pr_psargs
,
9990 sizeof (psinfo
.pr_psargs
));
9996 /* Fail - we don't know how to handle any other
9997 note size (ie. data object type). */
10001 /* Note that for some reason, a spurious space is tacked
10002 onto the end of the args in some (at least one anyway)
10003 implementations, so strip it off if it exists. */
10006 char *command
= elf_tdata (abfd
)->core
->command
;
10007 int n
= strlen (command
);
10009 if (0 < n
&& command
[n
- 1] == ' ')
10010 command
[n
- 1] = '\0';
10015 #endif /* defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO_T) || defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T) */
10017 #if defined (HAVE_PSTATUS_T)
10019 elfcore_grok_pstatus (bfd
*abfd
, Elf_Internal_Note
*note
)
10021 if (note
->descsz
== sizeof (pstatus_t
)
10022 #if defined (HAVE_PXSTATUS_T)
10023 || note
->descsz
== sizeof (pxstatus_t
)
10029 memcpy (&pstat
, note
->descdata
, sizeof (pstat
));
10031 elf_tdata (abfd
)->core
->pid
= pstat
.pr_pid
;
10033 #if defined (HAVE_PSTATUS32_T)
10034 else if (note
->descsz
== sizeof (pstatus32_t
))
10036 /* 64-bit host, 32-bit corefile */
10039 memcpy (&pstat
, note
->descdata
, sizeof (pstat
));
10041 elf_tdata (abfd
)->core
->pid
= pstat
.pr_pid
;
10044 /* Could grab some more details from the "representative"
10045 lwpstatus_t in pstat.pr_lwp, but we'll catch it all in an
10046 NT_LWPSTATUS note, presumably. */
10050 #endif /* defined (HAVE_PSTATUS_T) */
10052 #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T)
10054 elfcore_grok_lwpstatus (bfd
*abfd
, Elf_Internal_Note
*note
)
10056 lwpstatus_t lwpstat
;
10062 if (note
->descsz
!= sizeof (lwpstat
)
10063 #if defined (HAVE_LWPXSTATUS_T)
10064 && note
->descsz
!= sizeof (lwpxstatus_t
)
10069 memcpy (&lwpstat
, note
->descdata
, sizeof (lwpstat
));
10071 elf_tdata (abfd
)->core
->lwpid
= lwpstat
.pr_lwpid
;
10072 /* Do not overwrite the core signal if it has already been set by
10074 if (elf_tdata (abfd
)->core
->signal
== 0)
10075 elf_tdata (abfd
)->core
->signal
= lwpstat
.pr_cursig
;
10077 /* Make a ".reg/999" section. */
10079 sprintf (buf
, ".reg/%d", elfcore_make_pid (abfd
));
10080 len
= strlen (buf
) + 1;
10081 name
= bfd_alloc (abfd
, len
);
10084 memcpy (name
, buf
, len
);
10086 sect
= bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd
, name
, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
);
10090 #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T_PR_CONTEXT)
10091 sect
->size
= sizeof (lwpstat
.pr_context
.uc_mcontext
.gregs
);
10092 sect
->filepos
= note
->descpos
10093 + offsetof (lwpstatus_t
, pr_context
.uc_mcontext
.gregs
);
10096 #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T_PR_REG)
10097 sect
->size
= sizeof (lwpstat
.pr_reg
);
10098 sect
->filepos
= note
->descpos
+ offsetof (lwpstatus_t
, pr_reg
);
10101 sect
->alignment_power
= 2;
10103 if (!elfcore_maybe_make_sect (abfd
, ".reg", sect
))
10106 /* Make a ".reg2/999" section */
10108 sprintf (buf
, ".reg2/%d", elfcore_make_pid (abfd
));
10109 len
= strlen (buf
) + 1;
10110 name
= bfd_alloc (abfd
, len
);
10113 memcpy (name
, buf
, len
);
10115 sect
= bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd
, name
, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
);
10119 #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T_PR_CONTEXT)
10120 sect
->size
= sizeof (lwpstat
.pr_context
.uc_mcontext
.fpregs
);
10121 sect
->filepos
= note
->descpos
10122 + offsetof (lwpstatus_t
, pr_context
.uc_mcontext
.fpregs
);
10125 #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T_PR_FPREG)
10126 sect
->size
= sizeof (lwpstat
.pr_fpreg
);
10127 sect
->filepos
= note
->descpos
+ offsetof (lwpstatus_t
, pr_fpreg
);
10130 sect
->alignment_power
= 2;
10132 return elfcore_maybe_make_sect (abfd
, ".reg2", sect
);
10134 #endif /* defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T) */
10136 /* These constants, and the structure offsets used below, are defined by
10137 Cygwin's core_dump.h */
10138 #define NOTE_INFO_PROCESS 1
10139 #define NOTE_INFO_THREAD 2
10140 #define NOTE_INFO_MODULE 3
10141 #define NOTE_INFO_MODULE64 4
10144 elfcore_grok_win32pstatus (bfd
*abfd
, Elf_Internal_Note
*note
)
10149 unsigned int name_size
;
10152 int is_active_thread
;
10155 if (note
->descsz
< 4)
10158 if (! CONST_STRNEQ (note
->namedata
, "win32"))
10161 type
= bfd_get_32 (abfd
, note
->descdata
);
10164 const char *type_name
;
10165 unsigned long min_size
;
10168 { "NOTE_INFO_PROCESS", 12 },
10169 { "NOTE_INFO_THREAD", 12 },
10170 { "NOTE_INFO_MODULE", 12 },
10171 { "NOTE_INFO_MODULE64", 16 },
10174 if (type
> (sizeof(size_check
)/sizeof(size_check
[0])))
10177 if (note
->descsz
< size_check
[type
- 1].min_size
)
10179 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: warning: win32pstatus %s of size %lu bytes is too small"),
10180 abfd
, size_check
[type
- 1].type_name
, note
->descsz
);
10186 case NOTE_INFO_PROCESS
:
10187 /* FIXME: need to add ->core->command. */
10188 elf_tdata (abfd
)->core
->pid
= bfd_get_32 (abfd
, note
->descdata
+ 4);
10189 elf_tdata (abfd
)->core
->signal
= bfd_get_32 (abfd
, note
->descdata
+ 8);
10192 case NOTE_INFO_THREAD
:
10193 /* Make a ".reg/<tid>" section containing the Win32 API thread CONTEXT
10195 /* thread_info.tid */
10196 sprintf (buf
, ".reg/%ld", (long) bfd_get_32 (abfd
, note
->descdata
+ 4));
10198 len
= strlen (buf
) + 1;
10199 name
= (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd
, len
);
10203 memcpy (name
, buf
, len
);
10205 sect
= bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd
, name
, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
);
10209 /* sizeof (thread_info.thread_context) */
10210 sect
->size
= note
->descsz
- 12;
10211 /* offsetof (thread_info.thread_context) */
10212 sect
->filepos
= note
->descpos
+ 12;
10213 sect
->alignment_power
= 2;
10215 /* thread_info.is_active_thread */
10216 is_active_thread
= bfd_get_32 (abfd
, note
->descdata
+ 8);
10218 if (is_active_thread
)
10219 if (! elfcore_maybe_make_sect (abfd
, ".reg", sect
))
10223 case NOTE_INFO_MODULE
:
10224 case NOTE_INFO_MODULE64
:
10225 /* Make a ".module/xxxxxxxx" section. */
10226 if (type
== NOTE_INFO_MODULE
)
10228 /* module_info.base_address */
10229 base_addr
= bfd_get_32 (abfd
, note
->descdata
+ 4);
10230 sprintf (buf
, ".module/%08lx", (unsigned long) base_addr
);
10231 /* module_info.module_name_size */
10232 name_size
= bfd_get_32 (abfd
, note
->descdata
+ 8);
10234 else /* NOTE_INFO_MODULE64 */
10236 /* module_info.base_address */
10237 base_addr
= bfd_get_64 (abfd
, note
->descdata
+ 4);
10238 sprintf (buf
, ".module/%016lx", (unsigned long) base_addr
);
10239 /* module_info.module_name_size */
10240 name_size
= bfd_get_32 (abfd
, note
->descdata
+ 12);
10243 len
= strlen (buf
) + 1;
10244 name
= (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd
, len
);
10248 memcpy (name
, buf
, len
);
10250 sect
= bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd
, name
, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
);
10255 if (note
->descsz
< 12 + name_size
)
10257 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: win32pstatus NOTE_INFO_MODULE of size %lu is too small to contain a name of size %u"),
10258 abfd
, note
->descsz
, name_size
);
10262 sect
->size
= note
->descsz
;
10263 sect
->filepos
= note
->descpos
;
10264 sect
->alignment_power
= 2;
10275 elfcore_grok_note (bfd
*abfd
, Elf_Internal_Note
*note
)
10277 const struct elf_backend_data
*bed
= get_elf_backend_data (abfd
);
10279 switch (note
->type
)
10285 if (bed
->elf_backend_grok_prstatus
)
10286 if ((*bed
->elf_backend_grok_prstatus
) (abfd
, note
))
10288 #if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS_T)
10289 return elfcore_grok_prstatus (abfd
, note
);
10294 #if defined (HAVE_PSTATUS_T)
10296 return elfcore_grok_pstatus (abfd
, note
);
10299 #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T)
10301 return elfcore_grok_lwpstatus (abfd
, note
);
10304 case NT_FPREGSET
: /* FIXME: rename to NT_PRFPREG */
10305 return elfcore_grok_prfpreg (abfd
, note
);
10307 case NT_WIN32PSTATUS
:
10308 return elfcore_grok_win32pstatus (abfd
, note
);
10310 case NT_PRXFPREG
: /* Linux SSE extension */
10311 if (note
->namesz
== 6
10312 && strcmp (note
->namedata
, "LINUX") == 0)
10313 return elfcore_grok_prxfpreg (abfd
, note
);
10317 case NT_X86_XSTATE
: /* Linux XSAVE extension */
10318 if (note
->namesz
== 6
10319 && strcmp (note
->namedata
, "LINUX") == 0)
10320 return elfcore_grok_xstatereg (abfd
, note
);
10325 if (note
->namesz
== 6
10326 && strcmp (note
->namedata
, "LINUX") == 0)
10327 return elfcore_grok_ppc_vmx (abfd
, note
);
10332 if (note
->namesz
== 6
10333 && strcmp (note
->namedata
, "LINUX") == 0)
10334 return elfcore_grok_ppc_vsx (abfd
, note
);
10339 if (note
->namesz
== 6
10340 && strcmp (note
->namedata
, "LINUX") == 0)
10341 return elfcore_grok_ppc_tar (abfd
, note
);
10346 if (note
->namesz
== 6
10347 && strcmp (note
->namedata
, "LINUX") == 0)
10348 return elfcore_grok_ppc_ppr (abfd
, note
);
10353 if (note
->namesz
== 6
10354 && strcmp (note
->namedata
, "LINUX") == 0)
10355 return elfcore_grok_ppc_dscr (abfd
, note
);
10360 if (note
->namesz
== 6
10361 && strcmp (note
->namedata
, "LINUX") == 0)
10362 return elfcore_grok_ppc_ebb (abfd
, note
);
10367 if (note
->namesz
== 6
10368 && strcmp (note
->namedata
, "LINUX") == 0)
10369 return elfcore_grok_ppc_pmu (abfd
, note
);
10373 case NT_PPC_TM_CGPR
:
10374 if (note
->namesz
== 6
10375 && strcmp (note
->namedata
, "LINUX") == 0)
10376 return elfcore_grok_ppc_tm_cgpr (abfd
, note
);
10380 case NT_PPC_TM_CFPR
:
10381 if (note
->namesz
== 6
10382 && strcmp (note
->namedata
, "LINUX") == 0)
10383 return elfcore_grok_ppc_tm_cfpr (abfd
, note
);
10387 case NT_PPC_TM_CVMX
:
10388 if (note
->namesz
== 6
10389 && strcmp (note
->namedata
, "LINUX") == 0)
10390 return elfcore_grok_ppc_tm_cvmx (abfd
, note
);
10394 case NT_PPC_TM_CVSX
:
10395 if (note
->namesz
== 6
10396 && strcmp (note
->namedata
, "LINUX") == 0)
10397 return elfcore_grok_ppc_tm_cvsx (abfd
, note
);
10401 case NT_PPC_TM_SPR
:
10402 if (note
->namesz
== 6
10403 && strcmp (note
->namedata
, "LINUX") == 0)
10404 return elfcore_grok_ppc_tm_spr (abfd
, note
);
10408 case NT_PPC_TM_CTAR
:
10409 if (note
->namesz
== 6
10410 && strcmp (note
->namedata
, "LINUX") == 0)
10411 return elfcore_grok_ppc_tm_ctar (abfd
, note
);
10415 case NT_PPC_TM_CPPR
:
10416 if (note
->namesz
== 6
10417 && strcmp (note
->namedata
, "LINUX") == 0)
10418 return elfcore_grok_ppc_tm_cppr (abfd
, note
);
10422 case NT_PPC_TM_CDSCR
:
10423 if (note
->namesz
== 6
10424 && strcmp (note
->namedata
, "LINUX") == 0)
10425 return elfcore_grok_ppc_tm_cdscr (abfd
, note
);
10429 case NT_S390_HIGH_GPRS
:
10430 if (note
->namesz
== 6
10431 && strcmp (note
->namedata
, "LINUX") == 0)
10432 return elfcore_grok_s390_high_gprs (abfd
, note
);
10436 case NT_S390_TIMER
:
10437 if (note
->namesz
== 6
10438 && strcmp (note
->namedata
, "LINUX") == 0)
10439 return elfcore_grok_s390_timer (abfd
, note
);
10443 case NT_S390_TODCMP
:
10444 if (note
->namesz
== 6
10445 && strcmp (note
->namedata
, "LINUX") == 0)
10446 return elfcore_grok_s390_todcmp (abfd
, note
);
10450 case NT_S390_TODPREG
:
10451 if (note
->namesz
== 6
10452 && strcmp (note
->namedata
, "LINUX") == 0)
10453 return elfcore_grok_s390_todpreg (abfd
, note
);
10458 if (note
->namesz
== 6
10459 && strcmp (note
->namedata
, "LINUX") == 0)
10460 return elfcore_grok_s390_ctrs (abfd
, note
);
10464 case NT_S390_PREFIX
:
10465 if (note
->namesz
== 6
10466 && strcmp (note
->namedata
, "LINUX") == 0)
10467 return elfcore_grok_s390_prefix (abfd
, note
);
10471 case NT_S390_LAST_BREAK
:
10472 if (note
->namesz
== 6
10473 && strcmp (note
->namedata
, "LINUX") == 0)
10474 return elfcore_grok_s390_last_break (abfd
, note
);
10478 case NT_S390_SYSTEM_CALL
:
10479 if (note
->namesz
== 6
10480 && strcmp (note
->namedata
, "LINUX") == 0)
10481 return elfcore_grok_s390_system_call (abfd
, note
);
10486 if (note
->namesz
== 6
10487 && strcmp (note
->namedata
, "LINUX") == 0)
10488 return elfcore_grok_s390_tdb (abfd
, note
);
10492 case NT_S390_VXRS_LOW
:
10493 if (note
->namesz
== 6
10494 && strcmp (note
->namedata
, "LINUX") == 0)
10495 return elfcore_grok_s390_vxrs_low (abfd
, note
);
10499 case NT_S390_VXRS_HIGH
:
10500 if (note
->namesz
== 6
10501 && strcmp (note
->namedata
, "LINUX") == 0)
10502 return elfcore_grok_s390_vxrs_high (abfd
, note
);
10506 case NT_S390_GS_CB
:
10507 if (note
->namesz
== 6
10508 && strcmp (note
->namedata
, "LINUX") == 0)
10509 return elfcore_grok_s390_gs_cb (abfd
, note
);
10513 case NT_S390_GS_BC
:
10514 if (note
->namesz
== 6
10515 && strcmp (note
->namedata
, "LINUX") == 0)
10516 return elfcore_grok_s390_gs_bc (abfd
, note
);
10521 if (note
->namesz
== 6
10522 && strcmp (note
->namedata
, "LINUX") == 0)
10523 return elfcore_grok_arc_v2 (abfd
, note
);
10528 if (note
->namesz
== 6
10529 && strcmp (note
->namedata
, "LINUX") == 0)
10530 return elfcore_grok_arm_vfp (abfd
, note
);
10535 if (note
->namesz
== 6
10536 && strcmp (note
->namedata
, "LINUX") == 0)
10537 return elfcore_grok_aarch_tls (abfd
, note
);
10541 case NT_ARM_HW_BREAK
:
10542 if (note
->namesz
== 6
10543 && strcmp (note
->namedata
, "LINUX") == 0)
10544 return elfcore_grok_aarch_hw_break (abfd
, note
);
10548 case NT_ARM_HW_WATCH
:
10549 if (note
->namesz
== 6
10550 && strcmp (note
->namedata
, "LINUX") == 0)
10551 return elfcore_grok_aarch_hw_watch (abfd
, note
);
10556 if (note
->namesz
== 6
10557 && strcmp (note
->namedata
, "LINUX") == 0)
10558 return elfcore_grok_aarch_sve (abfd
, note
);
10562 case NT_ARM_PAC_MASK
:
10563 if (note
->namesz
== 6
10564 && strcmp (note
->namedata
, "LINUX") == 0)
10565 return elfcore_grok_aarch_pauth (abfd
, note
);
10571 if (bed
->elf_backend_grok_psinfo
)
10572 if ((*bed
->elf_backend_grok_psinfo
) (abfd
, note
))
10574 #if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO_T) || defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T)
10575 return elfcore_grok_psinfo (abfd
, note
);
10581 return elfcore_make_auxv_note_section (abfd
, note
, 0);
10584 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd
, ".note.linuxcore.file",
10588 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd
, ".note.linuxcore.siginfo",
10595 elfobj_grok_gnu_build_id (bfd
*abfd
, Elf_Internal_Note
*note
)
10597 struct bfd_build_id
* build_id
;
10599 if (note
->descsz
== 0)
10602 build_id
= bfd_alloc (abfd
, sizeof (struct bfd_build_id
) - 1 + note
->descsz
);
10603 if (build_id
== NULL
)
10606 build_id
->size
= note
->descsz
;
10607 memcpy (build_id
->data
, note
->descdata
, note
->descsz
);
10608 abfd
->build_id
= build_id
;
10614 elfobj_grok_gnu_note (bfd
*abfd
, Elf_Internal_Note
*note
)
10616 switch (note
->type
)
10621 case NT_GNU_PROPERTY_TYPE_0
:
10622 return _bfd_elf_parse_gnu_properties (abfd
, note
);
10624 case NT_GNU_BUILD_ID
:
10625 return elfobj_grok_gnu_build_id (abfd
, note
);
10630 elfobj_grok_stapsdt_note_1 (bfd
*abfd
, Elf_Internal_Note
*note
)
10632 struct sdt_note
*cur
=
10633 (struct sdt_note
*) bfd_alloc (abfd
,
10634 sizeof (struct sdt_note
) + note
->descsz
);
10636 cur
->next
= (struct sdt_note
*) (elf_tdata (abfd
))->sdt_note_head
;
10637 cur
->size
= (bfd_size_type
) note
->descsz
;
10638 memcpy (cur
->data
, note
->descdata
, note
->descsz
);
10640 elf_tdata (abfd
)->sdt_note_head
= cur
;
10646 elfobj_grok_stapsdt_note (bfd
*abfd
, Elf_Internal_Note
*note
)
10648 switch (note
->type
)
10651 return elfobj_grok_stapsdt_note_1 (abfd
, note
);
10659 elfcore_grok_freebsd_psinfo (bfd
*abfd
, Elf_Internal_Note
*note
)
10663 switch (elf_elfheader (abfd
)->e_ident
[EI_CLASS
])
10666 if (note
->descsz
< 108)
10671 if (note
->descsz
< 120)
10679 /* Check for version 1 in pr_version. */
10680 if (bfd_h_get_32 (abfd
, (bfd_byte
*) note
->descdata
) != 1)
10685 /* Skip over pr_psinfosz. */
10686 if (elf_elfheader (abfd
)->e_ident
[EI_CLASS
] == ELFCLASS32
)
10690 offset
+= 4; /* Padding before pr_psinfosz. */
10694 /* pr_fname is PRFNAMESZ (16) + 1 bytes in size. */
10695 elf_tdata (abfd
)->core
->program
10696 = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd
, note
->descdata
+ offset
, 17);
10699 /* pr_psargs is PRARGSZ (80) + 1 bytes in size. */
10700 elf_tdata (abfd
)->core
->command
10701 = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd
, note
->descdata
+ offset
, 81);
10704 /* Padding before pr_pid. */
10707 /* The pr_pid field was added in version "1a". */
10708 if (note
->descsz
< offset
+ 4)
10711 elf_tdata (abfd
)->core
->pid
10712 = bfd_h_get_32 (abfd
, (bfd_byte
*) note
->descdata
+ offset
);
10718 elfcore_grok_freebsd_prstatus (bfd
*abfd
, Elf_Internal_Note
*note
)
10724 /* Compute offset of pr_getregsz, skipping over pr_statussz.
10725 Also compute minimum size of this note. */
10726 switch (elf_elfheader (abfd
)->e_ident
[EI_CLASS
])
10730 min_size
= offset
+ (4 * 2) + 4 + 4 + 4;
10734 offset
= 4 + 4 + 8; /* Includes padding before pr_statussz. */
10735 min_size
= offset
+ (8 * 2) + 4 + 4 + 4 + 4;
10742 if (note
->descsz
< min_size
)
10745 /* Check for version 1 in pr_version. */
10746 if (bfd_h_get_32 (abfd
, (bfd_byte
*) note
->descdata
) != 1)
10749 /* Extract size of pr_reg from pr_gregsetsz. */
10750 /* Skip over pr_gregsetsz and pr_fpregsetsz. */
10751 if (elf_elfheader (abfd
)->e_ident
[EI_CLASS
] == ELFCLASS32
)
10753 size
= bfd_h_get_32 (abfd
, (bfd_byte
*) note
->descdata
+ offset
);
10758 size
= bfd_h_get_64 (abfd
, (bfd_byte
*) note
->descdata
+ offset
);
10762 /* Skip over pr_osreldate. */
10765 /* Read signal from pr_cursig. */
10766 if (elf_tdata (abfd
)->core
->signal
== 0)
10767 elf_tdata (abfd
)->core
->signal
10768 = bfd_h_get_32 (abfd
, (bfd_byte
*) note
->descdata
+ offset
);
10771 /* Read TID from pr_pid. */
10772 elf_tdata (abfd
)->core
->lwpid
10773 = bfd_h_get_32 (abfd
, (bfd_byte
*) note
->descdata
+ offset
);
10776 /* Padding before pr_reg. */
10777 if (elf_elfheader (abfd
)->e_ident
[EI_CLASS
] == ELFCLASS64
)
10780 /* Make sure that there is enough data remaining in the note. */
10781 if ((note
->descsz
- offset
) < size
)
10784 /* Make a ".reg/999" section and a ".reg" section. */
10785 return _bfd_elfcore_make_pseudosection (abfd
, ".reg",
10786 size
, note
->descpos
+ offset
);
10790 elfcore_grok_freebsd_note (bfd
*abfd
, Elf_Internal_Note
*note
)
10792 const struct elf_backend_data
*bed
= get_elf_backend_data (abfd
);
10794 switch (note
->type
)
10797 if (bed
->elf_backend_grok_freebsd_prstatus
)
10798 if ((*bed
->elf_backend_grok_freebsd_prstatus
) (abfd
, note
))
10800 return elfcore_grok_freebsd_prstatus (abfd
, note
);
10803 return elfcore_grok_prfpreg (abfd
, note
);
10806 return elfcore_grok_freebsd_psinfo (abfd
, note
);
10808 case NT_FREEBSD_THRMISC
:
10809 if (note
->namesz
== 8)
10810 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd
, ".thrmisc", note
);
10814 case NT_FREEBSD_PROCSTAT_PROC
:
10815 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd
, ".note.freebsdcore.proc",
10818 case NT_FREEBSD_PROCSTAT_FILES
:
10819 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd
, ".note.freebsdcore.files",
10822 case NT_FREEBSD_PROCSTAT_VMMAP
:
10823 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd
, ".note.freebsdcore.vmmap",
10826 case NT_FREEBSD_PROCSTAT_AUXV
:
10827 return elfcore_make_auxv_note_section (abfd
, note
, 4);
10829 case NT_X86_XSTATE
:
10830 if (note
->namesz
== 8)
10831 return elfcore_grok_xstatereg (abfd
, note
);
10835 case NT_FREEBSD_PTLWPINFO
:
10836 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd
, ".note.freebsdcore.lwpinfo",
10840 return elfcore_grok_arm_vfp (abfd
, note
);
10848 elfcore_netbsd_get_lwpid (Elf_Internal_Note
*note
, int *lwpidp
)
10852 cp
= strchr (note
->namedata
, '@');
10855 *lwpidp
= atoi(cp
+ 1);
10862 elfcore_grok_netbsd_procinfo (bfd
*abfd
, Elf_Internal_Note
*note
)
10864 if (note
->descsz
<= 0x7c + 31)
10867 /* Signal number at offset 0x08. */
10868 elf_tdata (abfd
)->core
->signal
10869 = bfd_h_get_32 (abfd
, (bfd_byte
*) note
->descdata
+ 0x08);
10871 /* Process ID at offset 0x50. */
10872 elf_tdata (abfd
)->core
->pid
10873 = bfd_h_get_32 (abfd
, (bfd_byte
*) note
->descdata
+ 0x50);
10875 /* Command name at 0x7c (max 32 bytes, including nul). */
10876 elf_tdata (abfd
)->core
->command
10877 = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd
, note
->descdata
+ 0x7c, 31);
10879 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd
, ".note.netbsdcore.procinfo",
10884 elfcore_grok_netbsd_note (bfd
*abfd
, Elf_Internal_Note
*note
)
10888 if (elfcore_netbsd_get_lwpid (note
, &lwp
))
10889 elf_tdata (abfd
)->core
->lwpid
= lwp
;
10891 switch (note
->type
)
10893 case NT_NETBSDCORE_PROCINFO
:
10894 /* NetBSD-specific core "procinfo". Note that we expect to
10895 find this note before any of the others, which is fine,
10896 since the kernel writes this note out first when it
10897 creates a core file. */
10898 return elfcore_grok_netbsd_procinfo (abfd
, note
);
10899 #ifdef NT_NETBSDCORE_AUXV
10900 case NT_NETBSDCORE_AUXV
:
10901 /* NetBSD-specific Elf Auxiliary Vector data. */
10902 return elfcore_make_auxv_note_section (abfd
, note
, 4);
10904 #ifdef NT_NETBSDCORE_LWPSTATUS
10905 case NT_NETBSDCORE_LWPSTATUS
:
10906 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd
,
10907 ".note.netbsdcore.lwpstatus",
10914 /* As of March 2020 there are no other machine-independent notes
10915 defined for NetBSD core files. If the note type is less
10916 than the start of the machine-dependent note types, we don't
10919 if (note
->type
< NT_NETBSDCORE_FIRSTMACH
)
10923 switch (bfd_get_arch (abfd
))
10925 /* On the Alpha, SPARC (32-bit and 64-bit), PT_GETREGS == mach+0 and
10926 PT_GETFPREGS == mach+2. */
10928 case bfd_arch_aarch64
:
10929 case bfd_arch_alpha
:
10930 case bfd_arch_sparc
:
10931 switch (note
->type
)
10933 case NT_NETBSDCORE_FIRSTMACH
+0:
10934 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd
, ".reg", note
);
10936 case NT_NETBSDCORE_FIRSTMACH
+2:
10937 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd
, ".reg2", note
);
10943 /* On SuperH, PT_GETREGS == mach+3 and PT_GETFPREGS == mach+5.
10944 There's also old PT___GETREGS40 == mach + 1 for old reg
10945 structure which lacks GBR. */
10948 switch (note
->type
)
10950 case NT_NETBSDCORE_FIRSTMACH
+3:
10951 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd
, ".reg", note
);
10953 case NT_NETBSDCORE_FIRSTMACH
+5:
10954 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd
, ".reg2", note
);
10960 /* On all other arch's, PT_GETREGS == mach+1 and
10961 PT_GETFPREGS == mach+3. */
10964 switch (note
->type
)
10966 case NT_NETBSDCORE_FIRSTMACH
+1:
10967 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd
, ".reg", note
);
10969 case NT_NETBSDCORE_FIRSTMACH
+3:
10970 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd
, ".reg2", note
);
10980 elfcore_grok_openbsd_procinfo (bfd
*abfd
, Elf_Internal_Note
*note
)
10982 if (note
->descsz
<= 0x48 + 31)
10985 /* Signal number at offset 0x08. */
10986 elf_tdata (abfd
)->core
->signal
10987 = bfd_h_get_32 (abfd
, (bfd_byte
*) note
->descdata
+ 0x08);
10989 /* Process ID at offset 0x20. */
10990 elf_tdata (abfd
)->core
->pid
10991 = bfd_h_get_32 (abfd
, (bfd_byte
*) note
->descdata
+ 0x20);
10993 /* Command name at 0x48 (max 32 bytes, including nul). */
10994 elf_tdata (abfd
)->core
->command
10995 = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd
, note
->descdata
+ 0x48, 31);
11001 elfcore_grok_openbsd_note (bfd
*abfd
, Elf_Internal_Note
*note
)
11003 if (note
->type
== NT_OPENBSD_PROCINFO
)
11004 return elfcore_grok_openbsd_procinfo (abfd
, note
);
11006 if (note
->type
== NT_OPENBSD_REGS
)
11007 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd
, ".reg", note
);
11009 if (note
->type
== NT_OPENBSD_FPREGS
)
11010 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd
, ".reg2", note
);
11012 if (note
->type
== NT_OPENBSD_XFPREGS
)
11013 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd
, ".reg-xfp", note
);
11015 if (note
->type
== NT_OPENBSD_AUXV
)
11016 return elfcore_make_auxv_note_section (abfd
, note
, 0);
11018 if (note
->type
== NT_OPENBSD_WCOOKIE
)
11020 asection
*sect
= bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd
, ".wcookie",
11025 sect
->size
= note
->descsz
;
11026 sect
->filepos
= note
->descpos
;
11027 sect
->alignment_power
= 1 + bfd_get_arch_size (abfd
) / 32;
11036 elfcore_grok_nto_status (bfd
*abfd
, Elf_Internal_Note
*note
, long *tid
)
11038 void *ddata
= note
->descdata
;
11045 if (note
->descsz
< 16)
11048 /* nto_procfs_status 'pid' field is at offset 0. */
11049 elf_tdata (abfd
)->core
->pid
= bfd_get_32 (abfd
, (bfd_byte
*) ddata
);
11051 /* nto_procfs_status 'tid' field is at offset 4. Pass it back. */
11052 *tid
= bfd_get_32 (abfd
, (bfd_byte
*) ddata
+ 4);
11054 /* nto_procfs_status 'flags' field is at offset 8. */
11055 flags
= bfd_get_32 (abfd
, (bfd_byte
*) ddata
+ 8);
11057 /* nto_procfs_status 'what' field is at offset 14. */
11058 if ((sig
= bfd_get_16 (abfd
, (bfd_byte
*) ddata
+ 14)) > 0)
11060 elf_tdata (abfd
)->core
->signal
= sig
;
11061 elf_tdata (abfd
)->core
->lwpid
= *tid
;
11064 /* _DEBUG_FLAG_CURTID (current thread) is 0x80. Some cores
11065 do not come from signals so we make sure we set the current
11066 thread just in case. */
11067 if (flags
& 0x00000080)
11068 elf_tdata (abfd
)->core
->lwpid
= *tid
;
11070 /* Make a ".qnx_core_status/%d" section. */
11071 sprintf (buf
, ".qnx_core_status/%ld", *tid
);
11073 name
= (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd
, strlen (buf
) + 1);
11076 strcpy (name
, buf
);
11078 sect
= bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd
, name
, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
);
11082 sect
->size
= note
->descsz
;
11083 sect
->filepos
= note
->descpos
;
11084 sect
->alignment_power
= 2;
11086 return (elfcore_maybe_make_sect (abfd
, ".qnx_core_status", sect
));
11090 elfcore_grok_nto_regs (bfd
*abfd
,
11091 Elf_Internal_Note
*note
,
11099 /* Make a "(base)/%d" section. */
11100 sprintf (buf
, "%s/%ld", base
, tid
);
11102 name
= (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd
, strlen (buf
) + 1);
11105 strcpy (name
, buf
);
11107 sect
= bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd
, name
, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
);
11111 sect
->size
= note
->descsz
;
11112 sect
->filepos
= note
->descpos
;
11113 sect
->alignment_power
= 2;
11115 /* This is the current thread. */
11116 if (elf_tdata (abfd
)->core
->lwpid
== tid
)
11117 return elfcore_maybe_make_sect (abfd
, base
, sect
);
11122 #define BFD_QNT_CORE_INFO 7
11123 #define BFD_QNT_CORE_STATUS 8
11124 #define BFD_QNT_CORE_GREG 9
11125 #define BFD_QNT_CORE_FPREG 10
11128 elfcore_grok_nto_note (bfd
*abfd
, Elf_Internal_Note
*note
)
11130 /* Every GREG section has a STATUS section before it. Store the
11131 tid from the previous call to pass down to the next gregs
11133 static long tid
= 1;
11135 switch (note
->type
)
11137 case BFD_QNT_CORE_INFO
:
11138 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd
, ".qnx_core_info", note
);
11139 case BFD_QNT_CORE_STATUS
:
11140 return elfcore_grok_nto_status (abfd
, note
, &tid
);
11141 case BFD_QNT_CORE_GREG
:
11142 return elfcore_grok_nto_regs (abfd
, note
, tid
, ".reg");
11143 case BFD_QNT_CORE_FPREG
:
11144 return elfcore_grok_nto_regs (abfd
, note
, tid
, ".reg2");
11151 elfcore_grok_spu_note (bfd
*abfd
, Elf_Internal_Note
*note
)
11157 /* Use note name as section name. */
11158 len
= note
->namesz
;
11159 name
= (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd
, len
);
11162 memcpy (name
, note
->namedata
, len
);
11163 name
[len
- 1] = '\0';
11165 sect
= bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd
, name
, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
);
11169 sect
->size
= note
->descsz
;
11170 sect
->filepos
= note
->descpos
;
11171 sect
->alignment_power
= 1;
11176 /* Function: elfcore_write_note
11179 buffer to hold note, and current size of buffer
11183 size of data for note
11185 Writes note to end of buffer. ELF64 notes are written exactly as
11186 for ELF32, despite the current (as of 2006) ELF gabi specifying
11187 that they ought to have 8-byte namesz and descsz field, and have
11188 8-byte alignment. Other writers, eg. Linux kernel, do the same.
11191 Pointer to realloc'd buffer, *BUFSIZ updated. */
11194 elfcore_write_note (bfd
*abfd
,
11202 Elf_External_Note
*xnp
;
11209 namesz
= strlen (name
) + 1;
11211 newspace
= 12 + ((namesz
+ 3) & -4) + ((size
+ 3) & -4);
11213 buf
= (char *) realloc (buf
, *bufsiz
+ newspace
);
11216 dest
= buf
+ *bufsiz
;
11217 *bufsiz
+= newspace
;
11218 xnp
= (Elf_External_Note
*) dest
;
11219 H_PUT_32 (abfd
, namesz
, xnp
->namesz
);
11220 H_PUT_32 (abfd
, size
, xnp
->descsz
);
11221 H_PUT_32 (abfd
, type
, xnp
->type
);
11225 memcpy (dest
, name
, namesz
);
11233 memcpy (dest
, input
, size
);
11243 /* gcc-8 warns (*) on all the strncpy calls in this function about
11244 possible string truncation. The "truncation" is not a bug. We
11245 have an external representation of structs with fields that are not
11246 necessarily NULL terminated and corresponding internal
11247 representation fields that are one larger so that they can always
11248 be NULL terminated.
11249 gcc versions between 4.2 and 4.6 do not allow pragma control of
11250 diagnostics inside functions, giving a hard error if you try to use
11251 the finer control available with later versions.
11252 gcc prior to 4.2 warns about diagnostic push and pop.
11253 gcc-5, gcc-6 and gcc-7 warn that -Wstringop-truncation is unknown,
11254 unless you also add #pragma GCC diagnostic ignored "-Wpragma".
11255 (*) Depending on your system header files! */
11256 #if GCC_VERSION >= 8000
11257 # pragma GCC diagnostic push
11258 # pragma GCC diagnostic ignored "-Wstringop-truncation"
11261 elfcore_write_prpsinfo (bfd
*abfd
,
11265 const char *psargs
)
11267 const struct elf_backend_data
*bed
= get_elf_backend_data (abfd
);
11269 if (bed
->elf_backend_write_core_note
!= NULL
)
11272 ret
= (*bed
->elf_backend_write_core_note
) (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
,
11273 NT_PRPSINFO
, fname
, psargs
);
11278 #if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO_T) || defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T)
11279 # if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO32_T) || defined (HAVE_PSINFO32_T)
11280 if (bed
->s
->elfclass
== ELFCLASS32
)
11282 # if defined (HAVE_PSINFO32_T)
11284 int note_type
= NT_PSINFO
;
11287 int note_type
= NT_PRPSINFO
;
11290 memset (&data
, 0, sizeof (data
));
11291 strncpy (data
.pr_fname
, fname
, sizeof (data
.pr_fname
));
11292 strncpy (data
.pr_psargs
, psargs
, sizeof (data
.pr_psargs
));
11293 return elfcore_write_note (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
,
11294 "CORE", note_type
, &data
, sizeof (data
));
11299 # if defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T)
11301 int note_type
= NT_PSINFO
;
11304 int note_type
= NT_PRPSINFO
;
11307 memset (&data
, 0, sizeof (data
));
11308 strncpy (data
.pr_fname
, fname
, sizeof (data
.pr_fname
));
11309 strncpy (data
.pr_psargs
, psargs
, sizeof (data
.pr_psargs
));
11310 return elfcore_write_note (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
,
11311 "CORE", note_type
, &data
, sizeof (data
));
11313 #endif /* PSINFO_T or PRPSINFO_T */
11318 #if GCC_VERSION >= 8000
11319 # pragma GCC diagnostic pop
11323 elfcore_write_linux_prpsinfo32
11324 (bfd
*abfd
, char *buf
, int *bufsiz
,
11325 const struct elf_internal_linux_prpsinfo
*prpsinfo
)
11327 if (get_elf_backend_data (abfd
)->linux_prpsinfo32_ugid16
)
11329 struct elf_external_linux_prpsinfo32_ugid16 data
;
11331 swap_linux_prpsinfo32_ugid16_out (abfd
, prpsinfo
, &data
);
11332 return elfcore_write_note (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
, "CORE", NT_PRPSINFO
,
11333 &data
, sizeof (data
));
11337 struct elf_external_linux_prpsinfo32_ugid32 data
;
11339 swap_linux_prpsinfo32_ugid32_out (abfd
, prpsinfo
, &data
);
11340 return elfcore_write_note (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
, "CORE", NT_PRPSINFO
,
11341 &data
, sizeof (data
));
11346 elfcore_write_linux_prpsinfo64
11347 (bfd
*abfd
, char *buf
, int *bufsiz
,
11348 const struct elf_internal_linux_prpsinfo
*prpsinfo
)
11350 if (get_elf_backend_data (abfd
)->linux_prpsinfo64_ugid16
)
11352 struct elf_external_linux_prpsinfo64_ugid16 data
;
11354 swap_linux_prpsinfo64_ugid16_out (abfd
, prpsinfo
, &data
);
11355 return elfcore_write_note (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
,
11356 "CORE", NT_PRPSINFO
, &data
, sizeof (data
));
11360 struct elf_external_linux_prpsinfo64_ugid32 data
;
11362 swap_linux_prpsinfo64_ugid32_out (abfd
, prpsinfo
, &data
);
11363 return elfcore_write_note (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
,
11364 "CORE", NT_PRPSINFO
, &data
, sizeof (data
));
11369 elfcore_write_prstatus (bfd
*abfd
,
11376 const struct elf_backend_data
*bed
= get_elf_backend_data (abfd
);
11378 if (bed
->elf_backend_write_core_note
!= NULL
)
11381 ret
= (*bed
->elf_backend_write_core_note
) (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
,
11383 pid
, cursig
, gregs
);
11388 #if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS_T)
11389 #if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS32_T)
11390 if (bed
->s
->elfclass
== ELFCLASS32
)
11392 prstatus32_t prstat
;
11394 memset (&prstat
, 0, sizeof (prstat
));
11395 prstat
.pr_pid
= pid
;
11396 prstat
.pr_cursig
= cursig
;
11397 memcpy (&prstat
.pr_reg
, gregs
, sizeof (prstat
.pr_reg
));
11398 return elfcore_write_note (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
, "CORE",
11399 NT_PRSTATUS
, &prstat
, sizeof (prstat
));
11406 memset (&prstat
, 0, sizeof (prstat
));
11407 prstat
.pr_pid
= pid
;
11408 prstat
.pr_cursig
= cursig
;
11409 memcpy (&prstat
.pr_reg
, gregs
, sizeof (prstat
.pr_reg
));
11410 return elfcore_write_note (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
, "CORE",
11411 NT_PRSTATUS
, &prstat
, sizeof (prstat
));
11413 #endif /* HAVE_PRSTATUS_T */
11419 #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T)
11421 elfcore_write_lwpstatus (bfd
*abfd
,
11428 lwpstatus_t lwpstat
;
11429 const char *note_name
= "CORE";
11431 memset (&lwpstat
, 0, sizeof (lwpstat
));
11432 lwpstat
.pr_lwpid
= pid
>> 16;
11433 lwpstat
.pr_cursig
= cursig
;
11434 #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T_PR_REG)
11435 memcpy (&lwpstat
.pr_reg
, gregs
, sizeof (lwpstat
.pr_reg
));
11436 #elif defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T_PR_CONTEXT)
11437 #if !defined(gregs)
11438 memcpy (lwpstat
.pr_context
.uc_mcontext
.gregs
,
11439 gregs
, sizeof (lwpstat
.pr_context
.uc_mcontext
.gregs
));
11441 memcpy (lwpstat
.pr_context
.uc_mcontext
.__gregs
,
11442 gregs
, sizeof (lwpstat
.pr_context
.uc_mcontext
.__gregs
));
11445 return elfcore_write_note (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
, note_name
,
11446 NT_LWPSTATUS
, &lwpstat
, sizeof (lwpstat
));
11448 #endif /* HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T */
11450 #if defined (HAVE_PSTATUS_T)
11452 elfcore_write_pstatus (bfd
*abfd
,
11456 int cursig ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED
,
11457 const void *gregs ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED
)
11459 const char *note_name
= "CORE";
11460 #if defined (HAVE_PSTATUS32_T)
11461 const struct elf_backend_data
*bed
= get_elf_backend_data (abfd
);
11463 if (bed
->s
->elfclass
== ELFCLASS32
)
11467 memset (&pstat
, 0, sizeof (pstat
));
11468 pstat
.pr_pid
= pid
& 0xffff;
11469 buf
= elfcore_write_note (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
, note_name
,
11470 NT_PSTATUS
, &pstat
, sizeof (pstat
));
11478 memset (&pstat
, 0, sizeof (pstat
));
11479 pstat
.pr_pid
= pid
& 0xffff;
11480 buf
= elfcore_write_note (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
, note_name
,
11481 NT_PSTATUS
, &pstat
, sizeof (pstat
));
11485 #endif /* HAVE_PSTATUS_T */
11488 elfcore_write_prfpreg (bfd
*abfd
,
11491 const void *fpregs
,
11494 const char *note_name
= "CORE";
11495 return elfcore_write_note (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
,
11496 note_name
, NT_FPREGSET
, fpregs
, size
);
11500 elfcore_write_prxfpreg (bfd
*abfd
,
11503 const void *xfpregs
,
11506 char *note_name
= "LINUX";
11507 return elfcore_write_note (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
,
11508 note_name
, NT_PRXFPREG
, xfpregs
, size
);
11512 elfcore_write_xstatereg (bfd
*abfd
, char *buf
, int *bufsiz
,
11513 const void *xfpregs
, int size
)
11516 if (get_elf_backend_data (abfd
)->elf_osabi
== ELFOSABI_FREEBSD
)
11517 note_name
= "FreeBSD";
11519 note_name
= "LINUX";
11520 return elfcore_write_note (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
,
11521 note_name
, NT_X86_XSTATE
, xfpregs
, size
);
11525 elfcore_write_ppc_vmx (bfd
*abfd
,
11528 const void *ppc_vmx
,
11531 char *note_name
= "LINUX";
11532 return elfcore_write_note (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
,
11533 note_name
, NT_PPC_VMX
, ppc_vmx
, size
);
11537 elfcore_write_ppc_vsx (bfd
*abfd
,
11540 const void *ppc_vsx
,
11543 char *note_name
= "LINUX";
11544 return elfcore_write_note (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
,
11545 note_name
, NT_PPC_VSX
, ppc_vsx
, size
);
11549 elfcore_write_ppc_tar (bfd
*abfd
,
11552 const void *ppc_tar
,
11555 char *note_name
= "LINUX";
11556 return elfcore_write_note (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
,
11557 note_name
, NT_PPC_TAR
, ppc_tar
, size
);
11561 elfcore_write_ppc_ppr (bfd
*abfd
,
11564 const void *ppc_ppr
,
11567 char *note_name
= "LINUX";
11568 return elfcore_write_note (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
,
11569 note_name
, NT_PPC_PPR
, ppc_ppr
, size
);
11573 elfcore_write_ppc_dscr (bfd
*abfd
,
11576 const void *ppc_dscr
,
11579 char *note_name
= "LINUX";
11580 return elfcore_write_note (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
,
11581 note_name
, NT_PPC_DSCR
, ppc_dscr
, size
);
11585 elfcore_write_ppc_ebb (bfd
*abfd
,
11588 const void *ppc_ebb
,
11591 char *note_name
= "LINUX";
11592 return elfcore_write_note (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
,
11593 note_name
, NT_PPC_EBB
, ppc_ebb
, size
);
11597 elfcore_write_ppc_pmu (bfd
*abfd
,
11600 const void *ppc_pmu
,
11603 char *note_name
= "LINUX";
11604 return elfcore_write_note (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
,
11605 note_name
, NT_PPC_PMU
, ppc_pmu
, size
);
11609 elfcore_write_ppc_tm_cgpr (bfd
*abfd
,
11612 const void *ppc_tm_cgpr
,
11615 char *note_name
= "LINUX";
11616 return elfcore_write_note (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
,
11617 note_name
, NT_PPC_TM_CGPR
, ppc_tm_cgpr
, size
);
11621 elfcore_write_ppc_tm_cfpr (bfd
*abfd
,
11624 const void *ppc_tm_cfpr
,
11627 char *note_name
= "LINUX";
11628 return elfcore_write_note (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
,
11629 note_name
, NT_PPC_TM_CFPR
, ppc_tm_cfpr
, size
);
11633 elfcore_write_ppc_tm_cvmx (bfd
*abfd
,
11636 const void *ppc_tm_cvmx
,
11639 char *note_name
= "LINUX";
11640 return elfcore_write_note (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
,
11641 note_name
, NT_PPC_TM_CVMX
, ppc_tm_cvmx
, size
);
11645 elfcore_write_ppc_tm_cvsx (bfd
*abfd
,
11648 const void *ppc_tm_cvsx
,
11651 char *note_name
= "LINUX";
11652 return elfcore_write_note (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
,
11653 note_name
, NT_PPC_TM_CVSX
, ppc_tm_cvsx
, size
);
11657 elfcore_write_ppc_tm_spr (bfd
*abfd
,
11660 const void *ppc_tm_spr
,
11663 char *note_name
= "LINUX";
11664 return elfcore_write_note (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
,
11665 note_name
, NT_PPC_TM_SPR
, ppc_tm_spr
, size
);
11669 elfcore_write_ppc_tm_ctar (bfd
*abfd
,
11672 const void *ppc_tm_ctar
,
11675 char *note_name
= "LINUX";
11676 return elfcore_write_note (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
,
11677 note_name
, NT_PPC_TM_CTAR
, ppc_tm_ctar
, size
);
11681 elfcore_write_ppc_tm_cppr (bfd
*abfd
,
11684 const void *ppc_tm_cppr
,
11687 char *note_name
= "LINUX";
11688 return elfcore_write_note (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
,
11689 note_name
, NT_PPC_TM_CPPR
, ppc_tm_cppr
, size
);
11693 elfcore_write_ppc_tm_cdscr (bfd
*abfd
,
11696 const void *ppc_tm_cdscr
,
11699 char *note_name
= "LINUX";
11700 return elfcore_write_note (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
,
11701 note_name
, NT_PPC_TM_CDSCR
, ppc_tm_cdscr
, size
);
11705 elfcore_write_s390_high_gprs (bfd
*abfd
,
11708 const void *s390_high_gprs
,
11711 char *note_name
= "LINUX";
11712 return elfcore_write_note (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
,
11713 note_name
, NT_S390_HIGH_GPRS
,
11714 s390_high_gprs
, size
);
11718 elfcore_write_s390_timer (bfd
*abfd
,
11721 const void *s390_timer
,
11724 char *note_name
= "LINUX";
11725 return elfcore_write_note (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
,
11726 note_name
, NT_S390_TIMER
, s390_timer
, size
);
11730 elfcore_write_s390_todcmp (bfd
*abfd
,
11733 const void *s390_todcmp
,
11736 char *note_name
= "LINUX";
11737 return elfcore_write_note (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
,
11738 note_name
, NT_S390_TODCMP
, s390_todcmp
, size
);
11742 elfcore_write_s390_todpreg (bfd
*abfd
,
11745 const void *s390_todpreg
,
11748 char *note_name
= "LINUX";
11749 return elfcore_write_note (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
,
11750 note_name
, NT_S390_TODPREG
, s390_todpreg
, size
);
11754 elfcore_write_s390_ctrs (bfd
*abfd
,
11757 const void *s390_ctrs
,
11760 char *note_name
= "LINUX";
11761 return elfcore_write_note (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
,
11762 note_name
, NT_S390_CTRS
, s390_ctrs
, size
);
11766 elfcore_write_s390_prefix (bfd
*abfd
,
11769 const void *s390_prefix
,
11772 char *note_name
= "LINUX";
11773 return elfcore_write_note (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
,
11774 note_name
, NT_S390_PREFIX
, s390_prefix
, size
);
11778 elfcore_write_s390_last_break (bfd
*abfd
,
11781 const void *s390_last_break
,
11784 char *note_name
= "LINUX";
11785 return elfcore_write_note (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
,
11786 note_name
, NT_S390_LAST_BREAK
,
11787 s390_last_break
, size
);
11791 elfcore_write_s390_system_call (bfd
*abfd
,
11794 const void *s390_system_call
,
11797 char *note_name
= "LINUX";
11798 return elfcore_write_note (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
,
11799 note_name
, NT_S390_SYSTEM_CALL
,
11800 s390_system_call
, size
);
11804 elfcore_write_s390_tdb (bfd
*abfd
,
11807 const void *s390_tdb
,
11810 char *note_name
= "LINUX";
11811 return elfcore_write_note (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
,
11812 note_name
, NT_S390_TDB
, s390_tdb
, size
);
11816 elfcore_write_s390_vxrs_low (bfd
*abfd
,
11819 const void *s390_vxrs_low
,
11822 char *note_name
= "LINUX";
11823 return elfcore_write_note (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
,
11824 note_name
, NT_S390_VXRS_LOW
, s390_vxrs_low
, size
);
11828 elfcore_write_s390_vxrs_high (bfd
*abfd
,
11831 const void *s390_vxrs_high
,
11834 char *note_name
= "LINUX";
11835 return elfcore_write_note (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
,
11836 note_name
, NT_S390_VXRS_HIGH
,
11837 s390_vxrs_high
, size
);
11841 elfcore_write_s390_gs_cb (bfd
*abfd
,
11844 const void *s390_gs_cb
,
11847 char *note_name
= "LINUX";
11848 return elfcore_write_note (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
,
11849 note_name
, NT_S390_GS_CB
,
11854 elfcore_write_s390_gs_bc (bfd
*abfd
,
11857 const void *s390_gs_bc
,
11860 char *note_name
= "LINUX";
11861 return elfcore_write_note (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
,
11862 note_name
, NT_S390_GS_BC
,
11867 elfcore_write_arm_vfp (bfd
*abfd
,
11870 const void *arm_vfp
,
11873 char *note_name
= "LINUX";
11874 return elfcore_write_note (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
,
11875 note_name
, NT_ARM_VFP
, arm_vfp
, size
);
11879 elfcore_write_aarch_tls (bfd
*abfd
,
11882 const void *aarch_tls
,
11885 char *note_name
= "LINUX";
11886 return elfcore_write_note (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
,
11887 note_name
, NT_ARM_TLS
, aarch_tls
, size
);
11891 elfcore_write_aarch_hw_break (bfd
*abfd
,
11894 const void *aarch_hw_break
,
11897 char *note_name
= "LINUX";
11898 return elfcore_write_note (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
,
11899 note_name
, NT_ARM_HW_BREAK
, aarch_hw_break
, size
);
11903 elfcore_write_aarch_hw_watch (bfd
*abfd
,
11906 const void *aarch_hw_watch
,
11909 char *note_name
= "LINUX";
11910 return elfcore_write_note (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
,
11911 note_name
, NT_ARM_HW_WATCH
, aarch_hw_watch
, size
);
11915 elfcore_write_aarch_sve (bfd
*abfd
,
11918 const void *aarch_sve
,
11921 char *note_name
= "LINUX";
11922 return elfcore_write_note (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
,
11923 note_name
, NT_ARM_SVE
, aarch_sve
, size
);
11927 elfcore_write_aarch_pauth (bfd
*abfd
,
11930 const void *aarch_pauth
,
11933 char *note_name
= "LINUX";
11934 return elfcore_write_note (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
,
11935 note_name
, NT_ARM_PAC_MASK
, aarch_pauth
, size
);
11939 elfcore_write_arc_v2 (bfd
*abfd
,
11942 const void *arc_v2
,
11945 char *note_name
= "LINUX";
11946 return elfcore_write_note (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
,
11947 note_name
, NT_ARC_V2
, arc_v2
, size
);
11951 elfcore_write_register_note (bfd
*abfd
,
11954 const char *section
,
11958 if (strcmp (section
, ".reg2") == 0)
11959 return elfcore_write_prfpreg (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
, data
, size
);
11960 if (strcmp (section
, ".reg-xfp") == 0)
11961 return elfcore_write_prxfpreg (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
, data
, size
);
11962 if (strcmp (section
, ".reg-xstate") == 0)
11963 return elfcore_write_xstatereg (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
, data
, size
);
11964 if (strcmp (section
, ".reg-ppc-vmx") == 0)
11965 return elfcore_write_ppc_vmx (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
, data
, size
);
11966 if (strcmp (section
, ".reg-ppc-vsx") == 0)
11967 return elfcore_write_ppc_vsx (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
, data
, size
);
11968 if (strcmp (section
, ".reg-ppc-tar") == 0)
11969 return elfcore_write_ppc_tar (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
, data
, size
);
11970 if (strcmp (section
, ".reg-ppc-ppr") == 0)
11971 return elfcore_write_ppc_ppr (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
, data
, size
);
11972 if (strcmp (section
, ".reg-ppc-dscr") == 0)
11973 return elfcore_write_ppc_dscr (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
, data
, size
);
11974 if (strcmp (section
, ".reg-ppc-ebb") == 0)
11975 return elfcore_write_ppc_ebb (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
, data
, size
);
11976 if (strcmp (section
, ".reg-ppc-pmu") == 0)
11977 return elfcore_write_ppc_pmu (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
, data
, size
);
11978 if (strcmp (section
, ".reg-ppc-tm-cgpr") == 0)
11979 return elfcore_write_ppc_tm_cgpr (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
, data
, size
);
11980 if (strcmp (section
, ".reg-ppc-tm-cfpr") == 0)
11981 return elfcore_write_ppc_tm_cfpr (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
, data
, size
);
11982 if (strcmp (section
, ".reg-ppc-tm-cvmx") == 0)
11983 return elfcore_write_ppc_tm_cvmx (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
, data
, size
);
11984 if (strcmp (section
, ".reg-ppc-tm-cvsx") == 0)
11985 return elfcore_write_ppc_tm_cvsx (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
, data
, size
);
11986 if (strcmp (section
, ".reg-ppc-tm-spr") == 0)
11987 return elfcore_write_ppc_tm_spr (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
, data
, size
);
11988 if (strcmp (section
, ".reg-ppc-tm-ctar") == 0)
11989 return elfcore_write_ppc_tm_ctar (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
, data
, size
);
11990 if (strcmp (section
, ".reg-ppc-tm-cppr") == 0)
11991 return elfcore_write_ppc_tm_cppr (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
, data
, size
);
11992 if (strcmp (section
, ".reg-ppc-tm-cdscr") == 0)
11993 return elfcore_write_ppc_tm_cdscr (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
, data
, size
);
11994 if (strcmp (section
, ".reg-s390-high-gprs") == 0)
11995 return elfcore_write_s390_high_gprs (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
, data
, size
);
11996 if (strcmp (section
, ".reg-s390-timer") == 0)
11997 return elfcore_write_s390_timer (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
, data
, size
);
11998 if (strcmp (section
, ".reg-s390-todcmp") == 0)
11999 return elfcore_write_s390_todcmp (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
, data
, size
);
12000 if (strcmp (section
, ".reg-s390-todpreg") == 0)
12001 return elfcore_write_s390_todpreg (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
, data
, size
);
12002 if (strcmp (section
, ".reg-s390-ctrs") == 0)
12003 return elfcore_write_s390_ctrs (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
, data
, size
);
12004 if (strcmp (section
, ".reg-s390-prefix") == 0)
12005 return elfcore_write_s390_prefix (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
, data
, size
);
12006 if (strcmp (section
, ".reg-s390-last-break") == 0)
12007 return elfcore_write_s390_last_break (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
, data
, size
);
12008 if (strcmp (section
, ".reg-s390-system-call") == 0)
12009 return elfcore_write_s390_system_call (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
, data
, size
);
12010 if (strcmp (section
, ".reg-s390-tdb") == 0)
12011 return elfcore_write_s390_tdb (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
, data
, size
);
12012 if (strcmp (section
, ".reg-s390-vxrs-low") == 0)
12013 return elfcore_write_s390_vxrs_low (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
, data
, size
);
12014 if (strcmp (section
, ".reg-s390-vxrs-high") == 0)
12015 return elfcore_write_s390_vxrs_high (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
, data
, size
);
12016 if (strcmp (section
, ".reg-s390-gs-cb") == 0)
12017 return elfcore_write_s390_gs_cb (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
, data
, size
);
12018 if (strcmp (section
, ".reg-s390-gs-bc") == 0)
12019 return elfcore_write_s390_gs_bc (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
, data
, size
);
12020 if (strcmp (section
, ".reg-arm-vfp") == 0)
12021 return elfcore_write_arm_vfp (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
, data
, size
);
12022 if (strcmp (section
, ".reg-aarch-tls") == 0)
12023 return elfcore_write_aarch_tls (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
, data
, size
);
12024 if (strcmp (section
, ".reg-aarch-hw-break") == 0)
12025 return elfcore_write_aarch_hw_break (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
, data
, size
);
12026 if (strcmp (section
, ".reg-aarch-hw-watch") == 0)
12027 return elfcore_write_aarch_hw_watch (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
, data
, size
);
12028 if (strcmp (section
, ".reg-aarch-sve") == 0)
12029 return elfcore_write_aarch_sve (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
, data
, size
);
12030 if (strcmp (section
, ".reg-aarch-pauth") == 0)
12031 return elfcore_write_aarch_pauth (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
, data
, size
);
12032 if (strcmp (section
, ".reg-arc-v2") == 0)
12033 return elfcore_write_arc_v2 (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
, data
, size
);
12038 elf_parse_notes (bfd
*abfd
, char *buf
, size_t size
, file_ptr offset
,
12043 /* NB: CORE PT_NOTE segments may have p_align values of 0 or 1.
12044 gABI specifies that PT_NOTE alignment should be aligned to 4
12045 bytes for 32-bit objects and to 8 bytes for 64-bit objects. If
12046 align is less than 4, we use 4 byte alignment. */
12049 if (align
!= 4 && align
!= 8)
12053 while (p
< buf
+ size
)
12055 Elf_External_Note
*xnp
= (Elf_External_Note
*) p
;
12056 Elf_Internal_Note in
;
12058 if (offsetof (Elf_External_Note
, name
) > buf
- p
+ size
)
12061 in
.type
= H_GET_32 (abfd
, xnp
->type
);
12063 in
.namesz
= H_GET_32 (abfd
, xnp
->namesz
);
12064 in
.namedata
= xnp
->name
;
12065 if (in
.namesz
> buf
- in
.namedata
+ size
)
12068 in
.descsz
= H_GET_32 (abfd
, xnp
->descsz
);
12069 in
.descdata
= p
+ ELF_NOTE_DESC_OFFSET (in
.namesz
, align
);
12070 in
.descpos
= offset
+ (in
.descdata
- buf
);
12072 && (in
.descdata
>= buf
+ size
12073 || in
.descsz
> buf
- in
.descdata
+ size
))
12076 switch (bfd_get_format (abfd
))
12083 #define GROKER_ELEMENT(S,F) {S, sizeof (S) - 1, F}
12086 const char * string
;
12088 bfd_boolean (* func
)(bfd
*, Elf_Internal_Note
*);
12092 GROKER_ELEMENT ("", elfcore_grok_note
),
12093 GROKER_ELEMENT ("FreeBSD", elfcore_grok_freebsd_note
),
12094 GROKER_ELEMENT ("NetBSD-CORE", elfcore_grok_netbsd_note
),
12095 GROKER_ELEMENT ( "OpenBSD", elfcore_grok_openbsd_note
),
12096 GROKER_ELEMENT ("QNX", elfcore_grok_nto_note
),
12097 GROKER_ELEMENT ("SPU/", elfcore_grok_spu_note
),
12098 GROKER_ELEMENT ("GNU", elfobj_grok_gnu_note
)
12100 #undef GROKER_ELEMENT
12103 for (i
= ARRAY_SIZE (grokers
); i
--;)
12105 if (in
.namesz
>= grokers
[i
].len
12106 && strncmp (in
.namedata
, grokers
[i
].string
,
12107 grokers
[i
].len
) == 0)
12109 if (! grokers
[i
].func (abfd
, & in
))
12118 if (in
.namesz
== sizeof "GNU" && strcmp (in
.namedata
, "GNU") == 0)
12120 if (! elfobj_grok_gnu_note (abfd
, &in
))
12123 else if (in
.namesz
== sizeof "stapsdt"
12124 && strcmp (in
.namedata
, "stapsdt") == 0)
12126 if (! elfobj_grok_stapsdt_note (abfd
, &in
))
12132 p
+= ELF_NOTE_NEXT_OFFSET (in
.namesz
, in
.descsz
, align
);
12139 elf_read_notes (bfd
*abfd
, file_ptr offset
, bfd_size_type size
,
12144 if (size
== 0 || (size
+ 1) == 0)
12147 if (bfd_seek (abfd
, offset
, SEEK_SET
) != 0)
12150 buf
= (char *) _bfd_malloc_and_read (abfd
, size
+ 1, size
);
12154 /* PR 17512: file: ec08f814
12155 0-termintate the buffer so that string searches will not overflow. */
12158 if (!elf_parse_notes (abfd
, buf
, size
, offset
, align
))
12168 /* Providing external access to the ELF program header table. */
12170 /* Return an upper bound on the number of bytes required to store a
12171 copy of ABFD's program header table entries. Return -1 if an error
12172 occurs; bfd_get_error will return an appropriate code. */
12175 bfd_get_elf_phdr_upper_bound (bfd
*abfd
)
12177 if (abfd
->xvec
->flavour
!= bfd_target_elf_flavour
)
12179 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_wrong_format
);
12183 return elf_elfheader (abfd
)->e_phnum
* sizeof (Elf_Internal_Phdr
);
12186 /* Copy ABFD's program header table entries to *PHDRS. The entries
12187 will be stored as an array of Elf_Internal_Phdr structures, as
12188 defined in include/elf/internal.h. To find out how large the
12189 buffer needs to be, call bfd_get_elf_phdr_upper_bound.
12191 Return the number of program header table entries read, or -1 if an
12192 error occurs; bfd_get_error will return an appropriate code. */
12195 bfd_get_elf_phdrs (bfd
*abfd
, void *phdrs
)
12199 if (abfd
->xvec
->flavour
!= bfd_target_elf_flavour
)
12201 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_wrong_format
);
12205 num_phdrs
= elf_elfheader (abfd
)->e_phnum
;
12206 if (num_phdrs
!= 0)
12207 memcpy (phdrs
, elf_tdata (abfd
)->phdr
,
12208 num_phdrs
* sizeof (Elf_Internal_Phdr
));
12213 enum elf_reloc_type_class
12214 _bfd_elf_reloc_type_class (const struct bfd_link_info
*info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED
,
12215 const asection
*rel_sec ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED
,
12216 const Elf_Internal_Rela
*rela ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED
)
12218 return reloc_class_normal
;
12221 /* For RELA architectures, return the relocation value for a
12222 relocation against a local symbol. */
12225 _bfd_elf_rela_local_sym (bfd
*abfd
,
12226 Elf_Internal_Sym
*sym
,
12228 Elf_Internal_Rela
*rel
)
12230 asection
*sec
= *psec
;
12231 bfd_vma relocation
;
12233 relocation
= (sec
->output_section
->vma
12234 + sec
->output_offset
12236 if ((sec
->flags
& SEC_MERGE
)
12237 && ELF_ST_TYPE (sym
->st_info
) == STT_SECTION
12238 && sec
->sec_info_type
== SEC_INFO_TYPE_MERGE
)
12241 _bfd_merged_section_offset (abfd
, psec
,
12242 elf_section_data (sec
)->sec_info
,
12243 sym
->st_value
+ rel
->r_addend
);
12246 /* If we have changed the section, and our original section is
12247 marked with SEC_EXCLUDE, it means that the original
12248 SEC_MERGE section has been completely subsumed in some
12249 other SEC_MERGE section. In this case, we need to leave
12250 some info around for --emit-relocs. */
12251 if ((sec
->flags
& SEC_EXCLUDE
) != 0)
12252 sec
->kept_section
= *psec
;
12255 rel
->r_addend
-= relocation
;
12256 rel
->r_addend
+= sec
->output_section
->vma
+ sec
->output_offset
;
12262 _bfd_elf_rel_local_sym (bfd
*abfd
,
12263 Elf_Internal_Sym
*sym
,
12267 asection
*sec
= *psec
;
12269 if (sec
->sec_info_type
!= SEC_INFO_TYPE_MERGE
)
12270 return sym
->st_value
+ addend
;
12272 return _bfd_merged_section_offset (abfd
, psec
,
12273 elf_section_data (sec
)->sec_info
,
12274 sym
->st_value
+ addend
);
12277 /* Adjust an address within a section. Given OFFSET within SEC, return
12278 the new offset within the section, based upon changes made to the
12279 section. Returns -1 if the offset is now invalid.
12280 The offset (in abnd out) is in target sized bytes, however big a
12284 _bfd_elf_section_offset (bfd
*abfd
,
12285 struct bfd_link_info
*info
,
12289 switch (sec
->sec_info_type
)
12291 case SEC_INFO_TYPE_STABS
:
12292 return _bfd_stab_section_offset (sec
, elf_section_data (sec
)->sec_info
,
12294 case SEC_INFO_TYPE_EH_FRAME
:
12295 return _bfd_elf_eh_frame_section_offset (abfd
, info
, sec
, offset
);
12298 if ((sec
->flags
& SEC_ELF_REVERSE_COPY
) != 0)
12300 /* Reverse the offset. */
12301 const struct elf_backend_data
*bed
= get_elf_backend_data (abfd
);
12302 bfd_size_type address_size
= bed
->s
->arch_size
/ 8;
12304 /* address_size and sec->size are in octets. Convert
12305 to bytes before subtracting the original offset. */
12306 offset
= ((sec
->size
- address_size
)
12307 / bfd_octets_per_byte (abfd
, sec
) - offset
);
12313 /* Create a new BFD as if by bfd_openr. Rather than opening a file,
12314 reconstruct an ELF file by reading the segments out of remote memory
12315 based on the ELF file header at EHDR_VMA and the ELF program headers it
12316 points to. If not null, *LOADBASEP is filled in with the difference
12317 between the VMAs from which the segments were read, and the VMAs the
12318 file headers (and hence BFD's idea of each section's VMA) put them at.
12320 The function TARGET_READ_MEMORY is called to copy LEN bytes from the
12321 remote memory at target address VMA into the local buffer at MYADDR; it
12322 should return zero on success or an `errno' code on failure. TEMPL must
12323 be a BFD for an ELF target with the word size and byte order found in
12324 the remote memory. */
12327 bfd_elf_bfd_from_remote_memory
12330 bfd_size_type size
,
12331 bfd_vma
*loadbasep
,
12332 int (*target_read_memory
) (bfd_vma
, bfd_byte
*, bfd_size_type
))
12334 return (*get_elf_backend_data (templ
)->elf_backend_bfd_from_remote_memory
)
12335 (templ
, ehdr_vma
, size
, loadbasep
, target_read_memory
);
12339 _bfd_elf_get_synthetic_symtab (bfd
*abfd
,
12340 long symcount ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED
,
12341 asymbol
**syms ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED
,
12346 const struct elf_backend_data
*bed
= get_elf_backend_data (abfd
);
12349 const char *relplt_name
;
12350 bfd_boolean (*slurp_relocs
) (bfd
*, asection
*, asymbol
**, bfd_boolean
);
12354 Elf_Internal_Shdr
*hdr
;
12360 if ((abfd
->flags
& (DYNAMIC
| EXEC_P
)) == 0)
12363 if (dynsymcount
<= 0)
12366 if (!bed
->plt_sym_val
)
12369 relplt_name
= bed
->relplt_name
;
12370 if (relplt_name
== NULL
)
12371 relplt_name
= bed
->rela_plts_and_copies_p
? ".rela.plt" : ".rel.plt";
12372 relplt
= bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd
, relplt_name
);
12373 if (relplt
== NULL
)
12376 hdr
= &elf_section_data (relplt
)->this_hdr
;
12377 if (hdr
->sh_link
!= elf_dynsymtab (abfd
)
12378 || (hdr
->sh_type
!= SHT_REL
&& hdr
->sh_type
!= SHT_RELA
))
12381 plt
= bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd
, ".plt");
12385 slurp_relocs
= get_elf_backend_data (abfd
)->s
->slurp_reloc_table
;
12386 if (! (*slurp_relocs
) (abfd
, relplt
, dynsyms
, TRUE
))
12389 count
= relplt
->size
/ hdr
->sh_entsize
;
12390 size
= count
* sizeof (asymbol
);
12391 p
= relplt
->relocation
;
12392 for (i
= 0; i
< count
; i
++, p
+= bed
->s
->int_rels_per_ext_rel
)
12394 size
+= strlen ((*p
->sym_ptr_ptr
)->name
) + sizeof ("@plt");
12395 if (p
->addend
!= 0)
12398 size
+= sizeof ("+0x") - 1 + 8 + 8 * (bed
->s
->elfclass
== ELFCLASS64
);
12400 size
+= sizeof ("+0x") - 1 + 8;
12405 s
= *ret
= (asymbol
*) bfd_malloc (size
);
12409 names
= (char *) (s
+ count
);
12410 p
= relplt
->relocation
;
12412 for (i
= 0; i
< count
; i
++, p
+= bed
->s
->int_rels_per_ext_rel
)
12417 addr
= bed
->plt_sym_val (i
, plt
, p
);
12418 if (addr
== (bfd_vma
) -1)
12421 *s
= **p
->sym_ptr_ptr
;
12422 /* Undefined syms won't have BSF_LOCAL or BSF_GLOBAL set. Since
12423 we are defining a symbol, ensure one of them is set. */
12424 if ((s
->flags
& BSF_LOCAL
) == 0)
12425 s
->flags
|= BSF_GLOBAL
;
12426 s
->flags
|= BSF_SYNTHETIC
;
12428 s
->value
= addr
- plt
->vma
;
12431 len
= strlen ((*p
->sym_ptr_ptr
)->name
);
12432 memcpy (names
, (*p
->sym_ptr_ptr
)->name
, len
);
12434 if (p
->addend
!= 0)
12438 memcpy (names
, "+0x", sizeof ("+0x") - 1);
12439 names
+= sizeof ("+0x") - 1;
12440 bfd_sprintf_vma (abfd
, buf
, p
->addend
);
12441 for (a
= buf
; *a
== '0'; ++a
)
12444 memcpy (names
, a
, len
);
12447 memcpy (names
, "@plt", sizeof ("@plt"));
12448 names
+= sizeof ("@plt");
12455 /* It is only used by x86-64 so far.
12456 ??? This repeats *COM* id of zero. sec->id is supposed to be unique,
12457 but current usage would allow all of _bfd_std_section to be zero. */
12458 static const asymbol lcomm_sym
12459 = GLOBAL_SYM_INIT ("LARGE_COMMON", &_bfd_elf_large_com_section
);
12460 asection _bfd_elf_large_com_section
12461 = BFD_FAKE_SECTION (_bfd_elf_large_com_section
, &lcomm_sym
,
12462 "LARGE_COMMON", 0, SEC_IS_COMMON
);
12465 _bfd_elf_final_write_processing (bfd
*abfd
)
12467 Elf_Internal_Ehdr
*i_ehdrp
; /* ELF file header, internal form. */
12469 i_ehdrp
= elf_elfheader (abfd
);
12471 if (i_ehdrp
->e_ident
[EI_OSABI
] == ELFOSABI_NONE
)
12472 i_ehdrp
->e_ident
[EI_OSABI
] = get_elf_backend_data (abfd
)->elf_osabi
;
12474 /* Set the osabi field to ELFOSABI_GNU if the binary contains
12475 SHF_GNU_MBIND or SHF_GNU_RETAIN sections or symbols of STT_GNU_IFUNC type
12476 or STB_GNU_UNIQUE binding. */
12477 if (elf_tdata (abfd
)->has_gnu_osabi
!= 0)
12479 if (i_ehdrp
->e_ident
[EI_OSABI
] == ELFOSABI_NONE
)
12480 i_ehdrp
->e_ident
[EI_OSABI
] = ELFOSABI_GNU
;
12481 else if (i_ehdrp
->e_ident
[EI_OSABI
] != ELFOSABI_GNU
12482 && i_ehdrp
->e_ident
[EI_OSABI
] != ELFOSABI_FREEBSD
)
12484 if (elf_tdata (abfd
)->has_gnu_osabi
& elf_gnu_osabi_mbind
)
12485 _bfd_error_handler (_("GNU_MBIND section is supported only by GNU "
12486 "and FreeBSD targets"));
12487 if (elf_tdata (abfd
)->has_gnu_osabi
& elf_gnu_osabi_ifunc
)
12488 _bfd_error_handler (_("symbol type STT_GNU_IFUNC is supported "
12489 "only by GNU and FreeBSD targets"));
12490 if (elf_tdata (abfd
)->has_gnu_osabi
& elf_gnu_osabi_unique
)
12491 _bfd_error_handler (_("symbol binding STB_GNU_UNIQUE is supported "
12492 "only by GNU and FreeBSD targets"));
12493 if (elf_tdata (abfd
)->has_gnu_osabi
& elf_gnu_osabi_retain
)
12494 _bfd_error_handler (_("GNU_RETAIN section is supported "
12495 "only by GNU and FreeBSD targets"));
12496 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_sorry
);
12504 /* Return TRUE for ELF symbol types that represent functions.
12505 This is the default version of this function, which is sufficient for
12506 most targets. It returns true if TYPE is STT_FUNC or STT_GNU_IFUNC. */
12509 _bfd_elf_is_function_type (unsigned int type
)
12511 return (type
== STT_FUNC
12512 || type
== STT_GNU_IFUNC
);
12515 /* If the ELF symbol SYM might be a function in SEC, return the
12516 function size and set *CODE_OFF to the function's entry point,
12517 otherwise return zero. */
12520 _bfd_elf_maybe_function_sym (const asymbol
*sym
, asection
*sec
,
12523 bfd_size_type size
;
12525 if ((sym
->flags
& (BSF_SECTION_SYM
| BSF_FILE
| BSF_OBJECT
12526 | BSF_THREAD_LOCAL
| BSF_RELC
| BSF_SRELC
)) != 0
12527 || sym
->section
!= sec
)
12530 *code_off
= sym
->value
;
12532 if (!(sym
->flags
& BSF_SYNTHETIC
))
12533 size
= ((elf_symbol_type
*) sym
)->internal_elf_sym
.st_size
;
12539 /* Set to non-zero to enable some debug messages. */
12540 #define DEBUG_SECONDARY_RELOCS 0
12542 /* An internal-to-the-bfd-library only section type
12543 used to indicate a cached secondary reloc section. */
12544 #define SHT_SECONDARY_RELOC (SHT_LOOS + SHT_RELA)
12546 /* Create a BFD section to hold a secondary reloc section. */
12549 _bfd_elf_init_secondary_reloc_section (bfd
* abfd
,
12550 Elf_Internal_Shdr
*hdr
,
12552 unsigned int shindex
)
12554 /* We only support RELA secondary relocs. */
12555 if (hdr
->sh_type
!= SHT_RELA
)
12558 #if DEBUG_SECONDARY_RELOCS
12559 fprintf (stderr
, "secondary reloc section %s encountered\n", name
);
12561 hdr
->sh_type
= SHT_SECONDARY_RELOC
;
12562 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd
, hdr
, name
, shindex
);
12565 /* Read in any secondary relocs associated with SEC. */
12568 _bfd_elf_slurp_secondary_reloc_section (bfd
* abfd
,
12570 asymbol
** symbols
,
12571 bfd_boolean dynamic
)
12573 const struct elf_backend_data
* const ebd
= get_elf_backend_data (abfd
);
12575 bfd_boolean result
= TRUE
;
12576 bfd_vma (*r_sym
) (bfd_vma
);
12578 #if BFD_DEFAULT_TARGET_SIZE > 32
12579 if (bfd_arch_bits_per_address (abfd
) != 32)
12580 r_sym
= elf64_r_sym
;
12583 r_sym
= elf32_r_sym
;
12585 /* Discover if there are any secondary reloc sections
12586 associated with SEC. */
12587 for (relsec
= abfd
->sections
; relsec
!= NULL
; relsec
= relsec
->next
)
12589 Elf_Internal_Shdr
* hdr
= & elf_section_data (relsec
)->this_hdr
;
12591 if (hdr
->sh_type
== SHT_SECONDARY_RELOC
12592 && hdr
->sh_info
== (unsigned) elf_section_data (sec
)->this_idx
12593 && (hdr
->sh_entsize
== ebd
->s
->sizeof_rel
12594 || hdr
->sh_entsize
== ebd
->s
->sizeof_rela
))
12596 bfd_byte
* native_relocs
;
12597 bfd_byte
* native_reloc
;
12598 arelent
* internal_relocs
;
12599 arelent
* internal_reloc
;
12601 unsigned int entsize
;
12602 unsigned int symcount
;
12603 unsigned int reloc_count
;
12606 if (ebd
->elf_info_to_howto
== NULL
)
12609 #if DEBUG_SECONDARY_RELOCS
12610 fprintf (stderr
, "read secondary relocs for %s from %s\n",
12611 sec
->name
, relsec
->name
);
12613 entsize
= hdr
->sh_entsize
;
12615 native_relocs
= bfd_malloc (hdr
->sh_size
);
12616 if (native_relocs
== NULL
)
12622 reloc_count
= NUM_SHDR_ENTRIES (hdr
);
12623 if (_bfd_mul_overflow (reloc_count
, sizeof (arelent
), & amt
))
12625 free (native_relocs
);
12626 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_file_too_big
);
12631 internal_relocs
= (arelent
*) bfd_alloc (abfd
, amt
);
12632 if (internal_relocs
== NULL
)
12634 free (native_relocs
);
12639 if (bfd_seek (abfd
, hdr
->sh_offset
, SEEK_SET
) != 0
12640 || (bfd_bread (native_relocs
, hdr
->sh_size
, abfd
)
12643 free (native_relocs
);
12644 /* The internal_relocs will be freed when
12645 the memory for the bfd is released. */
12651 symcount
= bfd_get_dynamic_symcount (abfd
);
12653 symcount
= bfd_get_symcount (abfd
);
12655 for (i
= 0, internal_reloc
= internal_relocs
,
12656 native_reloc
= native_relocs
;
12658 i
++, internal_reloc
++, native_reloc
+= entsize
)
12661 Elf_Internal_Rela rela
;
12663 if (entsize
== ebd
->s
->sizeof_rel
)
12664 ebd
->s
->swap_reloc_in (abfd
, native_reloc
, & rela
);
12665 else /* entsize == ebd->s->sizeof_rela */
12666 ebd
->s
->swap_reloca_in (abfd
, native_reloc
, & rela
);
12668 /* The address of an ELF reloc is section relative for an object
12669 file, and absolute for an executable file or shared library.
12670 The address of a normal BFD reloc is always section relative,
12671 and the address of a dynamic reloc is absolute.. */
12672 if ((abfd
->flags
& (EXEC_P
| DYNAMIC
)) == 0)
12673 internal_reloc
->address
= rela
.r_offset
;
12675 internal_reloc
->address
= rela
.r_offset
- sec
->vma
;
12677 if (r_sym (rela
.r_info
) == STN_UNDEF
)
12679 /* FIXME: This and the error case below mean that we
12680 have a symbol on relocs that is not elf_symbol_type. */
12681 internal_reloc
->sym_ptr_ptr
=
12682 bfd_abs_section_ptr
->symbol_ptr_ptr
;
12684 else if (r_sym (rela
.r_info
) > symcount
)
12687 /* xgettext:c-format */
12688 (_("%pB(%pA): relocation %d has invalid symbol index %ld"),
12689 abfd
, sec
, i
, (long) r_sym (rela
.r_info
));
12690 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value
);
12691 internal_reloc
->sym_ptr_ptr
=
12692 bfd_abs_section_ptr
->symbol_ptr_ptr
;
12699 ps
= symbols
+ r_sym (rela
.r_info
) - 1;
12700 internal_reloc
->sym_ptr_ptr
= ps
;
12701 /* Make sure that this symbol is not removed by strip. */
12702 (*ps
)->flags
|= BSF_KEEP
;
12705 internal_reloc
->addend
= rela
.r_addend
;
12707 res
= ebd
->elf_info_to_howto (abfd
, internal_reloc
, & rela
);
12708 if (! res
|| internal_reloc
->howto
== NULL
)
12710 #if DEBUG_SECONDARY_RELOCS
12711 fprintf (stderr
, "there is no howto associated with reloc %lx\n",
12718 free (native_relocs
);
12719 /* Store the internal relocs. */
12720 elf_section_data (relsec
)->sec_info
= internal_relocs
;
12727 /* Set the ELF section header fields of an output secondary reloc section. */
12730 _bfd_elf_copy_special_section_fields (const bfd
* ibfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED
,
12731 bfd
* obfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED
,
12732 const Elf_Internal_Shdr
* isection
,
12733 Elf_Internal_Shdr
* osection
)
12737 struct bfd_elf_section_data
* esd
;
12739 if (isection
== NULL
)
12742 if (isection
->sh_type
!= SHT_SECONDARY_RELOC
)
12745 isec
= isection
->bfd_section
;
12749 osec
= osection
->bfd_section
;
12753 esd
= elf_section_data (osec
);
12754 BFD_ASSERT (esd
->sec_info
== NULL
);
12755 esd
->sec_info
= elf_section_data (isec
)->sec_info
;
12756 osection
->sh_type
= SHT_RELA
;
12757 osection
->sh_link
= elf_onesymtab (obfd
);
12758 if (osection
->sh_link
== 0)
12760 /* There is no symbol table - we are hosed... */
12762 /* xgettext:c-format */
12763 (_("%pB(%pA): link section cannot be set because the output file does not have a symbol table"),
12765 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value
);
12769 /* Find the output section that corresponds to the isection's sh_info link. */
12770 if (isection
->sh_info
== 0
12771 || isection
->sh_info
>= elf_numsections (ibfd
))
12774 /* xgettext:c-format */
12775 (_("%pB(%pA): info section index is invalid"),
12777 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value
);
12781 isection
= elf_elfsections (ibfd
)[isection
->sh_info
];
12783 if (isection
== NULL
12784 || isection
->bfd_section
== NULL
12785 || isection
->bfd_section
->output_section
== NULL
)
12788 /* xgettext:c-format */
12789 (_("%pB(%pA): info section index cannot be set because the section is not in the output"),
12791 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value
);
12795 esd
= elf_section_data (isection
->bfd_section
->output_section
);
12796 BFD_ASSERT (esd
!= NULL
);
12797 osection
->sh_info
= esd
->this_idx
;
12798 esd
->has_secondary_relocs
= TRUE
;
12799 #if DEBUG_SECONDARY_RELOCS
12800 fprintf (stderr
, "update header of %s, sh_link = %u, sh_info = %u\n",
12801 osec
->name
, osection
->sh_link
, osection
->sh_info
);
12802 fprintf (stderr
, "mark section %s as having secondary relocs\n",
12803 bfd_section_name (isection
->bfd_section
->output_section
));
12809 /* Write out a secondary reloc section.
12811 FIXME: Currently this function can result in a serious performance penalty
12812 for files with secondary relocs and lots of sections. The proper way to
12813 fix this is for _bfd_elf_copy_special_section_fields() to chain secondary
12814 relocs together and then to have this function just walk that chain. */
12817 _bfd_elf_write_secondary_reloc_section (bfd
*abfd
, asection
*sec
)
12819 const struct elf_backend_data
* const ebd
= get_elf_backend_data (abfd
);
12820 bfd_vma addr_offset
;
12822 bfd_vma (*r_info
) (bfd_vma
, bfd_vma
);
12823 bfd_boolean result
= TRUE
;
12828 #if BFD_DEFAULT_TARGET_SIZE > 32
12829 if (bfd_arch_bits_per_address (abfd
) != 32)
12830 r_info
= elf64_r_info
;
12833 r_info
= elf32_r_info
;
12835 /* The address of an ELF reloc is section relative for an object
12836 file, and absolute for an executable file or shared library.
12837 The address of a BFD reloc is always section relative. */
12839 if ((abfd
->flags
& (EXEC_P
| DYNAMIC
)) != 0)
12840 addr_offset
= sec
->vma
;
12842 /* Discover if there are any secondary reloc sections
12843 associated with SEC. */
12844 for (relsec
= abfd
->sections
; relsec
!= NULL
; relsec
= relsec
->next
)
12846 const struct bfd_elf_section_data
* const esd
= elf_section_data (relsec
);
12847 Elf_Internal_Shdr
* const hdr
= (Elf_Internal_Shdr
*) & esd
->this_hdr
;
12849 if (hdr
->sh_type
== SHT_RELA
12850 && hdr
->sh_info
== (unsigned) elf_section_data (sec
)->this_idx
)
12852 asymbol
* last_sym
;
12854 unsigned int reloc_count
;
12856 unsigned int entsize
;
12857 arelent
* src_irel
;
12858 bfd_byte
* dst_rela
;
12860 if (hdr
->contents
!= NULL
)
12863 /* xgettext:c-format */
12864 (_("%pB(%pA): error: secondary reloc section processed twice"),
12866 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value
);
12871 entsize
= hdr
->sh_entsize
;
12875 /* xgettext:c-format */
12876 (_("%pB(%pA): error: secondary reloc section has zero sized entries"),
12878 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value
);
12882 else if (entsize
!= ebd
->s
->sizeof_rel
12883 && entsize
!= ebd
->s
->sizeof_rela
)
12886 /* xgettext:c-format */
12887 (_("%pB(%pA): error: secondary reloc section has non-standard sized entries"),
12889 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value
);
12894 reloc_count
= hdr
->sh_size
/ entsize
;
12895 if (reloc_count
<= 0)
12898 /* xgettext:c-format */
12899 (_("%pB(%pA): error: secondary reloc section is empty!"),
12901 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value
);
12906 hdr
->contents
= bfd_alloc (abfd
, hdr
->sh_size
);
12907 if (hdr
->contents
== NULL
)
12910 #if DEBUG_SECONDARY_RELOCS
12911 fprintf (stderr
, "write %u secondary relocs for %s from %s\n",
12912 reloc_count
, sec
->name
, relsec
->name
);
12916 dst_rela
= hdr
->contents
;
12917 src_irel
= (arelent
*) esd
->sec_info
;
12918 if (src_irel
== NULL
)
12921 /* xgettext:c-format */
12922 (_("%pB(%pA): error: internal relocs missing for secondary reloc section"),
12924 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value
);
12929 for (idx
= 0; idx
< reloc_count
; idx
++, dst_rela
+= entsize
)
12931 Elf_Internal_Rela src_rela
;
12936 ptr
= src_irel
+ idx
;
12940 /* xgettext:c-format */
12941 (_("%pB(%pA): error: reloc table entry %u is empty"),
12942 abfd
, relsec
, idx
);
12943 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value
);
12948 if (ptr
->sym_ptr_ptr
== NULL
)
12950 /* FIXME: Is this an error ? */
12955 sym
= *ptr
->sym_ptr_ptr
;
12957 if (sym
== last_sym
)
12961 n
= _bfd_elf_symbol_from_bfd_symbol (abfd
, & sym
);
12965 /* xgettext:c-format */
12966 (_("%pB(%pA): error: secondary reloc %u references a missing symbol"),
12967 abfd
, relsec
, idx
);
12968 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value
);
12977 if (sym
->the_bfd
!= NULL
12978 && sym
->the_bfd
->xvec
!= abfd
->xvec
12979 && ! _bfd_elf_validate_reloc (abfd
, ptr
))
12982 /* xgettext:c-format */
12983 (_("%pB(%pA): error: secondary reloc %u references a deleted symbol"),
12984 abfd
, relsec
, idx
);
12985 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value
);
12991 src_rela
.r_offset
= ptr
->address
+ addr_offset
;
12992 if (ptr
->howto
== NULL
)
12995 /* xgettext:c-format */
12996 (_("%pB(%pA): error: secondary reloc %u is of an unknown type"),
12997 abfd
, relsec
, idx
);
12998 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value
);
13000 src_rela
.r_info
= r_info (0, 0);
13003 src_rela
.r_info
= r_info (n
, ptr
->howto
->type
);
13004 src_rela
.r_addend
= ptr
->addend
;
13006 if (entsize
== ebd
->s
->sizeof_rel
)
13007 ebd
->s
->swap_reloc_out (abfd
, &src_rela
, dst_rela
);
13008 else /* entsize == ebd->s->sizeof_rela */
13009 ebd
->s
->swap_reloca_out (abfd
, &src_rela
, dst_rela
);